Quick Books Manual
Quick Books Manual
Quick Books Manual
Custom Edition
Elaine Marmel
New York Chicago San Francisco Lisbon London Madrid Mexico City Milan New Delhi San Juan Seoul Singapore Sydney Toronto
McGraw-Hill books are available at special quantity discounts to use as premiums and sales promotions, or for use in corporate training programs. For more information, please write to the Director of Special Sales, Professional Publishing, McGraw-Hill, Two Penn Plaza, New York, NY 10121-2298. Or contact your local bookstore. QuickBooks 2008 The Official Guide Copyright 2008 by The McGraw-Hill Companies. All rights reserved. Printed in the United States of America. Except as permitted under the Copyright Act of 1976, no part of this publication may be reproduced or distributed in any form or by any means, or stored in a database or retrieval system, without the prior written permission of publisher, with the exception that the program listings may be entered, stored, and executed in a computer system, but they may not be reproduced for publication. QuickBooks 2008 The Official Guide Premier Edition ISBN 978-0-07-154471-9 MHID 0-07-154471-2 QuickBooks 2008 The Official Guide Enterprise Edition ISBN 978-0-07-154472-6 MHID 0-07-154472-0 Sponsoring Editor Megg Morin Editorial Supervisor Jody McKenzie Project Manager Vasundhara Sawhney, International Typesetting & Composition Acquisitions Coordinator Carly Stapleton Technical Editor Daniel Hodge Copy Editor Mike McGee Proofreader Divya Kapoor Indexer Valerie Perry Production Supervisor George Anderson Composition International Typesetting & Composition Illustration International Typesetting & Composition
Information has been obtained by McGraw-Hill from sources believed to be reliable. However, because of the possibility of human or mechanical error by our sources, McGraw-Hill, or others, McGraw-Hill does not guarantee the accuracy, adequacy, or completeness of any information and is not responsible for any errors or omissions or the results obtained from the use of such information.
Acknowledgments
Id like to thank Megg Morin for giving me the opportunity to write this book and for really good chocolate, Daniel Hodge for keeping me technically accurate, Nicholas Tolstoshev for cheerfully seeing that I got the information I needed to complete the book, and the staff at International Typesetting & Composition for their professional handling of this book. Id also like to thank the staff at Intuit for taking time out of their busy schedules to work with me. The publisher adds in thanks to the Intuit folks who lent many hands, specifically Liane Freeman, Peggy Chang, and Sharjeel Durrani and also to Nicholas Tolstoshev who contributed his expertise, goodwill, and time.
Introduction
How to Use This eBook
This eBook is organized with a certain amount of logic connected to the way youll probably use your QuickBooks software. You can consult the table of contents, where youll notice that the topics start with the tasks you perform immediately after installing the software, move on to the tasks you perform often, and then cover the tasks you perform less frequently. The index guides you to specific tasks and features, so when you absolutely must know immediately how to do something, its easy to find the instructions. The Adobe Acrobat PDF format of this eBook makes it easy to access content from multiple points of entry. To see an overview of the contents of this eBook, choose View | Navigation Tabs | Bookmarks. In the View Bookmarks mode, click on individual chapters and topics to jump to the desired book page. Similarly, if you select Index from the list of Bookmarks, youll be presented with the list of indexed terms from the book. You can click on any of the page numbers next to an indexed term to be taken to that page where the term is located. We hope that these multiple entry points will be useful to you as you view the contents of this eBook.
Additional insight about a subject or a task. Sometimes theyre shortcuts, and sometimes theyre workarounds for QuickBooks restrictions. Notes Extra information about a topic or a task. Sometimes they provide information about what happens behind the scenes when you perform a task, and sometimes they have additional information you might be curious about. Cautions Help you avoid the traps you can fall into if a task has a danger zone.
VII
VIII
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
Sidebars
Facts you dont necessarily need to perform a task, but the information may be helpful. Some sidebars help you understand the way QuickBooks thinks (all software applications have a predictable thinking pattern). Others are designed to point out the way certain procedures help you run your business.
Part One
Getting Started
ongratulations on deciding to use QuickBooks to track your business finances! Accounting software such as QuickBooks has to be set up and carefully tweaked before you begin using it. Part One of this book has two chapters. In Chapter 1, youll learn about the focus of the Premier and Enterprise Solutions editions of QuickBooks. Youll also find a summary of the new features in QuickBooks 2008. Then, in Chapter 2, youll learn how to set up lists that form the backbone for using QuickBooks.
Chapter 1 Chapter 1
1
Introducing QuickBooks
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
Several years ago, the QuickBooks group at Intuit identified an increasing need to support the business management tasks of large and growing companies who are already Intuit customers, as well as those customers joining Intuit from outside of the QuickBooks installed base. The QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions and the QuickBooks Premier product lines are the result. You have in your hands one of the most robust QuickBooks products ever delivered to the marketplace. Both QuickBooks Premier and QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions support all basic accounting functions needed by growing and larger businesses. You can invoice customers, pay employees, and manage bill payment and inventory quickly, easily, and efficiently. QuickBooks Premier contains most of the features also available in QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions, and QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions is aimed at the larger organization that must support more than five simultaneous QuickBooks users. For example, the level of security that you can set in QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions far exceeds that available in QuickBooks Premier. QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions offers features like ODBC reporting capabilities and the ability to produce combined financial reports for multiple companies (see Chapter 15) that arent available in QuickBooks Premier.
Industry-Specific Editions
In addition to the General Business edition of QuickBooks, both QuickBooks Premier and QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions are available in the following industry-specific editions:
both the accountant and the client. In particular, the client can, in one step, create the Accountants Copy file and transfer it to an Intuit secure server. The accountant receives an e-mail message, notifying him or her that the file is ready to download and providing a link to download it. In addition, the accountant has much more freedom and flexibility in the tasks he or she can perform in the Accountants Copy.
CHAPTER
INTRODUCING
QUICKBOOKS
Creating new general ledger accounts is easier because you get extra help
selecting the correct type of account and when you add an account, you can choose from a recommended list. Significant improvements help you include reimbursable expenses on invoices. You can now e-mail invoices from Outlook and Outlook Express (Windows XP) or Windows Mail (Windows Vista) as well as use the QuickBooks e-mail service. From the Customer, Vendor, and Employee centers, you can get maps and directions to the address of the selected customer, vendor, or employee using Google Maps. If you own one of the convertible QuickBooks products, you can switch from one edition to another without uninstalling and reinstalling. You can enable credit card protection to make QuickBooks securely handle customer credit card information that you store in the customer record. Because QuickBooks is certified by an independent auditor to be Payment Application Best Practices (PABP)-compliant, QuickBooks users who save customer credit card information in QuickBooks will be able to meet the requirement of the Payment Card Industry for securely handling and storing credit card information. You can install and use QuickBooks Enterprise company files on a Linux server. Details are available in the installation guide that comes with QuickBooks Enterprise.
N O T E : If you dont maximize the Coach, options for the Coach appear on
the QuickBooks Home page.
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 1-1
When you click View The Tutorial, QuickBooks plays an online video that familiarizes you with the basics of the QuickBooks interface. When the video finishes, QuickBooks displays the QuickBooks Learning Center window, which helps you walk through setting up a company. When you click Show Coach Tips, the QuickBooks Home page takes on a different appearance (see Figure 1-2). On the left side, a series of Information icons containing the lowercase letter i appear scattered on the Home page. If you roll your mouse over one of these Information icons, the Coach Tips window explains the purpose of the button that appears beside the Information icon. And if you click an Information icon, QuickBooks displays a lighted numbered path that helps you identify the tasks involved in a particular workflow and the order in which you typically perform the tasks. In Figure 1-2, I clicked the Information icon beside Sales Orders (the Information icon disappears after you click it and reappears after you click a different Information icon). The Coach shows me there are four steps involved in tracking a sale from a customer. At any point, you can return the Home page to its usual appearance by clicking the Hide Coach Tips button on the right side of the window. The QuickBooks Coach window reappears (refer back to Figure 1-2). You can click the X in the upper right corner to hide the window, and you can hide the Coach buttons that appear on the right side of the Home page by clicking the minus sign () beside QuickBooks Coach. If you need the Coach again, click the plus sign (+) that appears beside QuickBooks Coach and then click Show Coach Tips to see workflows, or click Maximize Coach to see the QuickBooks Coach window. You turn the Coach on (and off) by choosing Edit | Preferences and then clicking the Desktop View icon on the left. On the My Preferences tab, check the Show Coach Window And Features box to turn on the Coach, and remove the check to turn off the Coach.
CHAPTER
INTRODUCING
QUICKBOOKS
FIGURE 1-2
The QuickBooks Coach can help you find your way through QuickBooks after setting up your company.
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 1-3
Scroll to the bottom of the Help topic to view the See Also links where youll have the opportunity to search the Intuit web site for more help if you dont find what you need.
System Requirements
Table 1-1 describes the recommended system requirements to install and use QuickBooks Premier (server) and the Enterprise Solutions client. During installation, if your system doesnt have .NET Framework 2.0 and you use the QuickBooks CD to install QuickBooks, .NET Framework 2.0 will be installed on 32-bit and 64-bit systems. If you download QuickBooks to install it, .NET Framework 2.0 will install only on 32-bit systems. Any 64-bit system users who dont already have .NET Framework 2.0 need to download and install .NET Framework 2.0 separately or use the QuickBooks CD to install QuickBooks.
CHAPTER
INTRODUCING
QUICKBOOKS
Minimum
Recommended
TABLE 1-1
Table 1-2 describes the recommended system requirements for Enterprise Solutions Server. In addition to these basic recommended requirements, please note the following:
Disk space requirements do not include company data files, so if you manage
many companies or if your company data file is very large, you may need more disk space. Disk access speed can affect performance. We recommend a 7200-rpm drive (or 20+ MB/sec); faster is better, and SATA is typically faster than IDE. Disks with large caches may improve performance, depending on usage. The minimum access speed is 4200 rpm. Network access speed has a strong impact on performance in networked environments (multiuser, or when accessing data files on other computers). We recommend a minimum 100-Mbps network for optimal performance. VPN and wireless networks often cannot provide sufficient and reliable low-latency performance. QuickBooks will work on both 32-bit and 64-bit processors running XP and Vista, but is compiled as a 32-bit application. Some capabilities (such as memory access) may be greater on 64-bit machines.
Minimum
Recommended
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
CPU clock speeds do not determine performance nearly as much as in the past, and the preceding points are given as guidelines rather than as absolutes. CPU architecture can have a bigger impact on performance than speedfor example, dual core processors will be faster than single core for many activities, even if running at a lower clock speed.
Created by credible top-rated independent Intuit Gold and Silver software developers who have extensive industry-specific expertise, these task-based applications work together with QuickBooks to offer a comprehensive end-to-end solution that helps you build and better manage your business. Using the lists shown on the left side of Figure 1-4, search QuickBooks Solutions Marketplace for needed online resources according to your specific industry, business function, and/or QuickBooks product. As you search for products, you can create and store a list of solutions that interest you. Using that list, you can connect to the provider of a software solution to learn more about each application, schedule a private demonstration, or make a purchase. You also can take advantage of online evaluation resources within Solutions Marketplace to evaluate each applications ability to meet your business needs:
Customer Satisfaction Rating Score QuickBooks ProAdvisor Product Review Customer Case study Customer comments
CHAPTER
INTRODUCING
QUICKBOOKS
FIGURE 1-4
Use QuickBooks Solutions Marketplace to find add-on solutions that make QuickBooks even more powerful.
If youre using QuickBooks Enterprise, you can also visit www.qbes.com/ integratedsolutions where youll find Enterprise-specific solutions. A graphic will appear in the center of the page, as shown in Figure 1-5. Click any link in the graphic and youll see a list of related solutions. Click a solutions link and a page from QuickBooks Solutions Marketplace appears describing the product and providing you with the same evaluation materials and options to save a list of solutions available to QuickBooks Premier users. Welcome to QuickBooks!
10
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 1-5
Use this graphic on the QuickBooks Enterprises web page to help you find solutions that work specifically with QuickBooks Enterprise.
Chapter 2 Chapter 2
n this chapter:
Creating a QuickBooks company Adding accounts to the chart of accounts Entering data into lists Inventing your own fields to make your lists more useful
11
12
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
In this chapter, Ill cover many basic chores. They arent terribly exciting or creative, but if you do them now, youll find your work easier later. So take the time now to get the basic data into the system to make future work faster and more efficient.
T I P : QuickBooks has a spell checker. Thus, when you edit some list entries, youll see a Spelling button. Click it to check the text you entered and you wont have to worry about spelling errors in transactions (for instance, invoices) because youve already checked the elements.
When you view the items in a list, you can sort the list by any column in the window. Just click the column heading to sort the list by the category of that column.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
13
FIGURE 2-1
Fill in the data and click Next to select an organization for your company, such as Sole Proprietorship or Corporation. Select the organization that applies to you and click Next. QuickBooks asks you to select the month in which your fiscal year starts. After you make a selection, click Next. QuickBooks displays a list of industries in the column on the left. When you select an industry in the left column, QuickBooks displays a chart of accounts typically used by businesses in that industry (see Figure 2-2).
N O T E : Actually, you dont have to use this chart of accounts. You can create
a company with no accounts by selecting Other/None in the Industry list. However, I think youll find it easier to use a sample chart of accounts and make changes as necessary.
By default, QuickBooks doesnt number accounts, but you can turn on account numbering after you create your company, and QuickBooks will automatically number the default accounts you see in Figure 2-2. See the section, Using Numbers for Accounts, later in this chapter.
14
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-2
When you select an industry, QuickBooks displays a chart of accounts that works well with businesses in that industry.
Click Next and QuickBooks displays the Create Your Company File screen, which explains that youll be storing your information in a file QuickBooks calls the company file. Click Finish and QuickBooks displays the Filename For New Company dialog box in which QuickBooks suggests a location and filename based on your company name.
Click Save to create your company file. QuickBooks creates the new company and opens it so you can view the Learning Center and start setting preferences, entering data, and doing all the other tasks involved in creating a company.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
15
N O T E : The Import utility works with Microsoft Office Excel 2007 and earlier.
Open both QuickBooks and your Excel spreadsheets. Then, use your Windows task bar to switch back to QuickBooks. In QuickBooks, choose File | Utilities | Import | Excel Files. QuickBooks displays the Add Your Excel Data To QuickBooks window.
Ill 2-1
Click the button that matches the type of list information you want to copy from Excel to QuickBooks. Excel starts and you see a preformatted workbook created to work directly with QuickBooks (see Figure 2-3). You cannot rename, resize, add, or move any of the columns in the preformatted workbook, and the column headings in your existing workbook may not match exactly the ones in the preformatted workbook, but that doesnt matter. If your workbook contains information you dont see in the preformatted workbook, youll need to add that information manually.
16
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-3
A sample preformatted workbook you can use to import Excel information into QuickBooks.
N O T E : If you have any of these workbooks open, you wont be able to switch
back to QuickBooks.
Working one column at a time, copy the appropriate information in your existing Excel workbook and paste it into the preformatted workbook that QuickBooks provides, repeating the process until youve copied and pasted all of your existing Excel information into the preformatted workbook. When you finish, save the workbook and make a note that identifies the location where you save the file. If you change the file name (you dont need to change the name), also make note of the file name.
T I P : After youve viewed the tips in the outlined boxes, you can turn them off by clicking the Hide Coach Tips button.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
17
Close Excel. QuickBooks reappears, displaying a new variation of the Add Your Excel Data To QuickBooks window.
Ill 2-2
In Step 2 of the window, click the Browse button and navigate to the folder where you saved the preformatted workbook that now contains all of the information you stored in Excel. After you select the file, click the add My Data Now button. Some work goes on behind the scenes and then another new variation of the Add Your Excel Data to QuickBooks window appears, with Step 3 displaying the number of entries QuickBooks successfully imported from Excel. You can click the View X List button (where X is Customer, Vendor, or Item) that appears below Step 3 to view the associated QuickBooks list.
18
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-4
Select the software package that currently contains your accounting data.
QuickBooks displays a message indicating that it needs to download the QuickBooks Conversion Tool. After you click Yes, you may see a message asking you to open your web browser. After you click OK, QuickBooks displays the QuickBooks Conversion Tool web page. Scroll to the bottom of the page, answer the required questions (there are only a few), and click Submit. Once you download the tool, double-click it to run it and then follow the onscreen prompts.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
19
To switch to a number format for your accounts, Just change a QuickBooks preference: Choose Edit | Preferences from the menu bar to open the Preferences dialog box. Select Accounting from the left pane. Click the Company Preferences tab (See Figure 2-5). Select the Use Account Numbers checkbox. Click OK to save the changes and assign the account numbers. If you chose a built-in chart of accounts during the EasyStep Interview, QuickBooks adds numbers to those accounts automatically. You may want to change some of the numbers, and you can do so by editing the accounts (see Editing Accounts later in this chapter). When you select the option to use account numbers, the option Show Lowest Subaccount Only becomes accessible (its grayed out if you havent opted to use account numbers). This option tells QuickBooks to display only the subaccount on transaction windows instead of both the parent account and the subaccount, making it easier to see precisely the account affected by the transaction.
FIGURE 2-5
20
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
If you havent numbered all of your accounts and you select Show Lowest Subaccount Only, when you click OK, QuickBooks displays an error message indicating you cannot enable this option until you have assigned numbers to all of your accounts. After youve edited existing accounts that need numbers, you can return to this Preferences window and enable the Show Lowest Subaccount Only option. I believe that a numbered chart of accounts helps you, your bookkeeper, and your accountant work more efficiently and easily. If you assign ranges of numbers to account types, numbers can give you a quick clue about the type of account with which youre working. In QuickBooks, youll find predefined charts of accounts that use a structure like the one shown in Table 2-1. This structure uses five-digit numbers and is friendly and easy to use.
#Range
Acct Type
10000 15000 16000 17000 19000 20000 21000 24000 27000 30000 40000 50000 60000 70000 80000 90000
14999 15999 16999 18999 19999 20999 23999 26999 29999 39999 49999 59999 69999 79999 89999 99999
Bank Accounts Receivable Other Current Asset Fixed Asset Other Asset Accounts Payable Credit Card Other Current Liability Long Term Liability Equity Income Cost of Goods Sold Expense Other Income Other Expense Nonposting
TABLE 2-1
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
21
Using a numbering scheme like this one leaves a lot of room (unused numbers) for further breakdowns, especially in the expenses. Most companies need more expense categories than any other category. Usually, you should add accounts by increasing the previous account number by 100 or, if that number is already used, by 10; if your first bank account is 10000, the next bank account is 10100. If 10100 is already assigned, you can use 10110. This approach gives you room to squeeze in additional accounts that belong in the same general area of your chart of accounts when they need to be added later.
Naming Accounts
Even if you enable account numbers, you must give each account a name. I suggest you establish a companywide standard for naming accounts. Your standard should be clear so that when everyone follows the standard, the account naming convention is consistent. Why is this important? Because when I visit clients who havent invented and enforced standards, I find accounts with names such as:
And, it isnt surprising to find that every one of those accounts has amounts posted to them. If you establish account naming standards, you can avoid the errors introduced by a variety of individuals making up names without realizing that accounts already exist. The following are a few suggestions for your standardsfeel free to amend them to fit your own situation or invent different standards that better suit your purposes. Consistency is the goal:
Avoid apostrophes. Avoid abbreviations when possible. When abbreviations cant be avoided, set the number of characters for
abbreviations. For example, if you permit four characters, telephone is abbreviated tele; a three-character rule produces tel.
22
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
maintenance or repairs&maintenance?
FYI
QuickBooks automatically creates nonposting accounts when you enable features that use those account types: Estimates, Sales Orders, and Purchase Orders. Nonposting accounts store information but dont affect account balances in your company.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
23
Using Subaccounts
Subaccounts provide a way to post transactions more precisely using subcategories for main account categories. For example, if you create an expense account for insurance expenses, you may want to have subaccounts for vehicle insurance, liability insurance, equipment insurance, and so on. Post transactions only to the subaccounts, never to the parent account. When you create reports, QuickBooks displays the individual totals for the subaccounts, along with the grand total for the parent account. To create a subaccount, you must first create the parent account, as described in the section, Creating Subaccounts, later in this chapter. If youre using numbered accounts, when you set up your main (parent) accounts, be sure to leave enough open numbers to be able to fit in all the subaccounts youll need; plan to increment subaccount numbers by ten. For example, suppose you have the following parent accounts:
63300 Insurance 68400 Travel 68600 Utilities
63310 Insurance:General Liability 63320 Insurance:Health 63330 Insurance:Life and Disability 68410 Travel:Sales 68420 Travel:Seminars and Meetings 68610 Utilities:Electric 68620 Utilities:Gas
The colon in the account names listed here is added automatically by QuickBooks to indicate a relationship between a parent account and a subaccountyou only have to create the subaccount name and number. In addition, QuickBooks supports two views of your lists: the hierarchical view and the flat view. In the Chart Of Accounts window, the difference between these views becomes apparent when you set up and view subaccounts. The flat view (see Figure 2-6) simply lists accounts while the hierarchical view provides a visual cue about the relationship of one account to another (see Figure 2-7). By clicking the Account button and selecting the desired view, you can switch between these two views.
24
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-6
Viewing the Chart Of Accounts window in flat view lists your accounts.
FIGURE 2-7
Viewing the Chart Of Accounts window in hierarchical view shows you the relationship between accounts and subaccounts.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
25
T I P : When you view the Customers & Jobs list in the Customer Center, the hierarchical view provides a visual cue about the relationship of jobs and a customer.
Adding Accounts
After youve done your homework, made your decisions, created your standards, and checked with your accountant, adding accounts is simple. When you add a new account, a wizard helps you select the correct account type. Follow these steps to add an account: Press CTRL+A (or click the Chart Of Accounts icon on the Home page) to open the Chart Of Accounts window. Press CTRL+N to enter a new account. The Add New Account: Choose Account Type window appears, providing more information about types of accounts to make it easier for you to select the correct account type.
Ill 2-3
26
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
Select a Type for the account you want to create and click Continue. The Add New Account window appears for the type of account you selected.
Ill 2-4
Because different types of accounts require different information, the window you use to create a new account changes its appearance based on the account type you select. To create a new account, you must provide the account type, a name, and, if youve enabled account numbers, the account number. The Note field, which only appears on some account types, and the Description field are optional. If you want some help, click the Select From Examples button to view typical accounts for the type you selected in the Add New Account: Choose Account Type window. Click the account you want to add and click OK. QuickBooks redisplays the Add New Account window, filling in all the information you need to set up the account. If you opted to use account numbers, QuickBooks even supplies a suggested account number. You can change any of the information before you save the account.
Ill 2-5
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
27
Some account types (for example, accounts connected to banks) have a field for an opening balance. I recommend you do not enter data in that field when youre creating an account. Instead, see Chapter 14 for details on entering opening balances for various types of accounts. I recommend an alternate procedure for opening balances that helps you track the details of the opening balance something your accountant will appreciate. When you record an opening balance using the Opening Balance field as you set up an account, QuickBooks posts the amount you enter to the account. Then, being a double-entry accounting system, QuickBooks needs to post the other side of the transaction to an account, and QuickBooks has no way of knowing what account to use, so QuickBooks uses a default account named Opening Bal Equity. Eventually, the amount in the Opening Bal Equity account becomes a huge number, and nobody can easily figure out what makes up that number. Accountants prefer being able to trace the balance of an account back to transactions, so please see Chapter 14 for details on entering opening balances for accounts. As you finish entering each account, click Save & New to display another blank New Account window. When youre finished entering accounts, click Save & Close, and then close the Chart Of Accounts window by clicking the X in the upper-right corner.
T I P : You can create up to 10,000 accounts in QuickBooks. To check to see how many accounts you have, press the F2 key while viewing the Chart Of Accounts window. In the List Information list box, youll see the total number of accounts currently defined.
Editing Accounts
If you need to make changes to any account information (including adding a number after you enable numbered accounts), select the account in the Chart Of Accounts list, and press CTRL+E. The Edit Account window appears. This dialog box closely resembles the New Account window you used in the preceding section. In this window, you can select the Account Is Inactive option, which means you wont be able to select the account while youre entering transactions. Inactive accounts dont appear by default in the Chart Of Accounts window and on the account drop-down list when youre filling out transaction windows. Make your changes and click OK to save them.
T I P : To make an inactive account active again, click the Account button in the Chart Of Accounts window and choose Show Inactive Accounts. Then, click the X that appears beside the account.
28
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
Creating Subaccounts
You can further organize account information using subaccounts. For example, you might create a parent account called Income and a subaccount called Consulting. If you use the combination in a transaction, the Account field shows Income:Consulting. If youve assigned numbers, the Account field shows 40000 Income:40100 Consulting. Because many of the fields in transaction windows are small, you may not be able to see the subaccount names without scrolling. You may find it easier to work if you display only the subaccount name by enabling the preference Show Lowest Subaccount Only, discussed earlier in the section Using Numbers for Accounts. To create a subaccount, you must have already created the parent account. Once a parent account has been created, perform the following steps: Open the Chart of Accounts list. Press CTRL+N to create a new account. Select the appropriate account type and click Continue to display the Add New Account window. If youre using numbered accounts, enter an account number. Type the name for the subaccount in the Account Name box or click the Select From Examples button. Check the Subaccount Of checkbox, and in the drop-down box next to the checkbox, select the parent account (see Figure 2-8). Click OK.
FIGURE 2-8
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
29
When you view the Chart Of Accounts window in hierarchical view, subaccounts appear indented under their parent accounts.
T I P : You can have multiple levels of subaccounts and create subaccounts for subaccounts.
Merging Accounts
It happensyou accidentally create two accounts for the same purpose. You can merge those accounts to combine their balances into one account that you will use going forward. To merge accounts, they must be of the same account type and you must be working in single-user mode.
Perform the following steps to merge two accounts: Open the Chart Of Accounts window. Click the account you do not want to use going forward. Press CTRL+E to open the Edit Account dialog box. Change the account name and number to match the account you want to keep. Click Save & Close. QuickBooks displays a dialog box telling you the account number or name youve entered already exists for another account and asks if you want to merge the accounts. Click Yes to confirm that you want to merge the two accounts.
30
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
T I P : Dont feel overwhelmed about getting all your customer information into QuickBooks. Many people enter just the customer name, company name, terms and sales tax information. The rest of the information is helpful but not required, so you can supply it later, as you have time.
FIGURE 2-9
Your list of customers and their associated jobs appears on the Customer & Jobs tab of the Customer Center
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
31
In transaction windows and dialog boxes, any field that requires the entry of a customer or job is labeled Customer:Job. Putting all your existing customers into the system takes very little effort. To create a new customer, follow these steps: In the Customer Center, select the Customers & Jobs tab to display your list of customers. Press CTRL+N (or click the New Customer & Job button above the Customers & Jobs tab and select New Customer) to open the New Customer dialog box (see Figure 2-10) and fill in the information. The New Customer dialog box contains four tabs of information; in the sections that follow, Im going to describe three of them: the Address Info tab, the Additional Info tab, and the Payment Info tab. Im going to delay discussion of the Job Info tab until later in this chapter in the section Entering Jobs.
N O T E : Some people prefer to enter just the customer name and company
name when theyre creating their customer lists, and then fill in the rest of the information described in the following sections at their leisure or the first time they invoice the customer.
FIGURE 2-10
32
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
In the Company and Addresses sections of the window, enter the company name, optionally enter a contact, and enter the billing address. Add any other contact information you want to track for this customer (telephone, e-mail, and so on).
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
33
I recommend you skip this field because, if you enter an amount, youll have no detailed records that describe the basis for the customers balance. Without these records, you wont be able to accept payments against specific invoices. Its better to skip this field and then enter as many invoices as necessary to post this customers balance to your books, using the original dates you created those transactions when you enter those invoices. By using the original date, you retain aging for the outstanding transactions. Entering transactions that describe the details associated with a customers balance is the most accurate way of setting up existing balances for customers when you first start using QuickBooks. As a side note, when you record an opening balance using the Opening Balance field on the customer record, QuickBooks posts the amount you enter to Accounts Receivable. Then, being a double-entry accounting system, QuickBooks needs to post the other side of the transaction to an account. QuickBooks has no way of knowing what income account to use, so it uses a default account named Uncategorized Income. Eventually, the amount in the Uncategorized Income account becomes a huge number, and nobody can easily figure out what transactions make up the number. Accountants prefer being able to trace the balance of an account back to transactions, so please enter individual transactions for open balances.
N O T E : The fields you see on the Additional Info tab may not be the same as
the fields shown here. The preferences you configure (for example, whether you track sales tax) determine the available fields.
Lets spend a minute going over the fields in this tab. Most of the fields also appear in various QuickBooks lists, and if you havent already entered items in those lists, you can do so as you fill out the fields in the New Customer dialog box. For each field that also appears in a list, youll find an entry named <Add New> when you click the drop-down arrow beside the field. Selecting the <Add New> entry opens the appropriate new blank entry window. Use the Type field to sort your customers by a type you find important or convenient when you create reports. QuickBooks maintains a Type list (see the Customer Type List section later in this chapter). For example, you may want to consider wholesale and retail customers as your customer types. To use the field, click the arrow to select a type you already entered, or click <Add New> to create a new type.
34
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-11
You can use price levels to create a pricing scheme, which usually involves special discounts you want to use when you sell to this customer. Select an existing price level or create a new one. See the section, Price Level List, to learn about creating and assigning price levels. You can use custom fields to store specialized information and to sort and arrange your QuickBooks lists in various ways. See the section, Using Custom Fields, later in this chapter.
Terms
Terms refers to payment terms. Click the arrow to the right of the text box to see the terms that QuickBooks already defined, or choose <Add New> to define a new one. QuickBooks uses the terms in the Terms List for both customers and vendors, and you may need to establish additional terms to meet your needs. See the Terms List section later in this chapter to learn how to create different types of terms.
Rep
Use this field to assign a sales representative to your customer. Its useful to make this assignment whether you pay commissions or you just want to know who is in charge of this customer. Sales reps can be employees, vendors, or other names
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
35
(which means the name is entered in the Other Names List). Select a rep from the list of reps or add a new rep by choosing <Add New>. See the Sales Rep List section for more information on populating this list.
documents as PDF files to an e-mail message. You can use your regular e-mail program or use a QuickBooks server to send the e-mail. Chapter 3 offers details. Mail, which lets you use a QuickBooks service to mail the invoices. The data is reproduced on a form that has a tear-off portion for your customers to enclose with their payment. Regardless of the method you choose as your default, you can use any send method when creating a transaction.
T I P : If you arent going to enforce the credit limit, dont bother to use the
field.
36
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-12
The Payment Info tab puts all the important information about customer finances in one place.
T I P : The payment method you select automatically appears in the Receive Payments window when you select this customer. You can change the payment method at that time, if necessary.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
37
If you plan to store customer credit card numbers, I recommend you enable Customer Credit Card Protection so QuickBooks meets the requirements set by the credit card industry to securely handle credit card information. While enabling Customer Credit Card Protection is not required, if you save customer credit card information, it is strongly recommended to help your business avoid fines or other damages imposed by your merchant service provider or the credit card companies if your customers credit card numbers are compromised. If you enable Customer Credit Card Protection, then all users who have access to viewing full credit card detail in the customer record will be required to set up a complex passwordone that is at least seven characters and contains at least one capital letter and one number. In addition, QuickBooks will prompt you to change the password every 90 days. Enabling Customer Credit Card Protection also turns on a credit card security audit log that records all relevant credit card actions in QuickBooks. You can use this log in the event of a security breach related to credit card information. To enable Customer Credit Card Protection, choose Company | Customer Credit Card Protection and follow the prompts onscreen to create a complex password. If you have enabled security in QuickBooks in a multiuser environment, log on to QuickBooks as the Admin user and then choose Company | Customer Credit Card Protection. Once you enable Customer Credit Card Protection, tell each QuickBooks user to change their QuickBooks password to a complex password the next time they log on to QuickBooks and mention that they will need to change the password every 90 days. As the Admin, you should limit permission to view the credit card fields to only designated users. For details on security and managing multiple users, see Chapter 23.
38
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
the selected customer by clicking the button. You dont have to open the customer record to get to the note.
Ill 2-6
Entering Jobs
Jobs are associated with customers; they cant stand alone. To create a job, press CTRL+J to open the Customer Center (or click the Customer Center icon on the toolbar) and select the Customers & Jobs tab. Right-click the customer for whom you want to create a job, and choose Add Job to open the New Job window, the fourth tab in the New Customer window you saw earlier in this chapter. (In the Customers and Jobs section, you read about the Address Info tab, the Additional Info tab, and the Payment Info tab.) Create a name for the job (you can use up to 41 characters) and make it descriptive enough for both you and your customer to understand. If this job requires you to bill the customer at an address thats different from the address you entered for this customer, or to ship goods to a different shipping address than the one thats entered, make the appropriate changes on the Address Info tab. QuickBooks maintains this information only for this job and wont change the original shipping address in the customer record. The Additional Info tab and the Payment Info tab are related to the customer rather than the job, so click the Job Info tab to set up this job (see Figure 2-13). All of the information on the Job Info tab is optional; the job may not require these data.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
39
FIGURE 2-13
The Job Status drop-down list offers choices you can change as the job progresses. You can change the text that describes each progress level to suit your own business. To accomplish this, follow these steps: Choose Edit | Preferences to open the Preferences dialog box. Click Jobs & Estimates in the left pane (see Figure 2-14). Click the Company Preferences tab in the right pane to see the current descriptive text for each status level. Change the text of any status level if you have a descriptive phrase you like better. For example, you may prefer Working to In progress. Click OK. QuickBooks uses new labels on every job in your company data file. When you finish entering all the information about this job, choose Next to create another job for the same customer. Otherwise, click OK to close the New Job window. The jobs you create for a customer appear indented below the customer in the list of Customers & Jobs.
40
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-14
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
41
FIGURE 2-15
The Additional Info tab for vendors has several important categories (see Figure 2-16):
Account No.
Enter your account number with this vendor (to the vendor, its your customer number), and the number will appear in the memo field of printed checks. Type Select a type or create one. This optional field is handy if you want to sort vendors by type, which makes reports more efficient. For example, you can create vendor types for inventory suppliers, tax authorities, and so on. Terms Enter the terms for payment this vendor has assigned to you. Credit Limit Enter the credit limit this vendor has given you. Tax ID Use this field to enter the Social Security number or EIN if this vendor receives a Form 1099. Vendor Eligible For 1099 If appropriate, select this checkbox. Custom Fields As with customers, you can create custom fields for vendors (see the section, Using Custom Fields, later in this chapter). Billing Rate Level If you use QuickBooks Enterprise or the Contractor, Professional, or Accountant Edition of QuickBooks Premier, you can assign a billing rate level. For more information, see the last section of this chapter.
Using the Account Prefill tab, you can select accounts that QuickBooks will automatically fill in on transactions whenever you select the vendor. Dont hesitate to take advantage of these fields; they will help you save time when entering bills or
42
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-16
Add information to this tab to make producing checks and reports easier.
writing checks. If you use more than one list to select accounts, QuickBooks will fill in all the accounts you select. You can take advantage of selecting multiple accounts if you always distribute bills and checks for this vendor to two or three accounts.
Ill 2-7
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
43
After you fill in the information, choose Next to set up the next vendor. When youre finished setting up vendors, click OK. When you view or edit a vendors information by selecting the vendors listing and pressing CTRL+E, youll find a Notes button just like the one in the Edit Customer dialog box. You can use it in the same way. The Edit Vendor dialog box contains a Notes button you can click to open a Notepad window dedicated to this vendor. You can use this Notepad to store any information about the vendor you find useful. When you view the Vendor List, an Edit Notes button appears in the Vendor Information pane of the Vendor Center. You can open the Notepad for the selected vendor by clicking the button; you dont have to open the vendor record to get to the note.
Entering Items
Items are the things that appear on invoices to customers. Each thing you sell is an item. Do you charge sales tax? If you do, thats an item. Do you subtotal sections of your invoices? That subtotal is an item. Do you show prepayments or discounts? Theyre items, too. Although you can issue an invoice that says Net amount due for services rendered or Net amount due for items delivered and enter one total in the invoice, the lack of detail will work against you when you try to analyze your business; you wont have enough information to determine where youre making lots of money and where youre making less money than you expected. This setup chore requires some planning. Each of your items must have a unique identification (QuickBooks calls that the Item Name/Number). Try to create a system that has some logic to it so you can easily identify your items when you see them listed.
T I P : Ive described all of the item types in terms of their use on your estimates, sales orders, and invoices, but you use many of them on your purchase orders and vendor bills, too.
44
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
Item Type
Description
An intangible product you provide to a customer. Selling a service doesnt affect any inventory accounts. A product you buy for the purpose of reselling. This item type isnt available unless you enable inventory using the Easy Step Interview or from the Items & Inventory section of the Preferences dialog box. Use this item type to describe inventory items you sell that you create (assemble) from other inventory parts, noninventory parts, or service items. For example, the computer systems you sell include a CPU, a monitor, a keyboard, and a mouse, and you dont sell a system without all of its parts. Your computer system is an assembly. See Chapter 10 for more information on assemblies. A tangible product you sell but dont track as inventory. Often, noninventory parts are items you buy specifically to resell to fill a customers order. A home builder views windows as noninventory parts, purchased as needed to construct a home. Use this item type for things like shipping charges or other line items that appear on your invoices. This item type adds up everything above it and below any previous subtotal. It provides a subtotal before you add shipping charges or subtract any discounts or prepayments. This item type cleverly enables you to enter a group of items (all of which must exist in your Item List) all at once. For example, if a service you sell consists of a charge for labor and charges for three different materials, you can group the items so you dont have to enter each individually on the invoice. Create a discount item so you can give a customer a line item discount. You can create as many discount items as you needfor example, a discount for wholesale customers, a discount for a volume purchase, and a special holiday sale discount. When you use the item on an invoice, you can indicate a flat rate or percentage. If you receive a prepayment (either a total payment or a partial payment as a deposit), you indicate it as a line item, using this item type. Create one of these item types for each sales tax authority for which you collect; this item type is available if sales tax is enabled. Use this item to group multiple sales taxes that appear on the same invoice. Again, this item type is available if sales tax is enabled.
Inventory Assembly
Noninventory Part
Group
Discount
TABLE 2-2
N O T E : Enterprise users see a set of search fields at the top of the Item List
window that do not appear in Premier editions.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
45
To create a new item, press CTRL+N. The New Item window opens, displaying a list of item types, as described previously in Table 2-2. Select an item type to display the appropriate fields in the blank New Item window. In Figure 2-17, you see the fields for an Inventory Part item. Other item types (such as Service items) have fewer fields. The Item Name/Number field is the place to insert a unique identifier for the item. When you are filling out estimates, sales orders, invoices, purchase orders, or vendor bills, the Item Name/Number appears in the drop-down list.
N O T E : After youve created an item, you can create subitems. For example,
if you sell shoes as an item, you can create subitems for dress shoes, sneakers, boots, and so on. Or use subitems for a parent item that comes in a variety of colors. You cannot create subitems for Subtotal items, Group items, Payment items, Sales Tax items, and Sales Tax Group items.
FIGURE 2-17
46
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
Many of the rest of the fields in the New Item window change depending on the item type you select. Most of them are self-explanatory, but some are important enough to merit discussion:
If youre entering an inventory item, fill in the cost of the item and enter the
account to which you post the cost of goods sold (COGS). Optionally, fill in the name of the vendor from whom you purchase the item. In the Sales Price field, you can enter a rate for those items youve priced. Leave the rate at zero for the items you want to price when you are preparing the invoice. Dont worrynothing is written in stone. You can change any rate that appears automatically when you include the item on a transaction. In the Income Account field, select an income account on your Chart Of Accounts. In the Tax Code field, choose Tax or Non to indicate whether the item is taxable. The Tax Code field is only available if youve configured your company to collect sales tax. When you complete the window, choose Next to create another item. When you finish entering items, click OK.
N O T E : One list, the Templates list, isnt covered here. The Templates list
contains all of the invoice, purchase order, sales receipt, and other forms you use in transactions. I discuss working with and customizing those templates in Chapter 15. I find you can accomplish what you need in windows by means other than the Templates List window.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
47
Users of editions of QuickBooks Premier other than the Accountants Edition can use the Depreciate Your Assets tool to determine depreciation rates in QuickBooks. The Depreciate Your Assets tool is a planning tool that does not perform depreciation tasks. Instead, you depreciate your assets in regular QuickBooks transaction windows. You can learn about the Depreciate Your Assets tool in Chapter 13.
FIGURE 2-18
48
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-19
You can assign a specific price for the item to a customer (or multiple customers), or to one or more jobs. In addition, if you wish, you can assign a specific price to an item when youre creating an invoice. If the invoice contains an item that has price levels assigned, a drop-down list containing all the price levels is available in the Rate column of the invoice. Just select the price you want to charge for this item, for this invoice. After you create price levels, you can apply a price level to customers. Open the Customers & Jobs List and select a customer. Press CTRL+E to edit the customers information and select a price level on the Additional Info tab.
T I P : You can apply price levels to items in addition to customers, enabling you to provide discounts (or increases) while youre creating invoices.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
49
T I P : Unless youre a proprietor or partner, its totally possible to use QuickBooks efficiently without ever using this list. And, if necessary, you can change any name on the Other Names List to a Vendor, Customer or Employee.
50
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
51
Use the Standard section to create terms that are due at some elapsed time after the invoice date:
Net Due In is the number of days allowed for payment after the invoice date. To create a discount for early payment, enter the discount percentage and the
number of days after the invoice date that the discount is in effect. For example, a 2-percent discount may be in effect for the first ten days after the invoice date. Use the Date Driven section to describe terms that are due on a particular date, regardless of the invoice date:
Enter the day of the month the invoice payment is due. Enter the number of days before the due date that invoices are considered
payable on the following month. To create a discount for early payment, enter the discount percentage and the day of the month at which the discount period ends. For example, if the standard due date is the 15th of the month, you may want to extend a discount to any customer who pays by the 8th of the month.
T I P : Date-driven terms are commonly used by companies that send invoices monthly, usually on the last day of the month. If you send invoices constantly, as soon as a sale is completed, its very difficult to track and enforce date-driven terms.
52
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
QuickBooks automatically populates the payment methods with common payment types. If you have a payment method that isnt listed, you can add that method to the list. To do so, press CTRL+N to open the New Payment Method dialog box. Name the payment method and select the appropriate payment type.
N O T E : FOB (Free On Board) is the site from which an order is shipped and is
also the point at which transportation and other costs are the buyers responsibility. There are no accounting implications for FOBits merely informational.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
53
54
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
FIGURE 2-20
You can set up custom fields for customers, vendors, and employees in this dialog box.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
55
Click the Use box to use the field. (To stop using a custom field, uncheck the box.) Click OK. The first time you enter a custom field on an item, a dialog appears to tell you that you can use these fields on templates (forms such as Invoices, Sales Orders, Estimates, Purchase Orders, or Packing Slips). Click OK and optionally check the box to stop displaying this message in the future. When you click Custom Fields in the Edit Item dialog box for any item, your existing custom fields appear. To enter data for the custom fields in an item, open the item from the Item List and click the Custom Fields button on the Edit Item window. Then enter the appropriate data.
Ill 2-9
Chart Of Accounts Item Customers & Jobs Vendor Other Names Classes
56
PART ONE
G E T T IN G
START E D
To merge entries within a list, take the following steps: Select the list entry you want to eliminate and press CTRL+E to edit the entry. Change the entrys name to match the name of the entry you want to keep. Click OK. QuickBooks displays a message telling you the name is already in use and asks if you want to merge the two names. Click Yes. QuickBooks merges all of the information, including transaction data, into the entry youre keeping. Bear in mind the following information when you decide to merge entries:
You cannot unmergethe process is not reversible. If you are unsure of the
process, back up your data before you merge. See Chapter 24 for details on backing up. For accounts and items, you cannot merge entries that have subentries. Change the subentries to parent entries by removing the Subaccount Of or Subitem Of check mark. Merge the parent entries and then reapply the Subaccount Of or Subitem Of check mark (all of which will now be subentries of the new single, merged, parent entry). You can merge an item without subitems with an item that has subitems, but not the other way around. You can merge subentries of the same parent (which is in fact the most common type of merge). You can merge jobs that are subentries of the same customer.
Now that all your lists exist and theyre fine-tuned, you can work quickly and easily in QuickBooks transaction windows. The following chapters walk you through those tasks.
CHAPTER
SETTING
UP
YOUR
COMPAN Y
57
performing a specific service. For example, on a given job, your senior consultants may be billable at one rate, while your junior consultants generate a different rate. You set up billing rate levels using the Billing Rate Level List, and associate billing rate levels with individual or all service items. Once you create the billing rates, you assign them to customers, vendors, employees, or someone listed on the Other Names List. To track services for each name and billing rate, use the QuickBooks Timesheet feature.
Part Two
Bookkeeping
art Two contains chapters about the day-to-day bookkeeping chores youll be performing in QuickBooks. These chapters take you through everything you need to know about sending invoices to your customers and collecting the money they send back as a result. Youll learn how to track and pay the bills you receive from vendors, as well as find plenty of information on dealing with inventory buying it, selling it, and counting itand keeping QuickBooks upto-date on those figures. Youll also learn about handling payroll, both in-house payroll and outside payroll services. This part covers how to print and customize reports and, once youve gotten a report looking just the way you want it, how to memorize that report. In addition, youll learn how to customize the templates of the windows you use to enter information into QuickBooks so that the windows more closely match the way you do business. Finally, youll learn about budgets, general ledger adjustments, and all the other once-in-a-while tasks you need to know for you to accomplish keeping your accounting records finely tuned.
Chapter 3 Chapter 3
Invoicing
n this chapter:
Understanding the customer center Creating and editing invoices Working with estimates and sales orders Creating and editing credit memos Printing invoices and credit memos Creating pick lists and packing slips
59
60
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
For many businesses, the only way to get money is to send an invoice to a customer. Creating an invoice in QuickBooks is easy. In this chapter, youll learn what all the parts of the invoice do and why theyre there. In addition to invoices, you often have to create credits, packing slips, sales orders, and estimates. After covering all those transaction documents, Ill describe the choices you have for getting those documents to your customers.
Click the Customer Center icon on the toolbar. Click the Customers icon on the left side of the Home page. Press CTRL+J. Choose Customers | Customer Center from the menu bar.
FIGURE 3-1
The Customers & Jobs tab provides a robust way to find information about a specific customer.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
61
The left pane of the Customer Center has two tabs: Customers & Jobs and Transactions. The Customers & Jobs tab actually replaces the Customer:Job list used in earlier versions of QuickBooks. As you click any customer or job on the Customers & Jobs tab, QuickBooks displays transactions for that customer on the right side of the screen. You can limit the transactions to a specific type to make the search easier, and you can filter the transactionsyour filtering choices depend on the type of transaction you select in the Show list box. To further narrow the search, you can select a date range. The Transactions tab (see Figure 3-2) lists all your customer-related transactions based on the type of transaction. You can use this tab to find a particular transaction or transactions that meet certain criteria. On the left side of the screen, select the transaction type for which you are searching. Then, use the Filter By and Date list boxes to narrow the search. Use the toolbar buttons in the Customer Center window and the links in the right pane of the Customers & Jobs tab to open transaction windows and produce reports.
FIGURE 3-2
62
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
You can customize the Customer Center by resizing any of its panes. To resize a pane, move the mouse pointer over the edge of any pane; the mouse pointer changes to a vertical (or horizontal) bar with pointing arrows attached. Drag the pane left or right (up or down) to change its size. The other pane(s) will adjust to fill the space. In addition, you can choose the columns that QuickBooks displays in the Customer & Jobs List by right- clicking on the list. QuickBooks displays a context menu; select Customize Columns.
T I P : Click the Show Full List Only button (it appears to the right of the View list box on the Customers & Jobs tab) to make the Customer & Jobs list fill up the entire Customer Center window.
N O T E : If you dont initially see the Customize button, make the Create
Invoices window wider.
The Attorneys Invoice, the Time & Expense Invoice, the Intuit Professional
Invoice, the Custom Invoice template, and the Intuit Service Invoice templates are all very similar. They differ in the order of the columns. In addition, the Attorneys Invoice template and the Time & Expense Invoice template include an Hours/Qty column while the same column is called Quantity on the other two invoice templates. The Service template, the Time and Expense Invoice template, and the Attorneys Invoice template have a field for a purchase order number. The Custom Invoice template contains a field for Contract #, but otherwise looks just like the Intuit Service Invoice template.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
63
FIGURE 3-3
The Intuit Product Invoice template has more fields and different columns than
most of the other templates because it contains information about the items in your inventory. The Progress template and the Custom Progress Invoice template are designed specifically for progress billing against a job estimate. They appear in the Template list only if you have set your company preferences to use progress billing and to contain columns that track prior invoicing as well as current invoicing. (For more info on progress billing, see the Using Estimates section later in this chapter.) The Custom S.O. Invoice template supports invoices created from sales orders. (The Creating Sales Orders section later in the chapter has more on sales orders and how to use this invoice template.) The Fixed Fee Invoice template doesnt contain any columns for quantity and ratethe two fields you would usually use to calculate an amount. Instead, you simply supply an amount when you use this invoice template. The Intuit Standard Pledge template works best for nonprofit organizations. The customer is called Donor and the message box is titled Donor Message. Like the Fixed Fee Invoice template, this template doesnt contain any columns for quantity and ratethe two fields you would usually use to calculate an amount. Instead, you simply supply an amount when you use this invoice template.
64
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
use with a customized estimate template, Proposal. As youll see later in this chapter, you can create an invoice from an estimate. If you use the Proposal Estimate template, QuickBooks fills in values from the estimate in the Proposal Amount column and the Prior Amount column of the Invoice From Proposal template. The Rock Castle Invoice template was designed for use in the sample company Rock Castle Construction and supports selling a mixture of goods and services. The Finance Charge template appears if you enable finance charges in the Finance Charge category of the Preferences dialog. Information about finance charges is in Chapter 5. The Packing Slip template is discussed in the section Printing Packing Slips later in this chapter.
T I P : In the Manage Templates dialog box, you can click the Download Templates button to open a QuickBooks web page. From this page, you can download over 100 predesigned business forms. You also can find template forms at www.quickbooksgroup.com/qblibrary/Forms. You can customize templates, as discussed later in the section, Customizing Templates.
For this discussion, Ill use the Intuit Product Invoice template, because it contains the most fields. If youre using any other template, youll still be able to follow along, even though your invoice form doesnt display some of the fields related to products. The top portion of the invoice is for the basic information and is called the invoice heading. The middle section, where the billing items are placed, is called the line item section. The bottom section holds the totals and other details (such as customer messages).
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
65
The current date appears in the Date field. If you want to change the date, either type in a new date, or click the calendar icon at the right side of the field to select a date. If you change the date, the new date appears automatically in each invoice you create during this session of QuickBooks (the current date returns after you close, and then reopen the software).
T I P : If you click in the Date field and then press either plus (+) or minus (), QuickBooks changes the date one day at a time (later or earlier) each time you press the key. N O T E : You can change the default behavior so that QuickBooks displays the
last date used on a transaction instead of todays date. Once you close and reopen QuickBooks, QuickBooks reverts to using the current system date, but if you change the date, QuickBooks uses the date you provide until you close QuickBooks. Choose Edit | Preferences and click the General category. On the My Preferences tab, change the Default Date To Use For New Transactions option.
The first time you enter an invoice, fill in the invoice number you want to use as a starting point. From that point forward, QuickBooks increments the invoice number for each new invoice. QuickBooks displays the Bill To address stored in the customer record. You can select a Ship To address from the drop-down list on the Product Invoice template, or add a new Ship To address by choosing <Add New> from the list.
FYI
66
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If you have a purchase order from this customer, enter it in the P Number .O. field. QuickBooks fills in the Terms field automatically using the terms you entered when you created the customer record. You can change the terms for this invoice if you wish. If terms dont automatically appear, then you didnt enter that information in the customer record.
T I P : If you enter or change any information about the customer while youre creating an invoice, QuickBooks offers to add the information to the customer record when you save the invoice. If the change is permanent, click Yes. If the change is only for this invoice, click No.
In the Rep field, QuickBooks displays the salesperson assigned to this customer. Click the arrow next to the field to choose any sales rep name from the drop-down list. In the Ship field, QuickBooks supplies the invoice date as the ship date. Use the Via field to select a shipping method. Click the arrow next to the field to see the available shipping choices. (See Chapter 2 for information about adding to this list.) Some companies use the FOB field to indicate the point at which the shipping costs are transferred to the buyer and the assumption of a completed sale takes place. If you use FOB terms, enter the applicable data in the field. It has no impact on your QuickBooks financial records and is there for your convenience only.
N O T E : QuickBooks warns you if you dont have enough items on hand and
then asks if you want to learn how to track backorders (discussed later in this chapter).
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
67
You can add as many rows of items as you need to an invoice. If you run out of room, QuickBooks automatically adds pages to your invoice.
FIGURE 3-4
68
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Entering Discounts
To let your customer know that you have reduced the price of an item, you can adjust individual lines of an invoice by applying discounts instead of using price levels. You enter discounts as line items, so you need to set up the discount as an item in your Items List. QuickBooks calculates the amount of a discount item based on the amount of the line item immediately above it. For example, lets suppose you have already entered line items as follows:
Qty of 1 for Some Item with a price of $100.00 for a total line item price of
$100.00 Qty of 2 for Some Other Item with a price of $40.00 for a total line item price of $80.00 If you enter a 10-percent-discount item on the next line, QuickBooks calculates the value of the discount as 10 percent of the last line you enteredand includes an $8.00 discount on the invoice. To apply the discount to all the line items, first enter a subtotal item from the Items List that adds and calculates the total of all the lines on the invoice. Then, enter the discount item as the next line item; QuickBooks calculates the discount based on the subtotal. You can use the same approach to discount some line items on the invoice but not others. Simply follow these steps: Enter all the items youre planning to discount. Enter a subtotal item. Enter a discount item. Enter the remaining items (the items youre not discounting). This method makes your discounts and your discount policies very clear to the customer. When youre finished entering all the line items, youll see that QuickBooks has kept a running total, including taxes (see Figure 3-5).
Checking Spelling
Click the Spelling icon on the toolbar of the Create Invoices window to run the QuickBooks spell checker. If the spell checker finds any word in your invoice form that isnt in the QuickBooks dictionary, that word is displayed. You can change the spelling, add the word to the QuickBooks dictionary (if its spelled correctly), or tell the spell checker to ignore the word.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
69
FIGURE 3-5
T I P : If you check the spelling each time you create an item, you eliminate the need to worry about spelling on an invoiceeverything is pre-checked before you insert the items in the invoice form. (The spell check ignores the data in the heading section of the invoice.) N O T E : The spell checker is turned on by default. You can control the spell
checker in the Spelling section of the Preferences dialog box, or click the Options button in the Check Spelling On Form window to open the Spell Options dialog box.
70
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
You can add text to the Memo field at the bottom of the invoice. This text doesnt print on the invoiceit appears only on the screen (youll see it if you reopen this invoice to view or edit it). However, the memo text does appear beside the invoice on statements.
T I P : You can print the default packing slip at this point if you click the arrow beside the Print icon at the top of the Create Invoices window and select Print Packing Slip from the drop-down list. The Print Packing Slip dialog opens so you can select your printing options, which are the same as the options for printing invoices described later in this chapter.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
71
When you find the invoice you want to edit, double-click it. QuickBooks displays it in the Create Invoices window.
N O T E : You can also use the QuickBooks Find feature described in Chapter 23.
Be aware of the following when youre editing a previously entered invoice:
If the invoice has been paid, you should not edit the amount, date, or items.
However, you can edit the Memo field. If the invoice has not been paid, but has been mailed, you shouldnt edit anything, although its probably safe to enter or modify text in the Memo field if necessary. If the invoice has not yet been sent to the customer, you can make any changes you wish. When you click Save & Close, QuickBooks displays a message dialog box asking whether you want to save the changes you made. Click Yes.
While you can delete invoices, I dont recommend the practice. You can properly cancel the effects of the invoice in some other way that leaves a trail of your actions
72
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
that others can understand. For example, you can void an invoice or you can enter a credit memo to cancel the invoice. Voiding an invoice produces the same results as deleting an invoice but leaves a trail of your actions for your accountant. Using a credit memo to cancel the effects of an invoice provides both your accountant and your customer with the trail of your actions. If you must delete an invoice, display the invoice, open the Edit menu, and click Delete Invoice. Then, youll have to confirm the deletion.
Because QuickBooks is a full double-entry bookkeeping program, it makes a balanced posting to the general ledger. For this invoice, QuickBooks creates the following entries to the general ledger:
Account Accounts Receivable Sales Tax IncomeServices Debit 530.00 30.00 500.00 Credit
If the invoice includes inventory items, the entries are a bit more complicated. Suppose that an invoice describes ten widgets that were sold and shipped to a customer. The widgets cost you $50.00 each, you sold them for $100.00 each, and you charged tax and shipping.
Account Accounts Receivable IncomeSales of Items Sales Tax Shipping Cost of Good Sold Inventory 500.00 500.00 Debit 1,077.00 1,000.00 70.00 7.00 Credit
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
73
FYI
Using Estimates
An estimate is an educated guess of the potential sale of goods or services that you can print and present to your customer. Most people associate estimates with businesses that use job costing. In particular, the construction industry leaps to mind when most people think of estimates. But estimates can have a wider use than you might first imagine. For example, estimates can be used as work orders in businesses where you need to keep a list of promised items or services prior to actually invoicing the customer. Once work for the customer has been completed, you can use the estimate to create an invoice for the customer. Estimates do not update your QuickBooks general ledger data. As such, you can think of them as placeholder documents that contain information you will need in the future when invoicing a customer. The invoice will update your QuickBooks general ledger data. For certain customers or certain types of jobs, it may be advantageous to create estimates. An estimate isnt an invoice, but it can be the basis of an invoice. You can also create multiple invoices to reflect the progression of the job.
Setting Preferences
To use estimates, you must turn on the feature. Open the Edit menu and click Preferences. On the left side of the Preferences dialog box, click Jobs & Estimates. On the right side, click Company Preferences. Then, click Yes in the Do You Create Estimates? box and in the Do You Do Progress Invoicing? box (see Figure 3-6). Click OK to save the changes.
74
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 3-6
Creating an Estimate
To create an estimate, click the Estimates icon on the Home page, or choose New Transactions | Estimates in the Customer Center to display the Create Estimates window, which closely resembles the Create Invoices window. Fill out the fields in the same manner you use for invoices (see Figure 3-7).
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
75
FIGURE 3-7
The Create Estimates window closely resembles the Create Invoices window.
want to duplicateyou can use the Customer Center to find the estimate and double-click it to display itright-click and choose Duplicate Estimate. The Estimate # field changes to the next number, while everything else remains the same. Make the required changes, and then click Save & Close.
76
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Follow these steps to create an invoice from an estimate: In the Customer Center, find and double-click the estimate you want to use to create an invoice. QuickBooks displays the estimate in the Create Estimates window. Click the Create Invoice button at the top of the window. QuickBooks displays the Create Progress Invoice Based On Estimate dialog box, from which you can decide whether to invoice the customer for the entire estimate or only part of the estimate.
Ill 3-1
Select the appropriate option to invoice your customer for the entire estimate, a percentage of the entire estimate, or for specific lines of the estimate. Click OK.
T I P : If you arent using progress invoicing, you dont see the Create Progress Invoice Based On Estimate dialog box. Instead, QuickBooks copies the entire estimate into the Create Invoices window.
What happens next depends on the option you chose in the Create Progress Invoice Based on Estimate dialog box. If you chose to create an invoice for the entire estimate, QuickBooks copies the entire estimate into the Create Invoices window. If you chose to create an invoice for a percentage of the entire estimate, QuickBooks creates an invoice that contains all lines of the estimate and the appropriate dollar amount for each line, based on the percentage you supplied. For example, if you chose to bill for 10 percent of the estimate, QuickBooks lists all lines on the estimate and the dollar amount for 10 percent of each line (see Figure 3-8). If you chose to invoice for specific lines of the estimate, QuickBooks displays the Specify Invoice Amounts For Items On Estimate dialog box, shown in Figure 3-9. Use this dialog box to specify which lines you want to invoice and how much of them you want to invoice. You can specify an amount or a percentage on any line. The total appears at the bottom of the box. Once you fill in the appropriate information and click OK, QuickBooks displays the Create Invoices window with the correct information in it.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
77
FIGURE 3-8
FIGURE 3-9
78
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Job Estimates vs. Actuals Summary Job Estimates vs. Actuals Detail Item Estimates vs. Actuals Job Progress Invoices vs. Estimates
Each report compares estimated to actual information from different points of view. If you frequently present the same estimated items to multiple customers, you can use the Memorize Estimate feature to create boilerplate estimates for future use. Memorized estimates do not contain the customer name; QuickBooks removes the name when memorizing the document. Follow these steps: Create an estimate, filling in the items that belong on this type of estimate. Dont fill in amounts (quantities, prices, or both) that usually change. Press CTRL+M to memorize the estimate. Give the estimate a name that reminds you of its contents. Select the option Dont Remind Me. Click OK. To use the memorized estimate, press CTRL+T, or choose Lists | Memorized Transaction List. QuickBooks displays the Memorized Transaction List window. Double-click the estimate, fill in the Customer:Job information, and save it. QuickBooks doesnt change the memorized estimate; it creates a new estimate.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
79
Like an estimate, a sales order doesnt affect your inventory or the general ledger. You must create an invoice containing the information that appears on a sales order before QuickBooks reduces your inventory and updates the general ledger. Just as you could create an invoice from an estimate, you can create an invoice from a sales order. You can also create a purchase order from a sales order, which is particularly handy when you need to buy the item that you intend to resell to your customer. Like sales orders, purchase orders do not affect your QuickBooks general ledger data. You can read more about purchase orders in Chapter 6.
FIGURE 3-10
80
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 3-11
The Create Sales Orders window closely resembles the Create Invoices window.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
81
T I P : QuickBooks doesnt create and track back orders until you invoice, so you wont see the Back Order column on the sales order at this point.
T I P : To create a purchase order for one or more items on the sales order that you need to buy to sell to your customer, click the down arrow beside the Create Invoice button and select Purchase Order. QuickBooks displays windows similar to the ones about to be described here, letting you save a purchase order. See Chapter 6 for details on working with purchase orders.
Select the Create Invoice For Selected Items option and click OK. QuickBooks displays the Specify Invoice Quantities For Items On Sales Order(s) window (see Figure 3-12), where you can select the items and the quantities that you want to include on the invoice. In the To Invoice column beside each item, type the number for which you want to invoice the customer. When you click OK, QuickBooks displays the Create Invoices window, containing all the information you provided on the sales order and in the Specify Invoice Quantities for Items on Sales Order window. You also can see the quantity ordered, the quantity invoiced, and if appropriate, the quantity backordered (see Figure 3-13). Notice that the invoice contains two lines, even though only one line will be invoiced. QuickBooks will display a message telling you not to delete the other line. It represents the backordered item. If you checked all the boxes in the Sales Order section when you set sales order preferences, QuickBooks wont print the line it isnt invoicing. You can then save the invoice.
82
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 3-12
Use this window to select the items and the quantities that you want to include on the invoice.
FIGURE 3-13
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
83
T I P : If you redisplay the sales order, QuickBooks shows the quantities invoiced and backordered. You also can customize the invoice template to display backordered quantities.
FIGURE 3-14
Use this report to check for the arrival of items on sales orders.
84
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 3-15
The Open Sales Orders By Customer report (shown in Figure 3-15) is very useful when trying to find a particular customers order. Again, you can drill down on the report to display a sales order in the Create Sales Orders window.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
85
FYI
When You Need to Issue a Credit but You Dont Receive Merchandise Back from the Customer
If the goods were damaged, your customer wont be returning goods to you but youll still need to issue a credit memo to reduce the customers balance. In this case, dont use the items you sold on the credit memoif you do, youll return the items to inventory for resale. Instead, create an Other Charge item called Returns and Allowances. Make it a taxable item and assign it to an income account or to a cost of sales account, which you use to reduce income. Use this Returns and Allowances item on the credit memo. Without affecting your inventory accounts, the credit memo will reduce the customers balance and your total Accounts Receivable balance. It will also reduce income or increase cost of sales. In addition, by making the Returns and Allowances item taxable, QuickBooks will also adjust your sales tax liability.
You usually send the credit memo to the customer to let the customer know the details about the credit thats being applied. QuickBooks updates your accounting records for credit memos the same way it updates your accounting records for invoices, except that theres an inherent minus sign next to the number. Creating a credit memo is similar to creating an invoice: Click the Refunds & Credits icon on the Home page or choose New Transactions | Credit Memos/Refunds in the Customer Center to open a blank Create Credit Memos/Refunds window (see Figure 3-16). Select a customer, and then fill out the rest of the heading. Move to the line item section and enter the item, the quantity, and the rate for the items in this credit memo. You dont need to use a minus sign. Remember to insert all the special items you need to give credit for, such as shipping. You can use the Customer Message field to add any short explanation thats necessary. Click Save & Close or Save & New to save the credit memo.
N O T E : See the Sending Invoices and Credit Memos section later in this
chapter to learn about delivering your credit memos.
When you save the credit memo, QuickBooks displays a dialog box where you can choose the way to apply this credit, explained in the following sections.
86
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 3-16
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
87
FIGURE 3-17
If you write checks manually, remove the check mark in the To Be Printed checkbox, and click OK. QuickBooks adds the check to your bank account register, using the next available check number.
FIGURE 3-18
You can choose the invoice to which you want QuickBooks to apply the credit.
88
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If the credit is larger than the oldest invoice, QuickBooks applies the remaining amount of the credit to the next oldest invoice. If there are no additional invoices, the remaining amount of the credit is held in the customers record, and is treated as a retained credit. Click Done to close the window.
T I P : You can assign different printers to different forms, which is a nifty timesaver.
Follow these steps to tell QuickBooks about the printer and the way you want to print invoices: Choose File | Printer Setup from the menu bar to open the Printer Setup dialog box (see Figure 3-19). Select Invoice from the Form Name drop-down list. If you have multiple printers available, select the printer you intend to use for invoices in Printer Name box. In the bottom of the dialog, select the type of form youre planning to use for invoices from the following options: Intuit Preprinted Forms These are templates with all your company information, field names, and row and column dividers already printed. These forms need to be aligned to match the way your invoice prints. Selecting this option tells QuickBooks that only the data need to be sent to the printer because the fields are already printed. Blank Paper Selecting this option tells QuickBooks that everything, including your company name and address, field names, and the like, must be sent to the printer. This is easiest, but it may not look as attractive as a printed form. Letterhead Selecting this option tells QuickBooks not to print the company information when it prints the invoice because youll be printing the invoice on your company letterhead, which already contains this information.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
89
FIGURE 3-19
Use this dialog box to describe how you want to print invoices.
T I P : Its a good idea to print lines around each field to make sure the information is printed in a way thats easy to read. To accomplish that, make sure that no check appears in the Do Not Print Lines Around Each Field checkbox.
90
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
The sample form prints to your dot matrix printer and QuickBooks displays a dialog box asking you to enter pointer line position. You can see the pointer line at the top of the printed sample. Enter the number of the pointer line in the dialog box and click OK (the printout numbers the lines). QuickBooks will walk you through any adjustments that might be needed. If you want to tweak the alignment a bit further, choose Fine. (See the information on using the Fine Alignment dialog in the section Aligning Laser and Inkjet Printers that follows this section.) Otherwise, choose OK. When the form is printing correctly, QuickBooks displays a message telling you to note the position of the form in your printer now that the form is properly aligned. You should note where the top of the page is in relation to the print head and the bar that leans against the paper.
T I P : The best way to note the position of the forms in your dot matrix printer is to use a marker to draw an arrow with the word invoice (or the letter I) at the spot on the printer where the top of the form should be. I have mine marked on the piece of plastic that sits above the roller.
Click Print Sample to send output to your printer. Then, with the printed page in your hand, make adjustments to the alignment in the dialog box. Use the arrows next to the Vertical and Horizontal boxes to move the positions at which printing occurs. Click OK, and then click OK in the Printer Setup dialog. QuickBooks saves your settings for printing invoices. Repeat this process to create settings for credit memos.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
91
FIGURE 3-20
Choose File | Print Forms | Invoices. In the Select Invoices To Print window, click the Print Labels button to display the Select Labels To Print dialog box. QuickBooks preselects the option to produce labels for multiple customers, and the customers selected are those customers who have invoices waiting to be printed. Click OK to open the Print Labels dialog box (see Figure 3-20). Select the appropriate printer and label format. In the drop-down list, youll see a selection of Avery labels as well as preprinted labels from Intuit. Click Print. After the labels print, QuickBooks redisplays the Select Invoices To Print dialog. Choose OK to open the Print Invoices dialog and begin printing your invoices. After youve finished printing invoices, review them to make sure that the printer didnt jam or that the wrong paper wasnt in the printer. If anything went amiss, QuickBooks gives you an opportunity to reprint the forms.
Batch Printing
If you didnt print each invoice or credit memo as you created it, and you made sure that the To Be Printed checkbox was selected on each invoice you created, youre ready to print invoices and credit memos. Place the correct paper in your printer and, if its continuous paper in a dot matrix printer, position it properly. In the steps that follow, Ill show you how to print invoices. Youll be using the same steps used to print credit memos, except that in step 1 youll choose File | Print Forms | Credit Memos.
92
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
So, follow these steps: Choose File | Print Forms | Invoices. In the Select Invoices To Print window, all your unprinted invoices appear selected with a check mark. If there are any invoices you dont want to print at this time, click the check marks to remove them.
N O T E : If you want to print mailing labels for these invoices, you must print
them first (see the next section).
Click OK to print your invoices. The Print Invoices dialog appears, and you can change or select printing options. Click Print to begin printing. Repeat the steps to print your credit memos.
FYI
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
93
T I P : You can also e-mail a customer from the Customer Center using an MAPI-compliant e-mail program from within QuickBooks without attaching an invoice. In addition, you can use an MAPI-compliant e-mail program to e-mail any report from QuickBooks.
FYI
On the Send drop-down list in the Create Invoices window (and on other forms), youll find a choice named Mail Invoice. This refers to a fee-based feature for which you can sign up to let Intuit print and mail your invoices. The printed form has a tear-off remittance slip, a return envelope, and other features. You also can add a pay online feature for customers, which is available, for a fee, from Intuit. Information about both additional services is available on the QuickBooks web site (www.quickbooks.com).
94
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
In the following discussion, Ill refer to invoices in the discussion, but all of the same instructions apply to credit memos and other customer forms.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
95
FIGURE 3-21
If you want to send a copy of the invoice to another recipient, enter the e-mail address in the CC field. For multiple recipients, separate each address with a comma. Make any needed changes to the text of the e-mail message. Click Send Now to e-mail the invoice immediately, or click Send Later to save the invoice and e-mail it with other invoices in a batch. If you click Send Now to e-mail this invoice immediately, QuickBooks opens a browser window and takes you to the Business Services section of the Intuit web site. Follow the prompts to complete the sign up process; the service is free. When your e-mail is sent, QuickBooks displays a message indicating that your e-mail was sent successfully.
96
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
mark in the leftmost column of its listing. Click again to put the check mark back. You can delete any item by selecting it and clicking Remove. Youre not deleting the invoice, youre deleting the e-mail. You can return to the invoice and send it anytime. To edit the message text of any e-mail, double-click its listing, or highlight it and click the Edit E-mail button. Make your changes and click OK. Click Send Now to e-mail all the selected items. If youre using your MAPIcompliant e-mail program, switch to it and send the e-mails. If youre using the free service from QuickBooks, QuickBooks opens a browser window and takes you to the Business Services section of the Intuit web site. Follow the prompts to complete the sign-up process.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
97
FIGURE 3-22
If your customer doesnt have Acrobat Reader (now called Adobe Reader) installed, clicking the Acrobat Reader link sends your customer to the Adobe web site, where the customer can download the software for free.
98
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
a word or phrase to the default title (which is the customer or job name), such as Retainer. You can use up to 31 characters, including spaces, in the Name box. Choose Remind Me and specify how and when you want to be reminded in the How Often and Next Date fields. The reminder will appear in the QuickBooks Reminder window. Choose Dont Remind Me if you only use this memorized invoice occasionally. Choose Automatically Enter if you want QuickBooks to issue this invoice automatically. If you opt for automatic issuing of this invoice, you must fill in the fields so that QuickBooks performs the task accurately, as follows: The How Often field is where you specify the interval for this invoice, such as monthly, weekly, or so on. Click the arrow to see the drop-down list and choose the option you need. The Next Date field is the place to note the next instance of this invoice. The Number Remaining field is a place to start a countdown for a specified number of invoices. This is useful if youre billing a customer for a finite number of months because you only have a one-year contract. The Days In Advance To Enter field is for specifying the number of days in advance of the next date you want QuickBooks to create the invoice. Click OK when you have finished filling out the dialog box. Then click Save & Close in the Invoice window to save the transaction. Later, if you want to view, edit, or remove the transaction, you can select it from the Memorized Transaction List by pressing CTRL+T.
Customized Templates
QuickBooks Enterprise and the Professional Services Edition of QuickBooks Premier contain customized invoice and estimate templates, while QuickBooks Enterprise and the Manufacturing and Wholesale Edition contain customized quote and sales order templates. In the following editions of QuickBooks, you have the option to save modifications to estimates as change orders, which identify what changed on the estimate.
QuickBooks Enterprise QuickBooks Premier: Contractor Edition QuickBooks Premier: Accountant Edition
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
99
T I P : Displaying the Current Availability window is very handy if you are on the phone with a customer and want to check stock. Youll also find this window available from the Item List window.
selections Process sales orders Print pick lists, packing slips, and sales orders
FIGURE 3-23
100
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
The Sales Order Fulfillment Worksheet (see Figure 3-24) is primarily a planning tool. Use it to test what will happen if you fill selected sales orders. Use the Sort dropdown list in the upper right corner to order the sales orders that appear in the top portion of the window. Sales orders containing inventory items appear in the top portion of the window. If you have enough in inventory to fill the entire sales order, a green icon appears in the Fulfillable column. If you have enough in inventory to fill only part of a sales order, QuickBooks displays a yellow icon in the Fulfillable column. If you dont have enough in inventory to fill any of a particular sales order, QuickBooks draws an X through the icon in the Fulfillable column. You click a sales order in the top portion of the window to see the details of the sales order in the bottom of the window. If you click in the Choose column beside a sales order, QuickBooks updates the quantities in the To FulFill Qty column with the quantities you need to fill each inventory item on the sales order. QuickBooks also updates the Unallocated column using the numbers on the sales order to reflect how many of each inventory item youll have left after you fill the sales order.
FIGURE 3-24
Use the Sales Order Fulfillment Worksheet to see how filling selected sales orders will affect your inventory.
CHAPTER
INVOICIN G
101
You can change the quantity in the To Fulfill Qty column to see the effect on inventory if you filled only part of the sales order. You also can click the Choose For Me button and let QuickBooks select the sales order for you to fill. QuickBooks can fill:
All orders with the earliest order date Full orders with the earliest order date All orders with the earliest ship date Full orders with the earliest ship date All orders with the largest potential revenue Full orders with the largest potential revenue
Once youve identified the sales orders you want to fill, you can use the Print button to print pick lists, packing slips, or sales orders. Warehouse personnel can use the pick list to pull items for the order from your shelves. When they return the pick list to you, notated with quantities pulled for the order, you can print the packing slip. You may also want to print the sales order.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4
Receiving Payments
n this chapter:
Applying customer payments Applying credits and discounts to invoices Handling cash sales Depositing payments and cash sales into your bank account
103
104
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
The best part of accounting is receiving payments. You need to make sure you apply customer payments correctly so you and your customers have the same information in your records. In this chapter, well cover the tasks youll perform when you receive money from customers.
The basics of recording a payment Handling underpayments Applying outstanding credits Handling discounts
T I P : If you open the Receive Payments window from the Customer Center, QuickBooks fills in the name of the customer or job highlighted in the Customers & Jobs list.
In the Amount field, enter the amount of the payment.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
105
FIGURE 4-1
T I P : You can skip the Amount field and select invoices at the bottom of the Receive Payments window; QuickBooks calculates the total of the invoices you select and places it in the Amount field. You can disable this option in the Sales & Customers category of the Preferences dialog box. If you disable the option and select an invoice without entering the amount of the payment first, QuickBooks displays an error message.
Click the arrow to the right of the Pmt. Method field and select the payment method: If the payment method is a check, enter the check number in the Check # field. If the payment method is a credit card, see the section, Accepting Credit Cards Payments, later in this chapter. The Memo field is optional. If theres some important note you want to attach to this payment record, this is the place to record it. If the Deposit To field appears onscreen, select the bank account into which youll deposit the payment, or choose the Undeposited Funds account (see the section, Working with the Undeposited Funds Account, later in this chapter for more information on the Undeposited Funds account). If the Deposit To field doesnt appear onscreen, youve set your Sales & Customers Preferences to automatically deposit payments to the Undeposited Funds account.
106
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
N O T E : You can add any additional payment methods you need by choosing
<Add New> in the Pmt. Method drop-down list (see Chapter 2 to learn about adding items to QuickBooks lists).
FIGURE 4-2
By default, QuickBooks applies payments to the oldest invoice or to an invoice whose amount exactly matches the payment.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
107
The rule of thumb is apply payments according to the customers wishes so your records match your customers records, making it easier for you and your customer to discuss open account balances. When the customers intention isnt clear, I suggest you call the customer and ask how the customer wants the payment applied. In QuickBooks, you can manually enter the amount youre applying against any invoice in the Payment column. If the customer sent a copy of the invoice with the payment or indicated the invoice number on the check or stub, apply the payment to that invoice, even if an older invoice remains unpaid. Customers sometimes deliberately pay a newer invoice and not an older one, usually because they are disputing a charge on the older invoice.
QuickBooks offers these two approaches so you can choose the method that will best make the deposits that appear on your bank statement match the entries in QuickBooks, making your bank account reconciliation easier. Lets suppose you prepare a deposit ticket for six checks totaling $10,450.25. Most banks list a single deposit of $10,450.25 on your bank statement instead of listing the individual checks that made up the deposit. A few banks, however, will list each of the six checks on your statement rather than listing the sum of the deposit. If your bank lists individual checks instead of deposit totals, you should deposit each customer payment directly into a bank account. When you use this approach in QuickBooks, each payment appears as a separate entry when you reconcile your bank account in QuickBooks, so your deposits in QuickBooks will match the deposits that appear on your bank statement. However, if your bank lists the sum of the depositthe $10,450.25you should deposit customer payments into the Undeposited Funds account and then use the Make Deposits window to select the checks you will include in the deposit you make at your bank. Think of the Undeposited Funds account as a holding tank for money you have not yet deposited in your account at the bank. This approach groups individual checks into a single bank deposit that appears in the Reconcile window so your bank deposits in QuickBooks match the deposits that appear on your bank statement. See Chapter 12 for detailed instructions on reconciling bank accounts. Even if your bank is one of the few that lists, on bank statements, individual checks as deposits instead of the sum of a deposit, I recommend you not change the default in the Sales & Customers category of the Preferences dialog box. When you
108
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
dont change the default setting, you allow QuickBooks to always deposit cash into the Undeposited Funds account, making the payment and deposit distinct and separate transactions and allowing you to group things the way you need them. Using the Undeposited Funds account is particularly helpful in reconciling your bank statement when you take credit or debit cards from customers. Most credit card companies make one deposit daily into your bank account that is the sum of all credit card transactions for the day. As youll see later in this chapter, in the section, Depositing Income, youll be able to easily group your credit card receipts to match the daily deposit if you use the Undeposited Funds account.
Handling Underpayments
If a customer sends a payment that isnt sufficient to completely pay an invoice, after you apply the customers payment, the Receive Payments window changes, displaying an area where you can decide how to handle the underpayment (see Figure 4-3). If you select Leave This As An Underpayment, QuickBooks applies the payment to the selected invoice, adjusting the open balance of the invoice by the amount of the payment you applied.
FIGURE 4-3
Using the lower-left corner of the Receive Payments window, decide how to handle an underpayment.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
109
Ill 4-1
If you select Write Off The Extra Amount, QuickBooks takes no action until you click Save & Close or Save & New. Then, QuickBooks opens the Write Off Amount dialog box so you can choose the posting account, and, if applicable, apply a class to the transaction. Discuss the account to use for a write-off with your accountant. You can create an Income or Expense account for this purpose, depending on the way you and your accountant agree you should track receivables youve decided to forgive.
FIGURE 4-4
QuickBooks notifies you in the Receive Payments window if credits exist for the selected customer.
110
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
the Discount & Credits button on the Customer Payment window; QuickBooks displays the Discount And Credits dialog box.
Ill 4-2
Select the credit you want to apply. Depending on the circumstances, heres how QuickBooks handles the credits:
When the credit total equals or is less than the unpaid amount of the selected
invoice, QuickBooks reduces the balance due on the selected invoice. If the customer sent a payment that reflects a deduction for the amount of his or her credits, so the credit total is equal to the unpaid amount, QuickBooks zeroes out the balance of the invoice. If applying the existing credit along with the payment doesnt pay off the invoice, QuickBooks reduces the balance due on the invoice by the total of the payment and the credit. If the amount of credit exceeds the amount needed to pay off an outstanding invoice, QuickBooks retains the balance of the credit so you can apply it to another invoice. To apply a credit to more than one invoice, repeat the process of selecting an invoice and clicking the Discount & Credits button as many times as necessary to use up the balance of the credit. You dont need to use the entire credit balance at one time; QuickBooks retains any unused credits for future use. You can send a statement to the customer to reflect the current, new invoice balances as a result of applying the payments and the credits (see Chapter 5 for details on creating statements in QuickBooks).
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
111
C A U T I O N : If theres an account named Discounts in the part of your chart of accounts thats devoted to cost of goods, dont use that account for your customer discounts because its there to track the discounts you take with your vendors.
Figure 4-5 shows the Receive Payments window for a customer who has been offered a discount for timely payment. QuickBooks displays a message below the list of invoices that tells you the customer has discounts available.
112
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 4-5
When a discount for early payment applies, QuickBooks displays a message in the Receive Payments window.
QuickBooks doesnt apply the discount automatically. Select the invoice and click the Discount & Credits button to see the Discount And Credits dialog box for the selected invoice. QuickBooks inserts the amount of the discount to use; select a discount account and click Done.
Ill 4-3
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
113
N O T E : If the customer only made a partial payment and you want to give a
proportionately smaller discount, you can change the amount of the discount in the Discounts And Credits dialog box.
When QuickBooks redisplays the Receive Payments window, a Discount column will appear, displaying the amount of the discount for the selected invoice.
The customers terms dont come into play until you record the customers payment. When you enter the customer payment in the amount of $99.00, QuickBooks makes the following entries:
Account Undeposited Funds or Bank Account Accounts Receivable Discounts Given $1.00 Debit $99.00 $100.00 Credit
Lets also take a moment to review what happens behind the scenes when you deposit customer payments directly into a bank account compared to when you deposit customer payments into the Undeposited Funds account.
114
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If you deposit a customer payment directly to a bank account, QuickBooks makes the following entries:
Account Bank Accounts Receivable Debit Individual customer payment Individual customer payment Credit
In addition, when you make the actual bank deposit, you dont use the Make Deposits window in QuickBooksin fact, you wont find them in the window when you open it. If you place customer payments in the Undeposited Funds account, QuickBooks makes the following entries:
Account Undeposited Funds Accounts Receivable Debit Individual customer payment Individual customer payment Credit
When you make the actual deposit using the Make Deposits window, QuickBooks creates the following entry:
Account Bank Undeposited Funds Debit Total of deposit Total of deposit Credit
N O T E : You can easily handle the occasional cash sale in any edition of
QuickBooks Premier or Enterprise. But, if cash sales are your normal method of doing businessthat is, youre running a retail storeyou should use the Retail Edition of QuickBooks Premier or QuickBooks Enterprise.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
115
T I P : If you make regular sales to customers who always pay at the time of the sale, you should set these customers up in QuickBooks and you might want to consider creating a customer type such as Cash for this group. You can then easily report on this group or identify them for marketing and advertising campaigns.
FIGURE 4-6
Use this window to record a sale for which you receive cash at the time you supply goods or render services.
116
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
For sales to customers you dont track in QuickBooks (and dont want to track in QuickBooks), click <Add New> to set up a customer named Cash Sale and select that customer for the sale, or you can leave the customer name blank. You can fill in the rest of the fields in the Enter Sales Receipts window the same way you complete them in the Create Invoices window, with one exception: If you have turned off the Undeposited Funds option in the Sales & Customers category of the Preferences dialog box, you need to select an account in which to deposit the cash you receive. For the same reasons I presented earlier in this chapter (in the Working with the Undeposited Funds Account section), I suggest you deposit the cash into the Undeposited Funds account. For details on recording credit card transactions, see the section later in this chapter, Accepting Credit Cards Payments. Some cash customers want a receipt. When you finish filling out the form, click the Print button on the Enter Sales Receipts window toolbar to open the Print One Sales Receipt window, shown in Figure 4-7. If youre not printing to a dot matrix printer with multipart paper and you want a copy of the receipt for your files, be sure to change the value in the Number Of Copies box from 1 to 2. Click Save & New to start a sales receipt or click Save & Close to close the Enter Sales Receipts window. You may want to modify the appearance of the Enter Sales Receipts window to include information suited to your business. For example, you may want to include a field for the Sales Rep in the Sales Receipts window if you want to track the person who made the sale or to help if you pay commissions on cash sales. You may also want to include the Ship To address and the Ship Via field for customers who
FIGURE 4-7
Use this dialog box to select a printer and paper type and specify the number of copies to print.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
117
pay cash and want you to deliver the goods. See Chapter 15 for details on customizing templates.
N O T E : If you want, you can create a bank account for the Cash Register to
use instead of your petty cash account, but be aware that putting the money into the cash register is, essentially, a one-time event and you wont use the cash register bank account again.
Record cash sales as previously discussed in this chapter, making sure you select the Undeposited Funds account if you are selecting a deposit account; otherwise, dont change the defaults in QuickBooks and simply allow QuickBooks to automatically record your sales receipt transactions in the Undeposited Funds account.
118
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
When you want to deposit cash collected in the cash register, leave the original startup moneyin this example, $100.00in the drawer. Count the rest of the money and deposit that money into your checking account. See the section, Depositing Income, for details on creating the deposit that moves the cash from the Undeposited Funds account to your bank account.
T I P : QuickBooks Merchant Service supports authorizing credit cards to ensure funds availability separately from actually charging a credit card. You can authorize funds at one point in time and charge against that authorization at a later point in time.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
119
120
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
display the Process Credit Card Payment window, where you fill in the customers credit card information and the name and address associated with the credit card. QuickBooks Merchant Service uses the name and address information to verify the account and process the payment.
Depositing Income
If you use the Undeposited Funds account (a holding tank for money you have not yet deposited in your account at the bank), you need to move money out of this account and into appropriate accounts when you take the money to the bank. This section shows you how to move the money. If youve been depositing every payment and cash receipt to a specific bank account, you dont need to read this section and you dont need to do anything special in QuickBooks when you make a bank deposit.
N O T E : Most credit card companies make one deposit daily into your bank
account that is the sum of all credit card transactions for the day. Youll use the techniques in this section to move credit card transactions out of the Undeposited Funds account and into your bank account so the credit card deposits match the deposits on your bank statement.
To record a bank deposit in QuickBooks, click the Record Deposits icon on the Home page or choose Banking | Make Deposits from the menu bar. QuickBooks displays the Payments To Deposit window (see Figure 4-8). The Payments To Deposit window displays only the payments youve entered using the Receive Payments window or the Enter Sales Receipts window in QuickBooks. As you walk through this process, youll see another window where you can record other types of deposits, such as refunds, loan proceeds, or capital infusion. In the Payments To Deposit window, the Type column identifies the window where you recorded the transactionPMT for transactions recorded in the Receive Payments window and RCPT transactions recorded in the Enter Sales Receipts window. The Payment Method column identifies whether the payment was cash, check, a specific credit card, and so on. You can use this information to group transactions on a bank deposit so they will match the deposits you see on the statement your bank sends you, making bank reconciliation easy.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
121
FIGURE 4-8
Use this window to identify the transactions you want to include in a bank deposit.
Select the items you want to include in a single bank deposit by clicking to the left of the item; QuickBooks places a check mark in the column beside each item you click. Click Select All to include all payments in a single deposit. When you finish selecting, click OK. The following sections describe some techniques you might consider using while selecting items to include in a deposit.
To create a bank deposit segregated by Payment Method, select a payment method from the View Payment Method Type drop-down list at the top of the Payments To Deposit dialog box. You can choose Selected Types to open the Select Payment Types dialog box and choose several payment types to include in the same deposit. After making a selection from the View Payment Method Type drop-down list, QuickBooks displays only the transactions that match the selected payment method in the Payments To Deposit window.
122
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
This feature is particularly useful if the money you deposit comes from a cash bag. You can use the View Payment Method Type drop-down list to display only cash and create one deposit. Then, you can view only checks and create a second deposit. Segregating the deposits is particularly helpful if the bank notifies you that its automatic counting machine produced a total different from the total on your cash deposit slip. You can easily edit the correct cash bank deposit in your bank account register to enter another line on the transaction to account for the over/ short amount. Depositing by payment method is also particularly useful when recording credit card deposits. You can select a particular credit card as the payment method type so you can easily create a deposit for all transactions for that credit card on a particular date. You shouldnt record credit card deposits into QuickBooks until your merchant bank notifies you it has placed the funds into your bank account. If you have QuickBooks online banking, the deposit shows up in the QuickReport (see Chapter 16 to learn about managing online banking transactions). If you have online access to your merchant card account, the transfer will appear on the activities report on the web site. If you dont have any form of online access, youll have to wait for the monthly statement to arrive (or contact the bank periodically to see if anything showed up in your account).
N O T E : If you use multiple merchant accounts, youll see the View Payments
By Merchant Account list box, and you can segregate payments available for deposit by merchant account.
When you select deposits for a credit card using that credit cards Payment Method, and the credit card returns exceed the credit card sales, QuickBooks will make your deposit, which will be negative.
T I P : If your merchant bank deducts fees before transferring funds, learn how to deposit the net amount in the section Calculating Merchant Card Fees later in this chapter.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
123
FIGURE 4-9
have to do anything special to deposit credit card payments. You can deal with the fees when you reconcile your bank account. If your merchant card bank deducts fees from transactions and deposits the net proceeds to your account, you can use the following steps to deposit the correct amount: Select the credit card transactions in the Payments To Deposit window. These represent the full amount the customer paid you. Click OK to display the transactions in the Make Deposits window. On the first empty line, select the merchant in the Received From column. In the Account column, select the expense account to which you post merchant card fees. Move to the Amount column and enter the fee as a negative number. When you make this entry, the net amount of the QuickBooks deposit matches the amount that the merchant card bank deposited in your bank account.
124
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
As you spend the cash for business expenses, record the expenses against the petty cash account, which you typically set up as a bank account, using the Write Checks window.
T I P : By creating a customer to which you assign overages and shortages, you can view that customers register to see all your overages and shortages.
While you may be tempted to try to use the Cash Back boxes at the bottom of the Make Deposits window to handle overages and shortages, you cant, for two reasons:
Using those fields only decreases the deposit, so you cannot use them to record
overages. You can assign the amount for the Cash Back Amount field only to Balance Sheet accounts, and you typically want to track overages and shortages using either an income or an expense account.
CHAPTER
RECEIVING
PAY M E N T S
125
Chapter 5 Chapter 5
n this chapter:
Running A/R aging reports Setting up finance charges Printing customer statements
127
128
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Collecting the money owed to you is one of the most important tasks in running a business. Successfully tracking and managing your accounts receivable can mean the difference between a healthy business and one that wont survive. You can track overdue invoices and then send statements as reminders to your customers to pay. In addition, you can use finance charges to encourage your customers to pay on time. In this chapter, you learn about the tools and features QuickBooks provides to help you track and collect the money your customers owe you.
FIGURE 5-1
CHAPT ER
MANAGING
ACCOUNTS
RECEIVABLE
129
FIGURE 5-2
The A/R Aging Summary Report presents an overview of what your customers owe you, and it breaks out each customers balance to indicate how old the balance is. The A/R Aging Detail Report presents a different view of the same information, focusing on the age of the balance and listing each invoice in each age bracket. To produce an aging report, choose Reports | Customers & Receivables, and then choose either A/R Aging Summary or A/R Aging Detail. You can customize these reports and you can memorize your customized versions. Typically, these reports show what you need without customization, but you may want to change fonts or add an extra footer line. For details on customizing and memorizing, see Chapter 15. In addition to the aging reports, QuickBooks contains customer and job reports designed to give you information about the selected customers/jobs instead of providing information on the totals for your business. Plenty of customer reports are available from the menu that appears when you choose Reports | Customers & Receivables, shown in Table 5-1.
130
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Report
Description
Customer Balance Summary Report Customer Balance Detail Report Open Invoices Report Collections Report
Lists the total balance owed by each customer. Lists every open accounts receivable transaction for each customer with a net subtotal for each customer. Lists all unpaid invoices, sorted and subtotaled by customer and job. Includes the contact name and telephone number, along with details about invoices with balances due. Use this report to call the customer to discuss past due balances. Shows a graphic representation of the breakdown of your accounts receivable, helping you focus on where to start collection efforts if appropriate. Tracks job expenses you havent invoiced. Displays individual transactions of all types for each customer. Shows payments received from customers who pay you online (if youve signed up for online payments). Displays an alphabetical list of customers along with the telephone number for each if you entered the telephone number in the customer record. Displays an alphabetical list of customers along with the telephone number, billing address, and current open balance for each. Lists all your items with their prices and preferred vendors.
Accounts Receivable Graph Unbilled Costs By Job Transaction List By Customer Online Received Payments Customer Phone List
TABLE 5-1
Job reports.
CHAPT ER
MANAGING
ACCOUNTS
RECEIVABLE
131
FIGURE 5-3
In the Annual Interest Rate field, entering any positive number enables the Finance Charge feature. The interest rate you enter should be the annual rate, not the monthly rate. So, to charge 1.5% a month, enter 18% in the Annual Interest Rate field. QuickBooks calculates the finance charge by taking the annual rate, dividing it by 365, and then multiplying that percentage by the number of days overdue.
FYI
132
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
You can assess a minimum finance charge for overdue balances. QuickBooks will calculate the finance charge, and if its less than the minimum you establish in the Preferences dialog box, QuickBooks will charge the minimum charge you specify here. Use the Grace Period field to enter the number of days your customer can be late paying an invoice before QuickBooks considers an invoice eligible for finance charges, and use the options in the Calculate Charges From box to choose whether to calculate the finance charge from the invoice due date or the invoice date. When you assess finance charges, QuickBooks creates invoices for each finance charge; by default, QuickBooks doesnt mark these invoices for printing. Instead, they will appear, along with other invoices, as a line item on a monthly statement. If you want to mail finance charge invoices separately, check the Mark Finance Charge Invoices To Be Printed box. Click OK to save your settings after youve filled out the window.
FIGURE 5-4
CHAPT ER
MANAGING
ACCOUNTS
RECEIVABLE
133
Before the window appears, QuickBooks may display a message if you have any customers that have credits you havent yet applied to an invoice. This message is not necessarily connected to the customers who are due to have finance charges assessed. Its a general statement that somewhere in your company data file, theres an unapplied credit. If an asterisk appears beside the name of any customer or job in the Assess Finance Charges window, close the window, correct the situation, and then reopen the window.
Ill 5-1
By default, QuickBooks selects all customers with overdue balances when assessing finance charges. You can eliminate a customer from the process by clicking the Assess column to remove the check mark.
134
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Click a customer and click the Collection History button. QuickBooks displays a Collections Report for the selected customer (see Figure 5-5). As you move your mouse over a transaction in the report, the pointer turns into a magnifying glass with the letter z (for zoom). You can double-click any transaction to display the transaction in the window where you created it if you need to examine the details. Make sure you apply any unapplied payments or credits to avoid erroneously assessing a finance charge. See Chapter 4 for details on applying payments and credit memos to invoices.
N O T E : If you want to print the finance charge invoices, select the Mark
Invoices To Be Printed checkbox in the Assess Finance Charges window. Most businesses dont print finance charge invoices. Instead, they display the finance charge on the monthly statement.
When all the figures are correct, click Assess Charges in the Assess Finance Charges window, and QuickBooks creates and saves finance charge invoices. If you opted to print them, choose File | Print Forms | Invoices. The list of unprinted invoices appears, and the list includes the finance charge invoicesall finance charge invoice numbers begin with FC. Otherwise, when you create your customer statements, the finance charges will appear.
FIGURE 5-5
CHAPT ER
MANAGING
ACCOUNTS
RECEIVABLE
135
Sending Statements
On a periodic basis, typically once each month, most businesses send statements to customers. Statements remind customers of outstanding balances, and they help ensure your records and your customers records reflect the same information.
Statement charges use items from your Item list, but you cannot use any of the following types of items:
Items that are taxable because the statement charge cant apply the tax Items that have percentage discounts because the statement charge cant look
To record a statement charge, you work directly in the register of a customer or a job: In the Customer Center, right-click a customer on the Customers & Jobs tab and choose Enter Statement Charges from the shortcut menu. QuickBooks opens the register for the selected customer (see Figure 5-6). Select an item from the Item drop-down list or use <Add New> to create a new item. See Chapter 2 for details on adding items. Enter a quantity in the Qty field if the item is invoiced by quantity. If youre using the Qty field, enter a rate or accept the default rate if one exists. QuickBooks calculates the amount using the Qty field and the Rate field. Enter the amount charged if you didnt supply values in the Qty and Rate fields. Enter a description for the statement charge.
136
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 5-6
A customer register
Optionally, enter the billed date, which does not have to match the transaction date in the first column of the register. Postdating or predating this field determines the statement on which the charge appears. Enter the due date, which affects your aging reports and your finance charge calculations. If you dont enter a date, QuickBooks uses the customers terms to determine the date. Click Record to save the transaction. If your statement charges are recurring charges, you can memorize them to have QuickBooks automatically create them. After you create the charge, right-click it in the register and select Memorize Stmt Charge from the shortcut menu. For detailed information on memorizing, see the information in Chapter 3 about memorizing invoices. To create a statement charge for a different customer or job, use the drop-down list at the top of the register window to select the customer or job.
Creating Statements
Before you start creating your statements, make sure youve entered all of the transactions that should appear on the statements. To create statements, click the Statements icon on the Home page or choose Customers | Create Statements from the menu bar. QuickBooks displays the Create Statements window (see Figure 5-7).
CHAPT ER
MANAGING
ACCOUNTS
RECEIVABLE
137
FIGURE 5-7
the From date, and includes individual lines for each transaction created within the date range. You should set the day after the last date of your last statement run as the starting date. If you do monthly statements, choose the first and last days of the current month for the date range. If you send statements quarterly, enter the first and last dates of the current quarterand so on. If you choose All Open Transactions As Of Statement Date, the printed statement shows only unpaid invoices and statement charges and unapplied credits. You can reduce the number of transactions that appear on the statement if you select Include Only Transactions Over X Days Past Due Date, where X is a number of days you specify.
138
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Click OK when you have selected all the appropriate customers. If youre sending a statement to one customer only, select One Customer, and open the list box to choose the customer. You can also select customers by customer type. Finally, you can choose customers based on the preferred send method you established in each customers record. Click the Preferred Send Method option, and then select the send method for this batch from the drop-down list that appears:
E-mail
Sends the statements by e-mail, using the QuickBooks e-mail services feature. Mail Sends the statements to QuickBooks services, a fee-based service, where the statement is created with a tear-off slip that the customer can return with payment. QuickBooks mails the invoice. None Means no special handling. You print the statements, put them in envelopes, and mail them.
T I P : After you select customers using any of the methods described earlier, you can click the View Selected Customers button to display a list of customers for whom QuickBooks will produce statements.
that customer jobs for, or you can print a separate statement for each job. You can opt to show invoice item details instead of listing one line for each invoice on the statement. If your invoices have a lot of line items, this could make your statements very long. Printing statements in order by ZIP code is handy if youre printing labels sorted by ZIP code. This option is also important if you use a bulk mail permit, because the post office requires bulk mail to be sorted by ZIP code. By default, QuickBooks displays the original due date for each transaction on the statement. However, you can choose not to print this information. You can skip producing statements for customers who meet the criteria you set in the Do Not Create Statements section of the window. For example, you may not want to send statements to customers with $0 balances.
CHAPT ER
MANAGING
ACCOUNTS
RECEIVABLE
139
FIGURE 5-8
140
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Use the Zoom In button (which changes to the Zoom Out button after you click it) to see the statement and its contents close up. Click the Next Page button to move through all the statements. Click Close to redisplay the Create Statements window.
Chapter 6 Chapter 6
n this chapter:
Understanding the vendor center Entering vendor bills Entering item purchases Using purchase orders Entering vendor credit memos Entering recurring bills
141
142
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
QuickBooks can help you track and pay bills in a timely fashion. You can enter bills that affect accounts, such as utility bills, and you can enter bills for items (inventory and noninventory) and services you purchase. If appropriate, you can assign portions of bills to customers as reimbursable expenses. You also can use purchase orders to help track items you order. In this chapter, youll learn how to handle all these tasks and more. Youll also learn how to account for vendor credits, create recurring bills to reduce the data entry work of entering bills, and manage mileage costs.
As you can see in Figure 6-1, the layout of the Vendor Center window is easy to understand and navigate.
The left pane of the Vendor Center has two tabs: Vendors and Transactions. The Vendors tab actually replaces the Vendor List used in earlier versions of QuickBooks. As you click any Vendor on the Vendors tab, QuickBooks displays transactions for that vendor on the right side of the screen. You can limit the transactions to a specific type to make the search easier, and you can filter the transactions. Your filtering choices depend on the type of transaction you select in the Show List box. To narrow the search further, select a date range. The Transactions tab (see Figure 6-2) lists all your vendor-related transactions, and you can use this tab to find a particular transaction or transactions using criteria you specify. On the left side of the screen, select the transaction type for which you are searching. Then, use the Filter By and Date List boxes to narrow the search. You can use the toolbar buttons in the Vendor Center window and the links in the right pane of the Vendors tab to open transaction windows and produce reports. You can customize the Vendor Center by resizing any of its panes. To resize a pane, move the mouse pointer over the edge of any pane; the mouse pointer changes to a vertical or horizontal bar with pointing arrows attached. Drag the pane left or right (up or down) to change its size. The other pane(s) will adjust to fill the space.
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
143
FIGURE 6-1
The Vendors tab provides a robust way of finding information about a specific vendor.
In addition, you can choose the columns that QuickBooks displays in the Vendor List by right-clicking the list. QuickBooks then displays a context menu. Choose Customize Columns.
T I P : Click the Show Full List Only button (its the arrow that appears beside the View List box on the Vendors tab) to make the Vendor list fill the entire Vendor Center window.
144
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 6-2
N O T E : A quick reminder: You established your terms with your vendor when
you set up the vendor in QuickBooks. Youll find the details in Chapter 2.
To enter your bills, click Enter Bills in the Vendor section of the Home page or choose New Transactions | Enter Bills from the Vendor Center. When the Enter Bills window opens (see Figure 6-3), fill out the information from the bill you received. The window has two sections: the top of the window, generally referred to as the Header section, contains information about the vendor and the bill, and the bottom of the window, generally called the Details section, records the information related to your general ledger accounts. The Details section has two tabs: Expenses and Items. In this section, Ill cover bills that you record using the Expenses tab. Ill discuss entering bills using the Items tab later in this chapter in the section, Managing Item Purchases.
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
145
FIGURE 6-3
Depending on the bill, you may be able to assign the entire bill to one expense account, or you may have to split the bill among multiple expense accounts. For example, your utility bills are usually posted to the appropriate utility account (electric, heat, and so on). However, you typically split credit card bills among numerous expenses, and loan repayments between interest (an expense account) and principal (a liability account).
N O T E : If the vendor isnt on the list, choose <Add New> to add this vendor
to your QuickBooks Vendor List.
Now fill out the rest of the bill as follows: Enter the bill date. In the Bill Due field, QuickBooks fills in the due date automatically, based on the terms you set up with this vendor. You can change this date if you wish.
N O T E : If you didnt set up terms for this vendor, QuickBooks fills in the due
date automatically using the default number of days (ten) for paying bills. You can change the default by choosing Edit | Preferences and then clicking Bills on the left side of the Preferences dialog box.
146
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Enter the vendors invoice number in the Ref. No. field. Enter the amount due.
T I P : You can enter the amount in the Amount Due field (step 3) or in the Amount column (step 5). QuickBooks fills in the field in which you made no entry.
In the Terms field, click the list box arrow to display a list of terms and select the terms that reflect your agreement with your vendor. QuickBooks changes the due date to reflect the terms.
N O T E : If you dont see the terms you have with this vendor, choose <Add
New> to create a new Terms entry.
In the Details section on the Expenses tab, click the Account column, and then click the arrow that appears to display your chart of accounts. Select the account to which you want to assign this bill. QuickBooks automatically assigns the amount you entered in the Amount Due field to the Amount column.
T I P : You can set preferences so QuickBooks learns the account you choose most often for the selected vendor. Choose Edit | Preferences and click the General category. Then, on the My Preferences tab, check the Automatically Remember Account Or Transaction Information checkbox and select the Prefill Accounts For Vendor Based On Past Entries option.
If you wish, enter a note in the Memo column. In the Customer:Job column, enter a customer or job if youre paying a bill you want to track for job costing, or if this bill is a reimbursable expense. See the Handling Reimbursable Expenses section later in this chapter for details. If youre tracking classes, a Class column appears. Enter the appropriate class. When youre finished, click Save & New to save this bill and display another blank Enter Bills window. When youve entered all your bills, click Save & Close.
N O T E : Although I mention that you can split credit card expenses among
accounts, you use this approach only if you dont use the Credit Card account type to track credit card expenses. For a full treatment of tracking credit card expenses, see Chapter 11.
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
147
FIGURE 6-4
Record a line on the Expenses tab for each account in the general ledger affected by the bill.
Heres how to split a bill among multiple general ledger accounts: Complete steps 1 through 4 in the preceding section. On the first line of the Expenses tab, click the Account column to display the arrow you use to see your chart of accounts and select the first account to which you want to assign some portion of this bill. Type the amount you want to assign to the account you selected. On a new line of the Expenses tab, repeat steps 2 and 3 until you have entered all the lines needed to sum the total of the bill. As you add each additional line to the bill, QuickBooks updates the Amount column on the Expenses tab with the total remaining amount based on the amount you entered in the Amount Due field in the header section. This updating process provides you with a visual cue if the last line item does not make the total of the line items match the amount of the bill (see Figure 6-4).
148
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
can coincide, they dont always happen at the same time. Its certainly possible for the bill to arrive after the items, and sometimes the bill comes before the items. In this section, Ill go over all three situations. In addition, some companies like to start the process of purchasing items using a purchase order. Ill start this section by showing you how to use the purchase order feature in QuickBooks. To use the Inventory and Purchase Order features, you must enable them. Choose Edit | Preferences to open the Preferences dialog box (see Figure 6-5). Then, click the Items & Inventory category, click the Company Preferences tab, and check the Inventory And Purchase Orders Are Active box and the Warn About Duplicate Purchase Order Numbers box. I suggest you also check the rest of the boxes and select the When The Quantity I Want To Sell Exceeds The Quantity Available option. Selecting the When The Quantity I Want To Sell Exceeds The Quantity On Hand option tells QuickBooks to warn you if you try to sell more than you have in stock. Selecting the When The Quantity I Want To Sell Exceeds The Quantity Available option tells QuickBooks to also consider items on sales orders and items reserved for assemblies along with quantity on hand when warning you.
T I P : When you enable the Inventory and Purchase Order features, QuickBooks creates a nonposting account named Purchase Orders. You can double-click the accounts listing to view and drill down into the purchase orders youve entered, but the data in the register has no effect on your finances and doesnt appear in financial reports.
FIGURE 6-5
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
149
T I P : You can automatically create a purchase order when you create a sales order or estimate involving items. This handy feature saves you the data entry time of creating a sales order and then retyping the same information in the Create Purchase Orders window. To create the purchase order, open the sales order transaction, click the arrow to the right of the Create Invoice icon on the toolbar and select Purchase Orders.
Heres how to create a purchase order: Choose Purchase Orders on the Home page, or choose New Transactions | Purchase Orders from the Vendor Center to open a blank Create Purchase Orders window. Fill in the Purchase Order fields, which are easy and self-explanatory (see Figure 6-6).
FIGURE 6-6
150
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
T I P : If youre purchasing something on behalf of the customer, select the customer or job in the Customer column, and QuickBooks will treat the line as a reimbursable expense when you enter the vendors bill for this purchase order. See Chapter 18 for details on handling reimbursable expenses.
Click Save & New to save the purchase order and move on to the next blank purchase order form, or click Save & Close if you have created all the purchase orders you need right now. You can print the purchase orders as you create them by clicking the Print button as soon as you complete a purchase order. Or, you can print them all in a batch make sure a check appears in the To Be Printed box on each purchase order. Then, enter all your purchase orders and, just before you save the last one, click the arrow to the right of the Print button and select Print Batch, or save all of the purchase orders and choose File | Print Forms | Purchase Orders. QuickBooks displays the Select Purchase Orders To Print dialog box, where you can remove purchase orders from the batch by clicking them. When youre ready to print, click OK. You can also e-mail the purchase orders as you create them, or as a batch by selecting Send Batch from the drop-down list next to the E-mail icon on the toolbar in the Create Purchase Orders window. If you intend to e-mail purchase orders in a batch, be sure to check the To Be E-Mailed box on each purchase order you intend to include in the batch.
T I P : Many companies dont send physical purchase orders. Instead, they create the purchase order and then provide the vendor with the purchase order number when placing the order over the telephone, via e-mail, or by logging in to the vendors Internet-based order system.
When you order something from a vendor and receive less than you ordered, QuickBooks tracks the backordered items and displays the Backordered column in the Create Purchase Orders window, the Create Item Receipts window, and the Enter Bills window. You can track open purchase orders using the Open Purchase Orders report and the Open Purchase Orders by Job report. You can print both reports by choosing Reports | Purchases and then clicking the appropriate report. When you receive the items and the bill, you can use the purchase order to automatically create the appropriate transactions in QuickBooks. In each of the following cases, the windows and your actions change slightly if you use a purchase order to create a transaction. As I explain how to enter these transactions, Ill describe the differences between using and not using a purchase order.
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
151
C A U T I O N : If the items and the bill arrive at the same time, dont use the steps in this section or the next section. Instead, refer to Receiving Items and Bills Simultaneously later in this chapter.
Follow these steps: Choose New Transactions | Receive Items from the Vendor Center or choose Receive Inventory | Receive Inventory Without Bill on the Home page. QuickBooks displays a blank Create Item Receipts window (see Figure 6-7). Enter the vendor name, and if open purchase orders exist for this vendor, QuickBooks will notify you.
Ill 6-1
If you know there isnt a purchase order for this particular shipment, click No, and fill out the Create Item Receipts window manually. Click the Item column to select an item, supply the quantity you received, fill in a cost, if necessary and, if appropriate, assign the line to a customer to make the receipt a reimbursable expense. If a purchase order exists, click Yes. QuickBooks displays all the open purchase orders for this vendor (see Figure 6-8).
Place a check beside the appropriate purchase order(s) and click OK. QuickBooks fills in the Create Item Receipts window using the information on the purchase order (see Figure 6-9). Check the shipment against the purchase order and change any quantities that dont match.
T I P : You can click the Select PO button to redisplay the Select Purchase Order dialog box and add other purchase orders for the selected vendor to the Create Item Receipts window. You can click the Show PO button to display the purchase order associated with the last line shown in the Create Item Receipts window.
152
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 6-8
Click Save & New to receive the next shipment into inventory, or click Save & Close if youve finished receiving goods. QuickBooks posts the amounts recorded on the purchase order to your Inventory and Accounts Payable account, although no bill shows up as available for payment when you pay bills. The entry to the Accounts Payable account is not a typical method for handling receipt of goods before a bill arrives, but, ultimately, the accounting entries QuickBooks makes are correct. (Ill explain what QuickBooks does in the section, Behind the Scenes, later in this chapter.)
FIGURE 6-7
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
153
FIGURE 6-9
When you receive items against a purchase order, QuickBooks fills in the purchase order information for you.
C A U T I O N : If the bill and the items arrive simultaneously, dont use the steps in this section or the preceding section. Instead, refer to the Receiving Items and Bills Simultaneously section later in this chapter.
To enter the bill, follow these steps: Choose New Transactions | Enter Bill For Received Items to open the Select Item Receipt window. QuickBooks displays the Select Item Receipt window, shown in Figure 6-10. Select the vendor, and QuickBooks displays the current items receipt information for the vendor. Select the appropriate item and click OK. QuickBooks opens the Enter Bills window (see Figure 6-11) and fills it in using the information from the item receipt. Change anything that needs to be changed. For example, the bill may specify a different cost per unit than the purchase order contained. Or, the bill may contain taxes and shipping costs that didnt appear on the purchase order
154
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 6-10
Use this window to select the Item Receipt for which you have now received a bill.
which you can record on the Expenses tab. If you make any changes, click the Recalculate button so QuickBooks can match the total in the Amount Due field to the changed line item data. Click Save & Close. QuickBooks displays a message asking if youre sure you want to save the changes. Click Yes, and QuickBooks replaces the original entry to Accounts Payable made when you received the items with the updated bill information.
FIGURE 6-11
QuickBooks fills in this window with information from an Item Receipt transaction.
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
155
FYI
156
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
QuickBooks displays the Enter Bills window you saw previously in Figure 6-11. When you select the vendors name, a message appears if open purchase orders exist for the vendor, asking if you want to receive goods and record a bill against an open purchase order. If you click No, QuickBooks displays an empty Enter Bills window. On the Items tab, fill in the items that arrived using the cost information shown on the bill. Click Save & Close to save the transaction. If you click Yes, QuickBooks displays the Open Purchase Orders window shown earlier in this chapter in Figure 6-8. From this window, select the appropriate purchase order and click OK. QuickBooks fills in the Enter Bills window using the line items on the purchase order. Correct any quantity or price difference between your original purchase order and the bill. When you save the transaction, QuickBooks receives the items into inventory in addition to posting the bill to A/P.
QuickBooks makes this entry even if you use the Create Item Receipts window to receive items without recording a bill for the items. QuickBooks assigns a transaction type of ITEM RCPT to these transactions to track them, and you can see them in the Accounts Payable register. To view the Accounts Payable register, double-click your Accounts Payable account in the Chart Of Accounts window. When you enter the bill that arrived separately from the items, QuickBooks does not record a new transaction in the Accounts Payable register. Instead, QuickBooks changes the transaction type of the Item Receipt entry in the Accounts Payable register from ITEM RCPT to BILL. If you made changes to any amounts when you recorded the bill, QuickBooks replaces the original amounts with the updated amounts. This practice ensures you dont have duplicate entries for the same vendor transaction.
C A U T I O N : If you first enter an Item Receipt from a vendor and then try to use the Enter Bills command to enter the bill from the vendor, QuickBooks warns you that pending Item Receipts exist for the vendor and instructs you to use the Enter Bill for Received Items if youre trying to record a bill for items you received previously. You should not ignore this message. If the bill you want to enter is indeed for items you already received into QuickBooks, using the wrong command will result in double entries for the same amount in your Accounts Payable account.
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
157
FIGURE 6-12
158
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If the credit is not for items, use the Expenses tab to assign an account and amount to this credit. If the credit is for items, use the Items tab to enter the items, along with the quantity and cost, for which you are receiving this credit. Entering inventory items on a credit reduces the quantity on hand for those items. Click Save & Close to save the credit.
N O T E : If youve agreed that the vendor pays the shipping costs to return
items, dont forget to enter that amount in the Expenses tab.
The following are the entries QuickBooks makes to your general ledger when you save a vendor credit:
Account Inventory Asset Applicable expense account(s) Accounts Payable Total credit amount Debit Credit Amount of returned items Amount of expenses in the credit
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
159
Ill 6-2
You can make the following choices when you complete the Memorize Transaction window:
Use the Name field to enter a name for the transaction. QuickBooks
automatically enters the vendor name, but you can change it. Use a name that describes the transaction so you dont have to rely on your memory.
FIGURE 6-13
160
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
C A U T I O N : Reminders appear only if youve enabled reminders in QuickBooks. Choose Edit | Preferences and click the Reminders category icon to view or change Reminders options.
Choose one of these options to specify how QuickBooks should handle
entering the memorized bill: a. Select Remind Me (the default) to tell QuickBooks to remind you when you open your company that you need to enter this bill. b. Select Dont Remind Me if you want to enter the bill without being reminded. c. Select Automatically Enter to have QuickBooks enter this bill automatically, without reminders. If you chose Remind Me, you have the following additional options to set.
From the How Often list, select the interval for this bill. Enter the Next Date this bill is due.
If you chose Automatically Enter, you can set the same options as if you had chosen Remind Me, along with the following additional options:
If you plan to pay this bill a finite number of timesloans fall into this
categoryuse the Number Remaining field to specify how many times QuickBooks should pay this bill. Specify the number of Days In Advance To Enter this bill into the system. At the appropriate time, the bill appears in the Select Bills To Pay List you use to pay your bills (covered in Chapter 7). Click OK to save the memorized bill. Then, click Save & Close in the Enter Bills window to save the bill.
T I P : If you created the bill only for the purpose of creating a memorized transaction and you dont want to enter the bill into the system for payment at this time, after you save the memorized transaction, close the Enter Bills window using the Close button in the top right corner, and respond No when QuickBooks asks if you want to save the transaction.
C HAPT ER
ENTERING
ACCOUNTS
PAYA B L E
BILLS
161
Ill 6-3
Double-click the appropriate listing to open the bill in the usual Enter Bills window with the next due date showing. If the amount is blank, fill it in and click Save & Close. QuickBooks saves the bill. It will appear in the list of bills that must be paid when you write checks to pay your bills. (See Chapter 7 for information about paying bills.)
162
Ill 6-4
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Open the Group Name list and select the group you just created. Click OK and repeat these steps for each bill you want to add to the group. In the future, you can assign new memorized bills to this group as you create each new memorized bill by selecting the With Transactions In Group option and choosing the group.
Chapter 7 Chapter 7
Paying Bills
n this chapter:
Choosing bills to pay Applying discounts and credits Writing checks Making direct disbursements Setting up sales tax payments
163
164
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
The expression writing checks doesnt have to be taken literally. You can let QuickBooks do the writing part by buying computer checks and printing them. Except for signing the check, QuickBooks can do all the work and save you considerable time.
FIGURE 7-1
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
165
You can double-click any entry to see the line items of the original bill you entered. You can filter the report to display only certain bills if you click Modify Report and change the settings on the Filters tab. For example, you might want to:
Filter for bills due today (or previously), eliminating bills due after today. Filter for bills that are more or less than a certain amount. Filter for bills that are more than a certain number of days overdue.
FIGURE 7-2
166
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Option
Purpose
Due On Or Before
Displays all the bills due within ten days by default, but you can change the date to an earlier or later date. If your vendors offer discounts for timely payments, this selection is more important than it seems, because the due date isnt the same as the discount date. Consider a bill with terms of 2% 10 Net 30 that is dated April 2. It is due on May 2 and wont appear on the list if the due date filter you select is April 30, even though the discount date is April 12. If you want to use a due date filter, go out at least 60 days. (See the section, Applying Discounts, later in this chapter.) Shows all the outstanding bills in your QuickBooks company, regardless of when theyre due. This is the safest option because you wont accidentally miss a discount date if the list is long. This field appears only if you have multiple A/P accounts. Select the account to which the bills you want to pay were originally posted. If you dont have multiple A/P accounts, this field doesnt appear in the window. Determines the order in which QuickBooks displays your bills in the Pay Bills window. The choices are Due Date (the default), Discount Date, Vendor, and Amount Due. Displays the available methods of payment: Check and Credit Card appear by default, but if youve signed up for QuickBooks online bill payment services, that payment method also appears in the list. If you are printing your checks, be sure to select the To Be Printed option. If youre writing checks manually, select Assign Check No., and when you finish selecting bills to pay, QuickBooks opens the Assign Check Numbers dialog so you can specify the starting check number. The checking or credit card account you want to use to pay these bills. The date that appears on your checks. By default, the current date appears in the field, but if you want to predate or postdate your checks, you can change that date. If you merely select the bills today and wait until tomorrow (or later) to print the checks, the payment date set here still appears on the checks. You can tell QuickBooks to use today as the date on checks by changing the Checking Preferences.
A/P Account
Sort Bills By
Payment Method
TABLE 7-1
plan to pay right now, you can just select the ones you do want to pay by clicking the leftmost column to place a check mark in it.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
167
the Select All Bills button changes its name to Clear Selections. When you pay all bills in full, QuickBooks makes the following entries in your general ledger:
Account Accounts Payable Bank Debit Total bill payments Total bill payments Credit
QuickBooks doesnt make any entries to expense accounts when you pay bills because QuickBooks made those entries when you entered the bills. You only need to update expense accounts if you dont enter a bill but instead write a check. (This process is described later in the chapter in the Using Direct Disbursements Section.)
FIGURE 7-3
168
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
When QuickBooks enters the transaction in the general ledger, QuickBooks posts the amount of the payment as a debit to the Accounts Payable account and as a credit to your bank account; the unpaid balance of the bill remains in the Accounts Payable account.
Applying Discounts
Bills with discounts for timely payment display the Discount Date in the Disc. Date column. If you dont see a date in the Disc. Date column, the bill has no discount associated with it (see Figure 7-4). Select the bill by clicking the check mark column, and the discount will be automatically applied. You can see the amount in the Disc. Used column, and the Amt. To Pay column adjusts accordingly as long as the date in the Due On Or Before field is equal to, or earlier than, the discount date. If QuickBooks doesnt apply the discount automatically, check your preferences. If you want QuickBooks to apply discounts and credit automatically, choose Edit | Preferences, click the Bills category on the left, and, on the Company Preferences tab, check the Automatically Use Discounts And Credits checkbox. Also select a Default Discount Account and click OK.
FIGURE 7-4
Youll see dates in the Disc. Date column for bills that offer discounts for timely payment.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
169
T I P : If the deadline for the discount has passed, you can still take the discountsee the next section, Taking Discounts After the Discount Date.
If youre making a partial payment and want to adjust the discount, click the Set Discount button to open the Discount And Credits window, and then enter the amount of the discount you want to take. Click Done to redisplay the Pay Bills window, where QuickBooks has applied the discount and adjusted the Amt. To Pay column.
Ill 7-1
170
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If the only vendors who offer discounts are those from whom you buy inventory items, consider putting the discount account in the section of your chart of accounts that holds the Cost Of Goods Sold accounts. The following shows what QuickBooks posts to your general ledger when you take a discount. Suppose the original amount of the bill was $484.00, the discount was $9.68, and the check amount was $474.32. Remember that QuickBooks originally posted the bill for the total amount without considering the discount.
Account Accounts Payable Bank Discounts Taken Debit $484.00 $474.32 $9.68 Credit
Applying Credits
If you click a bill in the Pay Bills window, youll see available credits in the Total Credits Available field below the list of unpaid bills. If you have set Bill preferences (choose Edit | Preferences, click the Bills icon, and click the Company Preferences tab) to automatically apply credits and you select any bill from a vendor for whom credits exist, QuickBooks automatically applies the credit(s). The amount of the credit appears in the Credits Used column, and QuickBooks adjusts the Amt. To Pay column (see Figure 7-5).
FIGURE 7-5
QuickBooks can automatically apply outstanding credits when you pay bills.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
171
If you havent set preferences to automatically apply credits, or if you dont want to take the credit, click Set Credits to open the Discount And Credits window. Make the appropriate changes and click Done to change the Amt. To Pay column to reflect your adjustments. If your total credits with the vendor are equal to, or exceed, the bill(s) you select, QuickBooks displays a message telling you no check will be created, because the entire bill is paid with credits. Its possible youll have several bills to pay from one vendor and a credit you can use to pay one bill entirely. If you choose to use the credit to completely pay one bill, you may want to inform the vendor you took this action since the check you send wont include any reference to the bill paid entirely by a vendor credit. To inform the vendor that youre paying a bill using a credit, you can print the history of the bill and include it with the payment. To print a bills history, display the bill in the Enter Bills windowyou can find the bill in the Vendor Centerand then click the History button to display a record of how the bill was paid. When QuickBooks displays the bills history, click Print. Alternatively, spread the credit out among the vendors bills so no bill is entirely paid by credit. That solution will be apparent to your vendor without any other effort on your part, or you can print the History report for the credit, which will list all the bills it paid.
172
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If you selected the To Be Printed option, the Assign Check Numbers dialog box doesnt appear. Regardless of the option you selected, QuickBooks displays the Payment Summary window, which lists the checks you created in the Pay Bills window. From the Payment Summary window, you can click:
Pay More Bills to continue paying bills. Print Checks to start the process of printing checks if you opted to print
checks. (For more information on printing checks, see the upcoming section, Printing Checks.) Done.
Ill 7-3
QuickBooks also transfers all the information about the checks you created to the general ledger, and records the payments in your checkbook account register or credit card account register. You can see those checks in the bank account register (see Figure 7-6)press CTRL+R or click the Register icon on the Icon Bar and select the bank account. If you chose the Assign Check No. option, the checks appear with the numbers you assigned. If you selected the To Be Printed option, your bank account register displays To Print as the check number. (See the upcoming section, Printing Checks, for more information.)
T I P : If you pay bills online, QuickBooks records the payment information in the register using SEND as the check number and then retains the payment information until you go online.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
173
FIGURE 7-6
Checks you intend to print for bills you paid appear in your checking account register.
Printing Checks
Printing your checks is far easier and faster than using manual checks, and it leaves less room for error. Before you can print, however, you have some preliminary tasks to take care of. You must purchase computer checks and set up your printer.
174
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Office supply stores, such as Staples, Office Depot, Office Max, and others. Check with your bank. Some banks have a computer-check purchasing
arrangement with suppliers. If you purchase checks from any supplier except Intuit, make sure you tell them you use QuickBooks. All check makers know about QuickBooks and offer a line of checks designed to work perfectly with the software. Computer checks come in several varieties (and in a wide range of colors and designs). For QuickBooks, you can order any of the following check types:
Plain checks Checks with stubs on which QuickBooks prints information Checks with special stubs for current check and year-to-date information about
FIGURE 7-7
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
175
These checks are the same width as standard checks, but they have a detachable section at the bottom of the check. QuickBooks prints voucher information if you use voucher checks, including the name of the payee, the date, and the individual amounts of the bills being paid by this check. Standard checks These checks are the width of a regular #10 business envelope. Laser printer checks come three to a page. Checks for a dot matrix pinfeed printer come on a continuous sheet with perforations separating the checks. Wallet checks These checks are narrower than the other two check styles. The paper size is the same as the other checks, but theres a perforation on the left edge of the check, so you can tear off the check.
Adding a Logo
If your checks have no preprinted logo and you have a digital file of your company logo, select the Use Logo option or click the Logo button to open the Logo dialog box. Click the File button to locate the digital file, which must be a bitmapped graphic (the file extension is .bmp).
C A U T I O N : Dot matrix printers cant handle graphics printing, so dont bother choosing a logo if youre using a dot matrix printer for your checks.
You can check the Print Company Name And Address checkbox, but when you buy checks, that information is preprinted.
Changing Fonts
Click the Fonts tab in the Printer Setup window to choose different fonts for the check information, such as the spelled-out amounts or the payees address block. Click the appropriate button and then choose a font, a font style, and a size from the dialog that opens.
C A U T I O N : Before you change fonts, make a note of the current settings. No Reset or Default button exists in the Fonts tab. If you make changes and they dont work properly, knowing the original settings will get you back to where you started quickly and easily.
176
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 7-8
The Partial Page solution is based on the way your printer handles envelopes.
T I P : Voucher checks for laser and inkjet printers are one to a page, so you dont have to worry about using remaining checks on a page.
Click OK in the Printer Setup window to save the check printing setup information. Now, youre ready to print your checks.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
177
By default, QuickBooks selects all the unprinted checks. The first time you print checks, the First Check Number field displays 1. Replace that number with the first check number you intend to print. After you select checks to print and establish the first check number, click OK to open the Print Checks window (shown previously in Figure 7-7). If you use a laser or inkjet printer and either standard or wallet checks, fill in the Number Of Checks On First Page box on the Settings tab. If you indicate there are three checks on the page, printing starts with the checks in the standard letter tray.
FYI
T I P : When you send sample checks, be sure to write the word VOID across
the check.
178
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
QuickBooks asks you to confirm that the checks printed properly before updating your company data file with the check number information. If everything printed fine, click OK. If anything untoward happened, click the number(s) of the problematic check(s) and click OK. Place more checks in the printer and choose File | Print Forms | Checks. Your unprinted checks appear once again in the Select Checks To Print dialog box, and QuickBooks increments the first check number to the next available check number. Repeat the printing process to print your checks.
N O T E : You should not use either the register or the Write Checks window to
write a check that pays a bill, because neither method associates the check with the outstanding bill. Stated another way, youll mess up your payables if you try to pay a bill using either of the following methods.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
179
FIGURE 7-9
The QuickBooks bank account register looks like your checkbook register.
When the account register opens, you can enter the check on a transaction line: Enter the date. Press the TAB key to move to the Number field. QuickBooks automatically fills in the next available check number.
T I P : If you intend to print this check, type T and press TAB. QuickBooks
replaces the check number with To Print.
Press TAB to move through the rest of the fields, filling in the name of the payee, the amount of the payment, and the expense account youre assigning to the transaction. Click the Record button to save the transaction. Repeat the steps for the next check and continue until all the manual checks youve written are entered into the register. If you want to assign a check to more than one expense account, click the Splits button. QuickBooks changes the appearance of the register (see Figure 7-10). In the Account box on the second line of the checks register entry, -split- appears. QuickBooks also displays lines where you can assign more than one account to the check. In this new area, select the appropriate accounts and fill in the amount for each account. QuickBooks enters the total for the check in the Payment column on the first line of the checks register entry. Click Close when you finish making account assignments.
180
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 7-10
When you need to assign a check to more than one account, click the Splits button.
FIGURE 7-11
The Write Checks window looks like a check you would write by hand
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
181
QuickBooks automatically fills in the next available check number unless you check the To Be Printed box. If the box is checked, click it to remove the check mark and type the check number. QuickBooks warns you if you enter a check number thats already been used when you try to save the check. Select a name from the Pay To The Order Of list; QuickBooks checks to determine whether outstanding bills exist for the payee:
If outstanding bills exist, QuickBooks displays the Open Bills Exist window
which lists the outstanding bills for the selected vendor. If youre trying to pay one of those bills, click the Go To Pay Bills button, and QuickBooks will open the correct window to use for paying bills (see the section, Selecting the Bills to Pay, earlier in this chapter for details on paying bills). If you want to write a check to the selected vendor that doesnt pay an outstanding bill, click the Continue Writing Check button and continue filling out the bottom area of the Write Checks window as described in the next paragraph. If no outstanding bills exist for the payee, you can fill in the bottom area of the Write Checks window. You can use the Items tab if youre writing a check for items or the Expenses tab to assign the check directly to an expense account. When you fill in the amount in the bottom portion of the check, QuickBooks updates the amountboth numerical and writtenin the top portion of the check. You can use more than one line in the bottom of the window to record the purpose of more than one kind of item or to split the check between accounts. When you finish, click Save & New to open a new blank check. When youre through writing checks, click Save & Close to close the Write Checks window. Any checks you write in this window also appear in the bank account register.
182
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Make sure that number agrees with the number of the check youre loading in the printer, and then click OK. QuickBooks displays the Print Checks window. Follow the instructions for printing described earlier in this chapter. When QuickBooks redisplays the Write Checks window, click Save & New to write another quick check, or click Save & Close if youre finished printing checks.
N O T E : You cannot print checks directly from the register, but you can print
them in batches. (See the next section.)
T I P : You can use the Print button in the register to print the register, but not checks in the register.
window, and then choose Print Batch. Regardless of the method you choose, QuickBooks displays the Select Checks To Print window, shown earlier in this chapter in the section, Printing Checks. Follow the directions in that section to complete the process.
If you split the check among multiple accounts, QuickBooks posts multiple debitsone for the sum of the amount posted to each expense accountso the debits equal the credit.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
183
Watch a video on setting up sales taxes in QuickBooks Set Sales Tax Preferences Print sales tax reports Pay your sales tax liability
184
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
You will need additional sales tax codes if your sales taxing authorities require that you report on sales in other categories besides taxable and non-taxable. In this case, create codes that match the reporting categories required by your taxing authorities. You can assign one sales tax code to every customer and one sales tax code to every item. QuickBooks uses the codes to determine whether to charge sales tax for each item and each customer. Even if a customer pays sales tax, you dont necessarily charge sales tax for every item the customer buys, because some items arent taxable. Similarly, you dont charge sales tax if a sales tax-exempt customer buys a taxable item. You may need additional sales tax codes for nontaxable customers, because some states want to know why a nontaxable customer doesnt pay sales tax. For example, do the rules in your state indicate that you dont have to collect taxes for out-ofstate sales, nonprofit organizations, or government agencies? If your state wants to know the breakdown of nontaxable sales, you should create tax codes for each category of nontaxable sales to match the reporting needs of the taxing authorities in your jurisdiction. For taxable customers, you may want to use tax codes to identify out-of-state customers from whom you collect sales tax if you remit taxes to a customers state taxing authority. In some states, the customers residence determines the tax rate the customer pays. In other states, the location of the business selling the item determines the tax rate the customer pays. You dont handle these scenarios with sales tax codes because the codes dont determine the tax rate. Instead, you use sales tax items, which Ill discuss later in this chapter. Some states have multiple tax rates, where a portion of the sales tax you charge belongs to the state and another portion belongs to a local taxing authoritya city or a county. In some cases, you may need to remit sales tax to the state, the county, and the city. Again, you dont use sales tax codes to handle these situations. Instead, you use sales tax items and sales tax groups for these situations. Ill also discuss sales tax groups later in this chapter. If you need to create codes to track customer sales tax status in a manner more detailed than taxable and nontaxable, follow these steps to add a new sales tax code: Choose Lists | Sales Tax Code List. Press CTRL+N to open the New Sales Tax Code window.
Ill 7-5
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
185
Enter the name of the new code, using up to three characters. Enter a description to make it easier to interpret the code. Select Taxable if youre creating a code to track taxable sales, or Nontaxable if youre entering a code to trace nontaxable sales. Click Next to set up another tax code. Click OK when youve finished adding tax codes. If your taxing authorities require that you break down nontaxable sales, use sales tax codes. You might consider creating the following sales tax codes:
NPO for nonprofit organizations GOV for government agencies WSL for wholesale businesses OOS for out-of-state customers if you arent required to collect taxes from outof-state customers
For taxable customers, the permutations and combinations are much broader. If youre required to collect and remit sales tax for some additional states, just create codes for customers in those states using the postal abbreviations for each state. Sales tax codes alone dont handle taxable customers. You may also need to assign a sales tax item to the customer. Im going to save sales tax items for later in this chapter and finish covering the rest of the preferences you set for sales tax tracking.
Check with your taxing authority (the payee for the check you write when you remit the sales tax you collected) and your accountant to identify the method you need to select. The method is dictated by your state and has nothing to do with your own tax reporting status. Then, choose Edit | Preferences, click the Sales Tax tab, and click the Company Preferences tab.
186
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
a specific period of time. If the sales tax authority notifies you that the frequency with which you must remit sales tax changes, dont forget to return to the Preferences dialog box to change the interval.
Follow these steps to create the new sales tax item: Select Sales Tax Item as the item type. In the Sales Tax Name box, enter a name for the item. Enter a description to describe this sales tax on your transaction forms.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
187
Enter the tax rate as a percentage. QuickBooks automatically adds the percent sign to the numbers you type (for instance, enter 6.5 if the rate is 6.5 percent). From the Tax Agency (the vendor you collect for) list, select the tax agency to whom you pay the tax. Click OK.
188
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If you remit your sales tax to one taxing authority, you can create one sales tax item for the combined amount7.5 percent in my exampleas long as you never need to report on the sales taxes separately, including at the end of the year. If, however, you need to report on the sales taxes separately at any time, then set up separate items and use a sales tax group to combine them. Sales tax reports in QuickBooks will break down the sales tax collected so you can report on each sales tax item, and QuickBooks calculates the total liability you owe to the sales tax vendor(s) correctly. To create a tax group, you must first create the individual tax items, and then use the following steps to create the group item: Open the Item List by Choosing Lists | Item List. Press CTRL+N to open the New Item dialog box. From the Type List, select Sales Tax Group. Enter a name for the sales tax group. Enter a description. This description appears on your sales forms. In the Tax Item column, choose the individual tax code items you need to create in this group. As you move to the next item, QuickBooks fills in the rate, the tax agency, and the description of each tax you already selected. The calculated total appears at the bottom of the dialog box (see Figure 7-12). When youve added all the required tax code items, click OK.
FIGURE 7-12
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
189
Select this item for the appropriate customers when youre creating sales transactions. If a different tax item exists on the customers record, QuickBooks will offer to replace the current sales tax item for the customer with the new sales tax group.
FIGURE 7-13
The Sales Tax Liability report breaks down sales tax into taxable and nontaxable sales.
190
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 7-14
The Sales Tax Revenue Summary report breaks down sales tax by sales tax code.
Select the bank account to use if you have more than one bank account. Check the date displayed in the field named Show Sales Tax Due Through. It must match the end date of your current reporting period.
CHAPTER
PAY I N G
BILLS
191
N O T E : QuickBooks doesnt ask for a start date because it uses the period
duration defined in your Sales Tax Preferences.
Click in the Pay column to insert a check mark next to those taxing authorities you want to pay. If youre going to print the check, select the To Be Printed checkbox. If you write the check manually, or if you remit sales tax online using an electronic transfer from your bank, remove the check mark from the To Be Printed checkbox. (For electronic payment, open the bank account register and change the check number QuickBooks inserts automatically to ACH or another code indicating an electronic transfer.) Click OK. The next time you print or write checks, the sales tax check appears in the Select Checks To Print dialog box.
Specify the amount by which to reduce or increase the tax amount. Specify an Adjustment Account, and click OK to return to the Pay Sales Tax window, where QuickBooks changes the amount due to reflect your adjustment.
Chapter 8 Chapter 8
Running Payroll
n this chapter:
Choosing a payroll service Setting up payroll Checking tax status, deductions, and other employee information Entering historical data Writing payroll checks
193
194
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If you plan to do your own payroll rather than employ a payroll service, the information you need to set up and run payroll is covered in this chapter. Much of the work for payroll involves setting up payroll. Once youve completed setupessentially a onetime taskyoull find that payroll tasks are quick and easy to complete.
comfortable filling out payroll tax forms by hand. Standard Payroll, which provides updated tax tables, automatic calculations of paycheck deductions and employer expenses, and automatic creation of federal forms (941, W-2, and so on). Enhanced Payroll, which adds state forms, electronic file and pay, workers compensation tracking, net-to-gross calculations. Assisted Payroll, which provides all the features of enhanced payroll, but turns the job of government filings and deposits over to Intuit. Enhanced Payroll For Accountants, which lets you prepare payroll for up to 50 companies and supports After-the-Fact data entry.
N O T E : If youre not a do-it-yourself type, you can sign up for Intuit Payroll
Services Complete Payroll Support, which is a full-service solution offered through Intuit. The service handles all your payroll needs. Visit http:// payroll.com/services/complete/index.html for more information.
QuickBooks does not make any calculations against the gross amount of the paycheck unless youve signed up for one of the QuickBooks payroll services. No withholding appears, QuickBooks doesnt post amounts to employee and employer liability accounts, and no net amount appears on the check. You can, if you wish, use the printed tax tables in the Employers Circular E from the IRS, calculate the deductions manually, and then issue a paycheck for the net amount to each employee. If you dont want to face that, you must sign up for payroll services.
With any of the payroll services, you can purchase direct deposit services for your employees. Employees must sign a form giving permission for direct deposit, and you can print those forms directly from QuickBooks. Employees can opt to deposit their entire paychecks into one bank account or split the amount between two bank accounts.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
195
FYI
To learn about or sign up for QuickBooks payroll offerings, choose Employees | Payroll | Learn About Payroll Options. QuickBooks opens its internal browser and takes you to the Payroll Solutions web site. Or, open your browser and visit http:// quickbooks.intuit.com/product/add-ons/payroll-software-and-services/. After youve used the links on the Payroll Solutions web site to learn about all the payroll offerings, click the Add To Cart link for the Payroll service you want. A wizard walks you through the enrollment process. You must enter information about your company and provide a credit card number. If you want to sign up for direct deposit, you also need your banks routing number and your bank account number. Follow the prompts in the ensuing windows, filling in information as required. When you complete the sign-up process, QuickBooks downloads and automatically installs the files you need to run payroll, including the most current tax table, onto the computer you used to sign up for payroll. After QuickBooks completes the process of installing payroll, your Employees menu has all the commands you need to run payroll.
If you need to run payroll on another computer, sit down at that computer and download a payroll update so that QuickBooks can install the tax updates needed for payroll onto that computer. To download a payroll update, choose Help | Update QuickBooks.
196
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
S E C U R I T Y N O T E : Users who do not have access permissions for Employee information do not see financial information when they open the Employee Center window.
The left pane of the Employee Center has three tabs: Employees, Transactions, and Payroll. The Employees tab, shown in Figure 8-1, replaces the Employee list used in earlier versions of QuickBooks. As you click any Employee on the Employees tab, QuickBooks displays transactions for that Employee on the right side of the screen. You can limit the transactions to a specific type to make the search easier, and you can filter the transactions by date range.
FIGURE 8-1
The Employees tab provides a robust way to find employee and transaction information about a specific employee.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
197
T I P : Click the Show Full List Only button (it appears beside the View list box on the Employees tab) to make the Employee list fill up the entire Employee Center window.
The Transactions tab (see Figure 8-2) lists all employee-related transactions. You can use this tab to find a particular transaction or transactions that meet certain criteria. On the left side of the screen, select the transaction type for which you are searching. Then, use the Date list box to narrow the search. If you are a Payroll subscriber, you can click the Payroll tab to see the Payroll Center (see Figure 8-3). On the left side of the Payroll Center is the status of your payroll subscription and a two-month calendar.
FIGURE 8-2
198
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 8-3
On the right side of the Payroll tab, you can produce paychecks, view details about the last set of paychecks you produced, view and pay payroll tax liabilities, and prepare payroll tax forms. Also, when you click the Learning Resources button, you will see commands that you can use to get payroll news and updates, visit payroll message boards, access tax tools and resources, contact Intuit Customer Service, or visit the IRS web site. Use the toolbar buttons in the Employee Center window and the links in the right pane of the Employees tab to open transaction windows and produce reports. You can customize the Employee Center by resizing any of its panes. To resize a pane, move the mouse pointer over the edge of any pane. The mouse pointer changes to a vertical (or horizontal) bar with pointing arrows attached. Drag the pane left or right (up or down) to change its size. The other pane(s) will adjust to fill the space. In addition, you can choose the columns that QuickBooks displays in the Employees List by right-clicking the list. QuickBooks will display a context menu. Choose Customize Columns.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
199
Vendors
The payroll process creates liabilities for payroll taxes and deductions that your company must pay. To be able to send the money you owe to the appropriate vendors, you must set up those vendors before you set up payroll items (discussed later in this chapter) so that you can assign the payroll items to the proper vendors. For withholding of federal income taxes, Medicare, FICA, and the matching employer Medicare and FICA payments, the vendor you use depends on the way you transmit the funds. If you use electronic transfer of funds, the vendor is the U.S. Treasury Department. If you use coupons, the vendor is your bank. For local and state income tax, unemployment, disability, workers comp, and deductions for benefits (such as health insurance), you must set up a vendor for each agency to which you send checks. Read Chapter 2 to learn how to add vendors to your company file.
Chart of Accounts
To support payroll processing, youll need, at a minimum, the following accounts in your chart of accounts:
A bank account for writing payroll checks or transferring direct deposit funds.
Many businesses maintain a separate payroll account. A payroll liabilities account to track the money you withhold from paychecks. A payroll expense account to track employer-related payroll expenses such as the employers share of Social Security and Medicare. QuickBooks automatically adds the payroll liabilities and employer-related payroll expense accounts when you enable payroll in your company file (either during the EasyStep Interview or in the Preferences dialog box). You can use one liability account and one expense account for all payroll entries, or create separate subaccounts for each type of liability/expense. Many accountants prefer to set up separate subaccounts for payroll to easily find balances associated with payroll liabilities and expenses on the Balance Sheet and the Profit & Loss report. If you use
200
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
one liability account and one expense account, you can identify your current outstanding balance for any payroll liability by viewing the Payroll Liability Balances report or the Payroll tab of the Employee Center.
FIGURE 8-4
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
201
QuickBooks displays each payroll schedule that you create on the Payroll tab of the Employee Center to remind you when payroll is due, but the value of the payroll schedule goes beyond serving as a reminder. In addition to creating the payroll schedule, you also assign one payroll schedule to each employee. Then, when you pay employees, you select a payroll schedule and QuickBooks creates paychecks only for the employees assigned to that schedule. You assign a payroll schedule to an employee when you enter or edit the employees information, described later in this chapter.
Payroll Items
A QuickBooks payroll item is any element that is part of a payroll check: the salary, wages, bonuses, and commissions that go into determining the gross amount of the payroll check, as well as the withheld taxes and deductions that determine the net amount of the payroll check. In addition, you need to set up company-paid benefits that dont deduct amounts from employee paychecks that are attached to payroll as payroll items. QuickBooks creates some payroll items during your EasyStep Interview (if you indicate youll be using payroll) and also during enrollment for a payroll service, but youll probably have to create additional items. Each item you create must be linked to an account in your chart of accounts. And because all the money you withhold or pay out as a company expense is turned over to somebody elsethe government, an insurance company, or a pension administratoryou must set up vendors to associate with each payroll item. You can use the following information to set up payroll items manually, or you can use the QuickBooks Payroll Setup Wizard described later in this chapter. You cannot create payroll items until youve enabled payroll and signed up for a payroll service (covered earlier in this chapter). During enrollment, some payroll items were added to the list automatically. Once youve completed enrollment, you can create payroll items. To view payroll items, choose Lists | Payroll Item List to open the Payroll Item List window (see Figure 8-5). State and local taxes, medical benefits deductions, and other payroll items may not appear in the list, but you can add a new item by pressing CTRL+N while viewing the Payroll Item List to open the Add New Payroll Item Wizard and then selecting the Custom Setup option.
T I P : You can use the Payroll Setup Wizard, covered later in this chapter, to walk you through setting up all the elements and components involved in setting up payroll.
Step through the Add New Payroll Item Wizard, making selections and answering questions. Use the following guidelines as you enter payroll items:
Check everything with your accountant. QuickBooks already has information on many state taxes, so check for your
202
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 8-5
The payroll items you create appear in the Payroll Item List window.
Youll probably have to enter your local (city or township) taxes manually
because QuickBooks only has built-in information on a few cities. If your business is a C corporation or a Subchapter S corporation, you must separate compensation for corporate officers from the compensation for other employees for tax-reporting purposes. To handle this need in QuickBooks, create a separate Earnings item called Officer Compensation and assign it to its own expense account. Afterward, assign this Earnings item to each company officer. For deductions, company contributions, and federal, state, and local taxes, the wizard will ask for the agency to which you pay the liability. Select the vendor that receives the money for the deduction. If you want the employer contributions to pension, health insurance, life insurance, and so on to appear on the payroll check stubs, you must enter those items as payroll items. When you enter a deduction, you must specify the taxes that QuickBooks should calculate after deducting the payroll item (see Figure 8-6). If you forget one, the paychecks and deductions may be incorrect. Some pension plans permit employees to choose between pre- and post-tax deductions. Some states have pre-tax deduction allowances.
When you have entered all your payroll items, youre ready to move on to the next step in entering your payroll information.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
203
FIGURE 8-6
As you set up deduction payroll items, youll see a screen like this one, where you determine whether a deduction is pre-tax or post-tax.
to see a list of wage types that youve defined in your Payroll Items List. Select the one that applies to most of your employees. In the Hourly/Annual Rate column, enter a wage or annual salary figure if theres one that applies to most of your employees. If no figure applies to most employees, just skip it. You can set up each employees rate on the individual employee record later.
204
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 8-7
Establish payroll items that you can assign to most of your employees.
From the Payroll Schedule drop-down list, select a payroll schedule. Use the Class field if youve enabled classes to track data. (See Chapter 22 for
information on using classes.) If youre using QuickBooks time-tracking features to pay employees and you pay most of your employees based on the hours they work, check the Use Time Data To Create Paychecks box. See Chapter 21 to learn how to transfer time tracking into your payroll records. If all or most of your employees have the same additional adjustments (such as insurance deductions, 401[k] deductions, or reimbursement for car expenses), click in the Item Name column in the Additions, Deductions, And Company Contributions box, and then click the arrow to select the appropriate adjustments. Click the Taxes button to open the Taxes Defaults dialog, and then select those taxes that are common and therefore suited for the template (usually all or most of them). Click the Sick/Vacation button to set the terms for accruing sick time and vacation time if your policy is similar enough among employees to include it in the template. When you have finished filling out the template, click OK to save it.
Employee Information
Youre now ready to tell QuickBooks about each of your employees. Select the Employees tab in the Employee Center, and press CTRL+N to open the New Employee dialog box (see Figure 8-8).
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
205
FIGURE 8-8
N O T E : You may see a message, asking if you want assistance adding the
employee. If you click Yes, QuickBooks opens a browser window where you can try out the Employee Organizer service that helps you remain in compliance with state and federal employment laws. For Enterprise users, the Employee Organizer is included in the product. Premier users pay a fee to use the Employee Organizer service.
Personal Info appears in the Change Tabs drop-down list at the top of the dialog box.
206
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Initially, you see three tabs in the New Employee dialog box: Personal, Address And Contact, and Additional Info. Use the drop-down list in the Change Tabs field at the top of the window to display other types of employee-related information, such as:
Payroll And Compensation Info, where you enter information about earnings,
date and other employment history. Workers Compensation, available only if you subscribe to the Enhanced Payroll Service.
Personal Info
While viewing Personal Info in the Change tabs list, you see three tabs associated with three categories of information. The Personal Tab Enter the employees name, Social Security number, and the way the name should print on paychecks. QuickBooks automatically inserts the data from the name fields, which is usually the way paychecks are written, but you may want to make a change (for instance, omitting the middle initial). Enter the Gender and/or Date Of Birth if you have a company policy of recording this information, or if any tax or benefits agency requires it. For example, your state unemployment form may require you to note the gender of all employees, while your medical or life insurance carrier may require the date of birth. The Address And Contact Tab Use this tab to record the employees address, as well as information about contacting the employee (phone number, e-mail, fax, and so on). The Additional Info Tab Use this tab to enter the employee number (if your company uses employee numbers). This tab also contains a Define Fields button so you can create custom fields for employee records (covered in the section Using Custom Fields later in this chapter).
N O T E : Premier users who have not purchased the Employee Organizer will
not see a Raises and Promotions button.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
207
FIGURE 8-9
If the amount of the earnings or the deduction payroll item remains constant from paycheck to paycheck, enter an amount. If the amounts vary, dont enter an amount. Instead, youll enter that information when you create the payroll check. Select the employees payroll schedule so that QuickBooks groups employees properly when you pay them. Employee Tax Information Click the Taxes button to open the Taxes dialog box (see Figure 8-10), which starts with Federal tax information. Fill in any data that wasnt automatically filled in from the Employee Template, and modify any data that is different for this employee. Click the State tab and set up the employees state payroll information. Since this information varies from state to state, you should check with your accountant if you arent sure of something you find there.
208
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 8-10
On the Other tab, apply any local payroll tax that applies to this employee. If you havent already configured that tax in the Payroll Item List, you can click <Add New> to enter it now. Click OK to save the tax status information and return to the Payroll Info tab. Sick and Vacation Pay Information Click the Sick/Vacation button and enter the configuration for this employee, which may include default information you established. When you are finished, click OK to return to the New Employee dialog box. Direct Deposit The Payroll Info tab has a Direct Deposit button, which you can use to establish direct deposit of the employees paycheck to his or her bank account. If you havent signed up for direct deposit, the dialog box that appears when you click this button offers the chance to enroll. See the section, Sending Direct Deposit Information, later in this chapter to learn how to use direct deposit.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
209
Type
Description
Regular Officer
A person you hired for whom you deduct withholdings, issue a W-2, and so on. Its important to have every employee fill out a W-4 form every year. An officer of a corporation. If your business isnt incorporated, you have no officers. On federal corporate tax returns, you are required to report payroll for officers of the corporation separately from the regular payroll amounts. Selecting Officer as the type has no impact on running your payroll (calculations, check printing, and so on). It only affects reports. Someone who works for you that the IRS has decided qualifies as an employee instead of an independent contractor. Check the Circular E or confer with your accountant to make sure that you correctly classify someone as either a statutory employee or an independent contractor. Owner and Employee are mutually exclusive terms to the IRS. If your company is a proprietorship or an unincorporated partnership, owners and partners are not employees; you should set them up in the Other Names list and pay them from the Write Checks window. If, however, you have already set up an owner or partner and cannot delete the record, set his or her Type to Owner so that the QuickBooks payroll services will not pay the owner or partner.
Statutory
Owner
TABLE 8-1
Employee Types
The selection you make in the Type field has an impact on the way your tax returns are prepared. You should check with your accountant if you have any questions about the type you should assign to any employee. Table 8-1 explains your choices.
T I P : If you need extra W-4 forms, you can download them from the IRS at www.irs.gov. Go to the forms section, select W-4, and print or download the form, making as many copies as you need.
You can use the Leave Of Absence tab to track leave dates, pay, and details, and, on the Terminate tab, you can store termination dates, severance pay, and termination details.
210
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
T I P : To avoid a lot of historical data entry, aim to start using payroll at the beginning of a calendar quarter or year.
due quarterly.
You cant enter summarized data for the current quarter. Instead, for the current
quarter, you must enter data for each individual weekly, biweekly, semimonthly, or monthly pay period. For prior quarters, you can enter quarterly totals. If you start using payroll on any date in the first quarter, you must enter historical data for each pay period prior to your first payroll in QuickBooks because you dont have a full quarter to summarize. If you start using payroll in the second quarter, enter a quarterly total for the first quarter and then enter the individual pay period information for the second quarter up to the date you first process payroll in QuickBooks. If you start using payroll in the third quarter, enter quarterly totals for the first two quarters and then enter information for each pay period up to the date you first process payroll in QuickBooks. If you start using payroll in the fourth quarter, you can follow the same pattern, but it might be just as easy to wait until January 1 to begin using QuickBooks payroll.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
211
212
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 8-11
The QuickBooks Payroll Setup Wizard walks you through the process of setting up payroll.
T I P : If your business is a C corporation or a Subchapter S corporation, you need to separate compensation for corporate officers from the compensation for other employees for tax-reporting purposes. To handle this need in QuickBooks, create a separate Earnings item called Officer Compensation and assign it to its own expense account. Then, assign this Earnings item to each company officer.
Benefits, such as insurance, pension, and so on. For each benefit you select,
for calculating vacation time and sick time if you let employees accrue time according to time worked. Other additions and deductions, such as workers comp, auto expense reimbursement, garnishments, union dues, charitable contributions, and so on.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
213
FIGURE 8-12
The wizard identifies employees with missing information so that you can correct the situation.
214
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
215
Although QuickBooks suggests typical frequencies for tax payments (monthly, quarterly, after each payroll, and next banking day) you can set up custom frequencies that work better for you. As you set up the tax payment schedule, you can set up custom frequencies that work better for you. Place a check in the Let Me Use A Different Payment (Deposit) Frequency checkbox. QuickBooks then displays a screen where you can create a custom payment schedule.
N O T E : The information you enter through the Payroll Setup Wizard does not
affect general ledger accounts, an important fact to consider when setting up your companys opening account balances. For details on entering opening account balances, see Chapter 14.
216
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Then, the wizard displays the employees you set up previously. You select one and click Edit to enter historical information about that employee. If you paid an employee during the quarter, the wizard asks about the last paycheck you issued outside of QuickBooks.
Ill 8-3
Using the information you provide, the wizard prompts you to enter the quarterly total for all earnings, withholding, company contribution, and company tax payroll items assigned to the employee.
Ill 8-4
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
217
When you finish entering employee information, the wizard walks you through the process of entering payments you made for employer withholding remittances, employer taxes, payments to pension and benefit plans, and so on. The wizard then walks you through entering the same information for subsequent quarters. If you are performing this task in the second month of any quarter, the wizard asks for batch information for the first month of the quarter and then individual paycheck information for the current month.
Finishing Steps
After QuickBooks verifies all your payroll data, the Payroll Setup Wizard displays a series of Finishing Up screens that provide you with information on where, in QuickBooks, you can find the information you just set up.
Running Payroll
Its payday. Youve entered all the historical data, and now its time to run the payroll. If youre using direct deposit services, you need a two-day lead before the actual payday. If only some of your employees use direct deposit, you have two choices.
Create paychecks two days before payday and hold the printed checks until
payday.
Run through the payroll procedure twice, selecting the appropriate employees
each time.
218
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 8-13
To make other types of changes to an employees paycheck, you can click the link representing the employees name in the Employee column. QuickBooks then displays the Preview Paycheck window, where you can make changes like assigning or changing the assignment of the employees wages to a customer:job, changing the workers compensation code, or, if appropriate, adding bonus pay. Once you finish working in this window, click Save & Next to view the details of the next employees check or click Save & Close to redisplay the Enter Payroll Information window. Verify the payroll period end date and the check date and make sure that you select the correct bank account. Click Continue.
T I P : If you have a separate payroll account, you can set it as the default account when you create paychecks so that you dont accidentally use the wrong bank account when creating paychecks. Choose Edit | Preferences and click the Checking category on the left side of the dialog box. On the Company Preferences tab, select the default bank account for creating paychecks and the default bank account for paying payroll liabilities.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
219
T I P : You can click the Printing Preferences link to open the Payroll Printing Preferences dialog box. Here, you can set pay stub and voucher check printing options.
FIGURE 8-14
In the Review And Create Paychecks window, you can verify that paycheck amounts will be correct.
220
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Click Create Paychecks. QuickBooks creates and saves the paychecks in your company data file and then offers you printing options described in the next section.
To print checks, follow these steps: Click the Print Paychecks button. QuickBooks displays the Select Paychecks To Print window. Select the bank account and make sure the First Check Number field matches the number of the first check loaded in your printer. If you have both paychecks and direct deposit stubs to print, select the appropriate option at the bottom of the dialog box to display only those items. Remove the check beside any paycheck you dont want to print by clicking the check-mark column. Click OK. The Print Checks window opens, where you can select a printer and a check style. For details on this window, see Chapter 7.
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
221
Click Print to print the paychecks. QuickBooks displays a window in which you must confirm that everything printed properly or decide to reprint any checks that had a problem. If everything is fine, click OK. If theres a problem, enter the number of the first check that had a problem and QuickBooks will reprint as necessary, starting with the next available check number. QuickBooks redisplays the Confirmation And Next Steps window. If you need to print pay stubs, click the Print Pay Stubs button. The procedure for printing pay stubs is exactly the same as the procedure for printing paychecks. Only the end result differs. When you finish printing, click Close.
Editing a Paycheck
While you can edit a paycheck, its really not wise. If you make a change that affects net pay, you will also change the wage base on the check and the tax amounts, and those changes affect your payroll liabilities, which could then mean filing amended payroll tax returns. Theres a domino effect here that you want to avoid. QuickBooks helps you avoid the problem with the Lock Net Pay option at the bottom of the Review Paycheck window. As long as this option is selected, you can review paychecks and make changes that dont affect net pay, such as changing a workers compensation code. To edit a paycheck, find it in the Employee Center and double-click it. When QuickBooks displays the check, click the Paycheck Detail button to display the Review Paycheck window, shown in Figure 8-15. Although you can unlock a paycheck and edit anything on it, you should check with your accountant before you take this action; your accountant may prefer that you void and reissue a paycheck. To void a paycheck, double-click it to display it in the Paycheck window. Then, choose Edit | Void Paycheck.
222
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 8-15
N O T E : You should void a paycheck only if you have the paycheck, so that
you can destroy it.
FYI
CHAPTER
RUNNING
PAY R O L L
223
INS Form I-9 COBRA notification Federal Form W-4 Independent Contractor Agreement Job Descriptions Form Reference Check Form Driving Record Check Form
224
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Chapter 9 Chapter 9
n this chapter:
Making tax deposits Preparing quarterly and annual returns Printing W-2 forms
225
226
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Preparing payroll in-house involves printing reports, filling out forms, and writing checks. In this chapter, well review the tasks involved in making tax deposits and preparing payroll reports and forms. If you have an active subscription for QuickBooks Assisted Payroll services, you dont have to worry about the sections in this chapter that are concerned with remitting federal and state withholdings. Youll be able to enter these transactions as journal entries. You do, however, have to remit any local payroll tax withholding.
N O T E : You can also set up schedules for benefits and other payments set
up as liabilities, but you can set up schedules only for payroll items you created previously. See Chapter 8 for details on setting up payroll items.
If you didnt set up tax payment schedules when you set up Payroll in Chapter 8, you can set up the schedules now. To create your tax payment schedules, open the
CHAPT ER
GOVERNMENT
PAY R O L L
REPORTIN G
227
Employee Center and click the Payroll tab to display the Payroll Center. Click the Related Payment Activities drop-down arrow, and then click Edit Payment Due Dates/Methods. The QuickBooks Payroll Setup Interview Wizard starts, explaining on the first screen that you can add new scheduled tax payments or change existing ones. Click Continue. The QuickBooks Payroll Setup Interview Wizard then displays an informational screen, explaining that setting up a tax payment schedule involves identifying who receives your tax payments and how often you pay them. Click Next. If youve already set up some tax payment schedules, they appear on the next wizard screen. To edit one of them, select it, and click the Edit button. If you havent set up any tax payment schedules yet, the QuickBooks Payroll Setup Interview Wizard displays the Set Up Payment Schedule For Federal 940 screen (see Figure 9-1). In the Payee list, select the vendor to whom you pay your 940 tax liability. The vendor may be an agency or a financial institution and must appear in the Vendor List. From the Payment (Deposit) Frequency list, select the frequency with which you
FIGURE 9-1
Use this screen to identify the vendor to whom you pay your 940 tax liability, and the frequency with which you make the payment.
228
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
make the payment. QuickBooks helps you select the frequency by telling you the usual frequency for this tax payment, but you can select a different frequency or click the Let Me Use A Different Payment (Deposit) Frequency checkbox. QuickBooks then displays a screen where you can create a custom payment schedule. After selecting the vendor and the frequency, click Next. Once youve finished setting up the 940 scheduled tax payment, the QuickBooks Payroll Setup Interview Wizard displays screens just like the one shown in Figure 9-1 so that you can set up scheduled tax payments for the Federal 941 tax liability and state liabilities. When you finish creating these payroll tax liability payment schedules, the QuickBooks Payroll Setup Interview Wizard offers you the opportunity to set up other scheduled tax payments for payroll items that are designated as liabilities, such as:
Payroll benefits like 401(k) contributions, and health and dental insurance
premiums Garnishments Charitable donations If you need to set up payment schedules for any of these other payroll-related payments, click Continue. The process is the same as the one I just described for creating payroll tax liability payment schedules, and QuickBooks will remind you when these payments are due.
T I P : Use the technique Im about to describe to pay scheduled liabilities. See the next section to learn how to pay unscheduled payroll liabilities.
To create the liability payment for your federal deposit, open the Employee Center and click the Payroll tab to display the Payroll Center. In the Pay Scheduled Liabilities section, click in the leftmost column to select the liabilities you want to pay. You can select as many liabilities as you want at one time; QuickBooks is smart enough to create separate checks for each payroll liability you select (see Figure 9-2).
N O T E : Notice that both the Due Date column and the Status column help
you identify the liabilities you need to pay.
After you select the liabilities you want to pay, click View/Pay. QuickBooks displays the Liability Payment window, showing a check in the amount of the total liabilities
CHAPT ER
GOVERNMENT
PAY R O L L
REPORTIN G
229
FIGURE 9-2
due to the selected payroll tax vendor. If you selected more than one liability to pay and your liabilities go to different vendors, QuickBooks automatically generates separate checks for each vendor. (In Figure 9-3, QuickBooks created two payments for the liabilities I selected, as Payment 1 of 2 in the upper left corner of the window indicates.) If you are generating multiple liability checks, click Save & Next to save the first check and view the next one. If you are generating only one liability check, click Save & Close. When you finish reviewing liability checks, QuickBooks displays the Payment Summary window (see Figure 9-4). Click Print Checks to produce the checks. QuickBooks then displays the Select Checks To Print window, where you can select your liability checks and print them. (See Chapter 7 for details on printing checks.) After you print checks, QuickBooks redisplays the Payroll Summary window, where you can click the Print Summary button. When you click the Print Summary button, QuickBooks prints a copy of the Payment Summary window. When QuickBooks finishes and redisplays the Payment Summary window, click Close.
230
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 9-3
When you click View/Pay in the Payroll Center, QuickBooks creates the appropriate number of liability checks.
FIGURE 9-4
After you review the liability checks, QuickBooks displays the Payment Summary window.
CHAPT ER
GOVERNMENT
PAY R O L L
REPORTIN G
231
If you double-check the Payroll Center, youll notice that QuickBooks updated the Pay Scheduled Liabilities portion of the window, and the liabilities for the period you paid no longer appear.
FIGURE 9-5
232
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Specify whether you want to create the check without reviewing it, or review the check before creating it. Click in the leftmost column beside the liabilities you want to pay. Click Create. If you opted to review the check, it appears in the Write Checks window. Click Save & Close. If you opted not to review the check, QuickBooks creates the check. If you print checks, follow the steps in Chapter 7 to print checks.
CHAPT ER
GOVERNMENT
PAY R O L L
REPORTIN G
233
Companies make workers compensation payments, typically to insurance companies, to provide benefits to workers who are injured on the job. When workers are injured and the injury is deemed work related, the insurance company pays workers compensation benefits that usually include medical expenses and possibly wages. Each state establishes workers compensation categories and corresponding rates based on the danger level of the work performed by employees in the category. The insurance company calculates your premium based on:
The amount of gross pay each employee receives, The workers compensation category of the employee, and The number of accidents that have occurred at your place of business.
The workers compensation rate for office workers is lower than the rate for construction workers because construction workers are more likely to be injured on the job than office workers. Also, as the number of accidents increases, the premiums increase. Workers compensation premiums accrue as you pay employees, so you need to set up workers compensation before writing paychecks; otherwise, the workers compensation reports and liability amount will not be accurate. So, plan to start using workers compensation in QuickBooks on January 1. If you start using the Workers Compensation feature in QuickBooks mid-year, youll need to combine the information QuickBooks tracks with the information you tracked outside of QuickBooks. To set up workers compensation, check with your insurance company to get the codes your insurance company uses and the rates charged for each code, your states regulations for workers compensation and overtime, and your experience modification factor, if assigned by the insurance company. The experience modification factor is based on the number of prior workers compensation claims your company has in your state, and it increases or reduces your workers compensation premium. Most companies pay an overtime premium, such as time-and-a-half, when an employee works more than the specified number of hours in a pay period. Timeand-a-half consists of the employees regular hourly rate plus half of the regular hourly rate for the hours that exceed 40 hours per week. The extra half of the regular hourly ratethe amount that exceeds the regular rate of payis considered overtime premium. In many states, you calculate your workers compensation liability only on regular wages and you therefore pay less. If you pay overtime, check with your insurance company or your accountant to see if you can calculate overtime amounts as regular pay. If necessary, set up overtime payroll items for all types of wages prior to setting up workers compensation.
234
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
You can also choose to see reminder messages to assign workers compensation codes when you create paychecks or timesheets. In addition, you can, if appropriate, select the option to exclude an overtime premium from the workers compensation calculation. To set up the Workers Comp calculations, choose Employees | Workers Compensation | Set Up Workers Comp. The Workers Compensation Setup Wizard starts. On the opening screen, you see a list of the things youll need to complete the setup. When you have everything you need, click Next. On the Who Is Your Workers Compensation Insurance Carrier screen, select the vendor to whom you pay your workers compensation insurance premium and optionally supply any account number by which that vendor recognizes you. Click Next. On the Set Employee Default Classification Codes screen, click the Workers Comp code column and choose <Add New>. The New Workers Compensation Code dialog box appears.
Ill 9-2
Supply the workers compensation code number and description. In the Rate box, type the rate per $100.00 of gross wages. Click the Calendar icon to select a starting date for the rate and click OK. QuickBooks redisplays the Set Employee Default Classification Codes Wizard screen. Repeat this process to add the workers compensation codes you need to use. Then, assign a default workers compensation code to each employee (see Figure 9-6) and click Next.
CHAPT ER
GOVERNMENT
PAY R O L L
REPORTIN G
235
FIGURE 9-6
T I P : QuickBooks creates the Exempt code for you automatically, and you can change the workers compensation code on the employees check as necessary.
QuickBooks displays the Enter Your Experience Modification Factor (If Applicable) screen. If you use an experience modification factor, enter it and supply its effective date. Otherwise, click No, I Dont Use An Experience Modification Factor and click Next. The Overtime Payments screen appears, asking if you pay overtime wages. Click Yes or No as appropriate and then click Next. If you click Yes, the Overtime Premiums And Workers Compensation Calculations screen appears, where you specify whether you include or exclude overtime premiums from your workers compensation calculations. Click the appropriate response and then click Next. The Name Your Workers Compensation Payroll Item screen appears. This screen also appears if you click No on the Overtime Payments screen. Type a name for your workers compensation payroll item and click Next. The Workers Compensation Wizard displays a summary screen for your workers compensation setup. Click Finish.
N O T E : If you leave the check mark in the Display The Workers Compensation
Overview When I Finish box, QuickBooks will display the Help topic for Workers Compensation after you click Finish.
236
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FYI
The workers compensation codes you created appear in the Workers Comp List, which you can display from the Lists menu or by choosing Employees | Workers Compensation | Workers Comp List.
T I P : If your experience modification factor changes, open the Workers Comp List, click the Experience Modification button, and click Edit. QuickBooks displays the Edit Experience Modification Factor dialog box, where you can set a new experience modification factor and its effective date.
To pay the workers compensation insurance bill from the Pay Liabilities window, follow the steps in the Paying Unscheduled Payroll Liabilities section earlier in this chapter. If the bill does not match the accrued liability amount, you may need to adjust the liability amount.
CHAPT ER
GOVERNMENT
PAY R O L L
REPORTIN G
237
238
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Choose Federal Form and click OK. The Select Payroll Form dialog box appears. Choose Quarterly Form 941/Schedule B - Interview For Your Form 941/ Schedule B. In the Select Filing Period area, select a quarter and the quarter ending date and click OK. The Interview for your form 941/Schedule B appears, asking you some questions. After you answer the questions, click Next to display Form 941 and, if appropriate, Schedule B onscreen. The form contains information from your QuickBooks company data file. After you click Next to view all the pages, you will see a page of filing and printing instructions.
CHAPT ER
GOVERNMENT
PAY R O L L
REPORTIN G
239
N O T E : If you file 250 or more W-2 forms, the IRS requires that you file
electronically.
In the Select Employees For Form W-2/W-3, QuickBooks selects all employees by default. Choose Review/Edit and the Welcome To The W-2 And W-3 Interview window appears. Click Next to answer the review questions. When you finish, click Next to begin reviewing each employees W-2 form and the W-3 transmittal form. When you finish reviewing, QuickBooks displays filing and printing instructions. As with Form 940 and Form 941, QuickBooks has a very clever troubleshooting tool for Form W-2 to help you see the calculations that make up any line of the W-2 by clicking that line of the form. Visit www.quickbooks.com/support and search for Form W-2 instructions without the quotation marks. On the page that appears, click the Form W-2 Instructions link.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10
n this chapter:
Creating inventory items Creating assemblies Counting inventory Adjusting inventory Running inventory reports
241
242
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Inventory is the lifeblood of a business that sells products. You need to track and manage inventory items every bit as carefully as you track and manage customer receivables. Managing inventory well helps ensure you never miss a sale because, if you dont have the item immediately in inventory, you know exactly when it will arrive. Managing inventory well also helps ensure you dont overstock items, tying up cash you need for other purposes.
than once. If your company file is large, checking this box could slow down processing. When calculating the quantity available, you can specify that QuickBooks exclude items because they make up an assembly you plan to build, or because they appear on sales orders. You can determine how QuickBooks calculates how much inventory is available to sell before it warns you of insufficient quantities. When you choose When The Quantity I Want To Sell Exceeds The Quantity On Hand, QuickBooks looks at the number you have in stock. When you choose When The Quantity I Want To Sell Exceeds The Quantity Available, QuickBooks also considers quantities reserved for assemblies and sales orders based on the way you set the preceding preference to calculate the quantity available. You can enable the Unit Of Measure feature, which you can read about in the next section.
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
243
FIGURE 10-1
244
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Enterprise Versions
U/M
Premier Versions
U/M
Accountant Contractor Mfg/Wholesale Nonprofit Professional Nonindustry (plain) Retail TABLE 10-1
To set up the Unit of Measure feature, follow these steps: Choose Edit | Preferences to display the Preferences dialog box. Click Items & Inventory. Click the Company tab.
N O T E : If you enabled Single U/M Per Item, youll use these steps with
some slight changes. See the note after the step for details.
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
245
FIGURE 10-2
You can enable the unit of measure feature in QuickBooks to track single or multiple units of measure per item.
Choose Lists | U/M Set List. The U/M Set List window appears. Press CTRL+N. The Unit Of Measure Wizard starts.
Ill 10-1
246
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
T I P : If you dont see the unit of measure you need, click Other. The wizard lets you assign a name and abbreviation to the unit of measure. Then, continue with step 6.
Click Next. The Select A Base Unit Of Measure screen appears.
Ill 10-2
Select the smallest unit you sell or buy. Click Next. The Add Related Units screen appears.
Ill 10-3
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
247
Check the other units of measure you sell or buy. If you dont choose any related units, skip to step 10.
N O T E : If you selected Other in step 3, click the first empty line, place a
check in the Add column and fill in the Name, Abbreviation, and quantity of base units contained in the related unit you are defining.
Click Next. The Select Default Units Of Measure screen appears. Select the default unit of measure that QuickBooks should display when you buy items, sell items, and ship items. If you choose a unit for shipping, the unit you select will override the unit of measure that appears on sales orders when you print a pick list. Click Next. The Name Of The Unit Of Measure Set screen appears, displaying a name that QuickBooks supplies. Accept the name QuickBooks supplies or type a new name and click Finish.
N O T E : If you select the Single U/M Per Item option, you wont see an entry
on the Lists menu for the U/M Set List. You will need to set up units of measure, but youll do so while creating or editing inventory items. Youll see some of the same screens that the user of the Multiple U/M Per Item option sees, but you wont see the Add Related Units screen, the Select Default Units Of Measure screen, or the Name The Unit Of Measure Set screen.
FIGURE 10-3
The Item List window displays a wide variety of information about established items.
248
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
N O T E : QuickBooks Premier users wont see the search fields at the top of
the Item List window.
To add a new item to your inventory items list, press CTRL+N. When the New Item window opens, select Inventory Part for the item type, and fill in the information (see Figure 10-4):
The Item Name/Number is your code for the item. This field must be unique in
Manufacturers Part Number field when you create an item. If you purchase from a distributor instead of a manufacturer, enter the distributors part number. If you enabled the unit of measure feature, assign a U/M. If you enabled Multiple U/M Per Item, assign a U/M set, and QuickBooks will assign the default unit in the set definition in transaction windows. If you enable Single U/M Per Item, assign a specific unit of measure that QuickBooks will use in transaction windows.
FIGURE 10-4
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
249
automatically appears when you create a purchase order, a bill, a credit card charge, or a check. The text you enter in the Description On Sales Transactions field automatically appears on invoices, estimates, sales receipts, and sales orders. You can change the information as you create transactions.
individual transaction. The value in the Sales Price field appears by default when you sell the item, and the value in the Cost field appears by default when you purchase the item.
N O T E : Dont confuse the Cost field with the inventory costing method Avg.
Cost, which displays the value of the item in your inventory asset account. In case your accountant asks, QuickBooks uses the Average Costing inventory method and does not support FIFO or LIFO.
Select the appropriate accounts for Cost Of Goods Sold and Income. Enter a number in the Reorder Point field that reflects the minimum quantity
you want to have in stock. If you turn on the QuickBooks Reminders feature, QuickBooks will remind you to reorder the item when this quantity is reached. To turn on the Reminder feature, choose Edit | Preferences and click the Reminders category. On the My Preferences tab, check Show Reminders List When Opening A Company File checkbox. On the Company Preferences tab, choose either Show Summary or Show List for the Inventory To Reorder option. You shouldnt need to enter values in the On Hand or Total Value field if you set up the item before you purchase it. Your first purchase will create the values for these fields. If you are setting up inventory and trying to establish existing inventory, use the inventory adjustment transaction to set up opening balances for items. This approach provides the financial trail your accountant will prefer instead of using the boxes in the New Item dialog box. You can read more about the inventory adjustment transaction later in this chapter in the section, Making Inventory Adjustments. If you created any custom fields for items (discussed in Chapter 2), click Custom Fields and enter data in any custom field thats appropriate for this item. If you
250
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
want to add additional custom fields, click Define Fields. You can define up to five custom fields.
Ill 10-4
If you disabled automatic spell checks in the Preferences dialog box, click Spelling to make sure you have no spelling errors, letting the QuickBooks spell checker add the words connected to this item to its dictionary and eliminating the need to check spelling when you use the item in a transaction. If you didnt disable the spell checker, it will start when you click OK to save the item.
Creating Subitems
Subitems are useful when choices exist for items and you want all the choices to be part of a larger hierarchy so you can track them efficiently. For instance, if you sell interior and exterior doors, you may want to create an item for door and subitems interior and exterior. To create a subitem, you must assign it to a parent item. When you create a parent item, use these guidelines:
Use a generic name for the item (the details are in the subitem names). Enter the COGS Account because its a required field for all inventory items. Enter the Income Account because its a required field for all inventory items.
Dont fill in any of the other fields for the parent item. Instead, store that information with the subitem. Having created the parent item, subitems are easy to generate. To do so, create a new item and assign the item a name. Then, check the Subitem Of box and select the parent item from the drop-down list that appears when you click the arrow to the right of the field. Afterward, fill in the rest of the New Item dialog box, as described earlier in this chapter.
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
251
As long as youre not using the item, you can make it inactive so it wont appear on the Item List when youre entering transactions. To make an item inactive, open the Item List window and right-click the item. Then, choose Make Item Inactive from the shortcut menu. When you make an item inactive, it doesnt appear when you open the item list while recording a transaction and it doesnt appear in the Item List window. However, you can change the appearance of the Item List window to display inactive items. When you have made items inactive, QuickBooks makes the Include Inactive checkbox available. Click it and QuickBooks displays inactive items with an X to the left of the item.
T I P : To make an inactive item active again, click the X beside an inactive item. C A U T I O N : You can make any subitem inactive, but if you make a parent item inactive, QuickBooks also makes all of its subitems inactive.
Inactive items dont appear on any of the inventory reports. If the inactive items have a quantity and dollar amount, you should activate all inventory items before running any inventory reports. This will ensure the dollar amounts on the inventory reports agree with the financial statements.
Creating Assemblies
The Inventory Assembly item type helps you use raw inventory parts to build finished goods items; thus, it is particularly useful to companies for which manufacturing is a light to moderate portion of their business.
T I P : You can create an inventory assembly item from an existing inventory part item. Just edit the item and change the Type to Inventory Assembly; you can then add other items to the newly created assembly. However, once you make the switch, you cant change your mind.
252
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FYI
Assembly Cost
You might be tempted to think that the cost of your assembly will be the Total Bill Of Materials cost that appears when you create or edit the item. In fact, the Total Bill Of Materials cost you see when you create or edit the item is the sum of the costs you supplied when you created each component of the assembly. QuickBooks will determine the actual cost of your assembly at the time you build the assembly, and that cost will be the sum of the average costs of the components at the time of the build, which might be different from the Total Bill Of Materials Cost.
When you create an inventory assembly item, you define the components of the assembly, which exist as raw parts in your inventory, as you can see in Figure 10-5. Simply click the Item column of the Bill Of Materials section and select a component of the assemblyQuickBooks fills in the description, type, and cost of the item. You then supply the quantity and QuickBooks calculates the total.
FIGURE 10-5
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
253
You assign a cost of goods sold account, an income account and tax code, and an inventory asset account. In addition, you can supply a build point to identify the minimum quantity you want to have in stock. If you are setting up QuickBooks for the first time, dont enter values into the On Hand or Total Value columns to record existing assemblies in QuickBooks. Instead, use inventory adjustment transactions (see the section, Making Inventory Adjustments, later in this chapter). To enter new assemblies into inventory, youll build them. Read on to discover how to enter assemblies into inventory.
Pending Builds
Even if you dont have enough component parts, QuickBooks permits you to build more assemblies than the number listed as the Maximum Number You Can Build From Quantity On Hand. If you choose to build more than the maximum number, QuickBooks displays the warning box you see in Figure 10-7.
254
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 10-6
FIGURE 10-7
By building more than your current inventory allows, you can create a pending build.
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
255
If you click Make Pending, QuickBooks marks the build as pending and doesnt update your inventory counts, so your finished goods are not yet available. When parts become available, you can finish the build. Use the Pending Builds report to find pending builds to complete. Choose Reports | Inventory | Pending Builds to view the Pending Builds report. Drill down on any line on the report to display it in the Build Assemblies window.
Ill 10-5
You can manually mark a build as pending. Create the build as described earlier. Then, while redisplaying it in the Build Assemblies window, choose Edit | Mark Build as Pending.
C A U T I O N : Be aware that if you make inventory adjustments or modify transactions that include assemblies, builds that were previously final could become pending.
Disassembling Assemblies
So, what if I accidentally build more assemblies than I really want? Am I stuck with them? The answer is no. You can disassemble assemblies in any of the following ways:
On an existing build transaction in the Build Assemblies window, reduce the
quantity to build.
Delete a build transaction completely. Use the Adjust Quantity/Value On Hand window to reduce the quantity of
finished goods.
256
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Lists box. Click Print or, if you dont want a paper report, you can view the Bill Of Materials report onscreen by clicking the Preview button.
Ill 10-6
Counting Inventory
Although everyone makes a concerted effort to account for everything that comes and goes, you need to perform a physical inventory at least once each yearand twice in some industriesto make sure your QuickBooks records match your physical inventory. While taking physical inventory isnt fun, it is important. After all, inventory is the lifeblood of businesses that sell products.
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
257
FIGURE 10-8
Use the column containing the blank lines to record physical inventory counts.
Some businesses need the preferred vendor to help employees taking inventory distinguish similar items that come from different vendors. If you have no use for the Pref Vendor column, you can remove it from the report if you drag the diamond on the right side of the column all the way to the diamond on the left side of the column. The items appear on the report in alphabetical order, but you may want to reorganize the information to better support taking a physical inventory. For example, you may want to arrange the items to match the way youve laid out your warehouse. Or, you may want to add bin numbers or row numbers to each item on the sheet. Click the Export button to export the Physical Inventory Worksheet report to Excel, where you can add warehouse location information and then sort the report using that location information.
258
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
You can make adjustments to inventory at any time and for a variety of reasons:
Breakage or other damage. Customer demo units. Gifts or bonuses for customers or employees. Removal of inventory parts in order to create prebuilt or preassembled inventory items (see the section, Creating Assemblies, earlier in this chapter).
The important thing to remember is that tracking inventory isnt just to make sure you have sufficient items on hand to sell to customers. Equally important is the fact that inventory is a significant asset, just like your cash, equipment, and other assets. It affects your companys worth in a substantial way.
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
259
FIGURE 10-9
Correct the quantity and value of inventory to match the physical count.
You may need to change your inventory valuation. For example, an inventory items market value may have declined, and your accountant wants you to change from the cost value to the market value for that item. Click the Value Adjustment checkbox at the bottom of the window. QuickBooks adds the New Value column to the window (see Figure 10-10) and displays the
FIGURE 10-10
260
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
value of the total adjusted count for each item. If your inventory adjustment lowers the value of your inventory, QuickBooks debits the inventory adjustment account and credits the inventory asset account for the same amount. If your adjustment raises the value of your inventory, QuickBooks posts the debit to the inventory asset account, and the credit to the inventory adjustment account.
Report
Description
This report gives you a quick assessment of the value of your inventory. By default, the date range is the current month to date. For each item, the report shows the item description, the quantity on hand, the U/M if enabled, the average cost, the asset value, the percent of total assets, the sales price, the retail value, and the percent of total retail value. This report lists each transaction that involved each inventory item. The report shows no financial information about the price charged to customers, because your inventory value is based on cost. You can doubleclick any sales transaction line to see the details (and the amount you charged for the item). The report also includes assemblies and inventory adjustments in which the item was involved. Among other things, this report shows the preferred vendor, the item reorder point, the number currently on hand, for sales orders, for assemblies, the U/M if enabled, a check mark to remind you to order items that are below the reorder point, the number currently on purchase orders, the next delivery date based on purchase order information, and the average number of units sold per week. Two versions of the report exist so you can sort the information by item or by vendor. This is the report you print when its time to take an inventory count. See the section, Counting Inventory, for more information. This report details the current state of assemblies you create from existing items (called builds, or prebuilds). QuickReports provide valuable information about an individual inventory item or all inventory items. In the Item List window, select an item and press CTRL+Q to display a QuickReport.
TABLE 10-2
Inventory Reports
C H A PT ER
10
CONF IGURING
AND
TRACKING
INVENTORY
261
hope you really do have them but you havent used a QuickBooks transaction to bring them into stock), its possible to have a negative number in this column. QuickBooks calculates asset value by multiplying the number on hand by the average cost. QuickBooks displays the sales price listed when you create the item. The changes you make to prices as you sell arent reflected in this report. QuickBooks calculates the retail value by multiplying the number on hand by the retail price.
Chapter 11 Chapter 11
n this chapter:
Making deposits Transferring funds between accounts Dealing with bounced checks Voiding disbursements Managing cash Balancing credit card statements
263
264
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Working with a bank account involves more than writing checks. In this chapter, well walk through the wide variety of bank accountrelated activities, including making deposits, transferring funds between bank accounts, handling bounced checks, and voiding disbursements. Afterward, well look at the ways you can use QuickBooks to handle tracking your credit card activity.
Making a Deposit
In Chapter 4, you saw how QuickBooks takes care of depositing money into your bank account when you receive money from customers. But there are times when you receive money thats unconnected to a customer payment. For example, you might receive a cash refund from a vendor or a rebate on a purchase you made. Entering a deposit that isnt a customer payment into your QuickBooks check register isnt much different from entering a deposit into a manual checkbook register. Actually, its easier because you dont have to make any calculations QuickBooks takes care of that. The window you use to record these deposits depends on whether you plan to record the deposit as a single separate deposit or whether you want to include the money in a deposit with other fundseven customer payments. If you plan to record the deposit as a single separate deposit, you can enter it directly in the bank account register. If you intend to include the money in a deposit with other money, you can use the Make Deposit window described in Chapter 4. To record the deposit directly in the register, click Check Register on the Home page or press CTRL+R and then select the bank account into which you intend to deposit the money. Fill in the date and then click the deposit column to enter the amount. Assign the deposit to an account, and use the Memo field for an explanation of the deposit so youll remember where you got the money when your accountant asks you. Then, click the Record button.
FYI
C H A PT ER
11
M ANAGING
BANK
AND
CREDIT
CARD
ACCOUNTS
265
FIGURE 11-1
266
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FYI
C H A PT ER
11
M ANAGING
BANK
AND
CREDIT
CARD
ACCOUNTS
267
reimbursable expenses. If the check does clear the second time, record the transaction again and create a reimbursable expense for only the amount of the bank service charge. To adjust your bank balance, follow these steps: Press CTRL+W to open the Write Checks window. Select the bank account affected by the NSF check. In the Pay To The Order Of field, select the Returned Check Vendor. In the Check Number field, type an entry such as RetChk. You can (and should) reuse an alphabetic entry in the Check Number field for the same vendor. On the Expenses tab, select the Returned Checks expense account, enter the amount of the check, and choose the customer who wrote the check in the Customer:Job column. On a second line, select your Bank Service Charges account, supply the amount the bank charged you, and again, choose the customer who wrote the check in the Customer:Job column (see Figure 11-2).
268
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 11-2
Record a check to adjust your bank account for the NSF check.
N O T E : If you have not yet redeposited the bounced check, avoid creating
reimbursable expenses by removing the check marks from the Billable column. If the bounced check failed to clear after redepositing it, leave the check marks in the Billable column. If the bounced check cleared after you redeposited it, create a reimbursable expense for only the bank service charge.
C H A PT ER
11
M ANAGING
BANK
AND
CREDIT
CARD
ACCOUNTS
269
FIGURE 11-3
N O T E : If the Billable Time/Costs dialog box doesnt appear, click the Add
Time/Costs button at the bottom of the Create Invoices window and skip step 3.
Click Select The Outstanding Billable Time And Costs To Add To This Invoice? and click OK. The Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box appears. Click the Expenses tab. Two entries appear that represent the amount of the NSF check and the amount of your banks service charge. Check both entries.
270
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Optionally, you can add your own fee in the Markup Amount or % box. If you do, select the Bank Service Charges account for the Markup Account. Click OK. The charges appear on the invoice. You can edit the descriptions on the invoice to make them more meaningful. Print the invoice.
Voiding Disbursements
Sometimes you have to void a check that youve written. Perhaps you decided not to send it for some reason, or perhaps it was lost in the mail. Whatever the reason, if a check isnt going to clear your bank, you should void it. The process of voiding a check is quite easy, and the only trouble you can cause yourself is deleting the check instead of voiding it. Deleting a check removes all history of the transaction, while voiding a check keeps the record of the check number but sets the amount to zero. To void a check, press CTRL+R and select the account containing the check you want to void. QuickBooks opens the bank account register. Right-click anywhere on the checks transaction line and QuickBooks opens a shortcut menu. Choose Void Check. QuickBooks automatically adjusts the expense accounts to which the check was posted. Click Record to save the transaction.
Tracking Cash
Although most of your transactions dont deal with cash directly, some do. Using an ATM machine makes it easy to take cash out of your bank account. Many businesses maintain a petty cash box to dispense cash to employees or owners who need cash as a reimbursement for money theyve spent for the company or as an advance against future expenditures. When you use cash, you have to account for both the portion you spend and the portion that remains in your pocket because the cash belongs to the business.
C H A PT ER
11
M ANAGING
BANK
AND
CREDIT
CARD
ACCOUNTS
271
If you dont have a petty cash account in your chart of accounts, use these steps to create one: Click the Chart Of Accounts icon on the Home page, or press CTRL+A to display the Chart Of Accounts window. Press CTRL+N. The Select Account Type window appears. Select Bank and click Continue. The New Account window appears, with the Account Type already selected. If you number your accounts, use a number that places your new petty cash account near the other bank accounts in your chart of accounts. Leave the opening balance at zero. Click Save & Close.
T I P : Dont let anyone take money out of the petty cash till without a receipt. If the money is an advance against a purchase instead of payment for a receipt, use an IOU. Later, replace the IOU with the purchase receipt.
272
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FYI
Open the petty cash account register and use the receipts youve collected to assign expense accounts to the transaction. You can enter one transaction, splitting each receipt among all the affected expense accounts, or enter individual transactions. You can delete the check number that QuickBooks automatically inserts in the Number field, or you can leave the number there. You dont typically reconcile the petty cash account, so it doesnt matter. You can either skip the Payee field or use a payee you set up in the Other Names list named Petty Cash. If you spent less than the amount of cash you withdrew, the balance stays in the petty cash account in QuickBooks while the cash is in your pocket. When you spend it later, repeat this process to account for that spending.
arrives.
Treat the credit card bill as a liability and enter each transaction as its made.
C H A PT ER
11
M ANAGING
BANK
AND
CREDIT
CARD
ACCOUNTS
273
FIGURE 11-4
If you dont pay off the card balance each month, subsequent credit bills will contain interest charges in addition to your purchases. Post the interest charges to an interest expense account. If you enter the bill in the Enter Bills window and then use the Pay Bills window to write the check, select the oldest bill and make a partial payment or full payment. You can select additional bills and pay part or all of them, but always pay the oldest bill first.
274
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
display the Select Account Type window. Select Credit Card and click Continue. In the New Account window, type a name for the credit card account, and, if you use account numbers, assign a number in the range of your liability accounts. Dont enter an opening balance and then click Save & Close.
If you enable your credit card for online banking, there is no need to enter the transactions manually. Downloading the transactions is faster, easier, and less error prone. See Chapter 16 for instructions. To enter credit card charges manually, choose Banking | Enter Credit Card Charges to open the Enter Credit Card Charges window (see Figure 11-5).
FIGURE 11-5
You can manually enter credit card transactions using this window.
C H A PT ER
11
M ANAGING
BANK
AND
CREDIT
CARD
ACCOUNTS
275
Select the appropriate credit card account and then use the store receipt as a reference document to fill in the transaction.
You can skip the Purchased From field. If you want, you can use this field to
track the vendor or store name. You can use the Purchased From field to note the vendor (store) name if you want to track this. (You may only want to track vendors with bills, so this is optionalin other words, it is similar to petty cash expenses.) If the transaction is a return, be sure to select the Refund/Credit option at the top of the window. You can enter the receipt number in the Ref No. field. Enter the date of the purchase. Use the Expenses tab for general expenses, and use the Items tab if you used the credit card to buy inventory items for resale. If you use the credit card to purchase an item or incur an expense for a customer, select the customer so you can bill them for reimbursement (see Chapter 18 for details about entering reimbursable expenses).
Click Save & New to save the record and record another credit card transaction, or click Save & Close if youre finished entering credit card charges.
T I P : You can also enter these charges directly in the register of your credit card account.
You can read about reconciling bank and credit card accounts in detail in Chapter 12. Before you can reconcile a bank or credit card account the first time, you need to set up the accounts beginning balance. (Youll find information about setting up the beginning balance for a bank or credit card account in Chapter 14.) In the following section, Ill briefly describe the reconciliation process, which, for a credit card, ends with the option of paying the credit card bill. Choose Banking | Reconcile from the QuickBooks menu bar to open the Begin Reconciliation window.
276
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
In the Account field, select the credit card from the drop-down list. In the Begin Reconciliation dialog box, enter the following data:
The ending balance from the credit card bill Any finance charges on the bill in the Finance Charge box, along with the date
when the charges were assessed The account you use to post finance charges Click Continue to open the Reconcile Credit Card window, which displays the credit card purchases and payments you entered into QuickBooks. Click the check mark column for each transaction on your window that has a matching transaction on the credit card bill.
N O T E : You can add any transactions you forgot to enter by opening the
credit card register and entering the transactions. Right-click and choose Use Register.
When the Difference is $0.00, click Reconcile Now. If the difference is not $0.00, read Chapter 12 to learn how to troubleshoot reconciliations.
Chapter 12 Chapter 12
n this chapter:
Reconciling an existing bank account the first time Using the Begin Reconciliation window Entering interest income and service charges Reconciling transactions Finishing reconciliation Printing reconciliation reports Troubleshooting reconciliation issues
277
278
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Reconciling bank accounts is one of the most important, and most dreaded, tasks connected with financial record keeping. But reconciling a bank account in QuickBooks is much easier than reconciling on paper. Reconciling is important because it gives you the opportunity to compare the amount you think you have in your bank account with the amount the bank says you have in the account. Banks make mistakes, so reconciling is important. In this chapter, Ill go over the steps required to reconcile your bank accounts.
The bank hasnt yet processed a check. The bank processed the check in a previous period. You voided the check and didnt issue it, so the bank will never process it. You used a different bank account when recording the check.
The process of reconciling makes sure all transactions that appear on the bank statement also appear in the corresponding QuickBooks account. If the reconciliation process identifies transactions that appear on the bank statement but not in QuickBooks, you add them to QuickBooks using the same procedures you used to enter the transactions that appear both on the bank statement and in QuickBooks. Refer to Chapter 4 for details on making deposits, and Chapter 7 for details on paying vendor bills and writing direct disbursement checks.
CHAPTER
12
RECONCILING
BANK
ACCOUNTS
279
Reconciling your bank account starts with the Begin Reconciliation window, which you open by clicking the Reconcile icon on the Home page or by choosing Banking | Reconcile. If you have more than one bank account, select the account you want to reconcile from the drop-down list in the Account field.
Ill 12-1
N O T E : You also can reconcile credit card accounts. See Chapter 11 for
details.
Compare the Beginning Balance field in the window against the beginning balance on the bank statement. If the beginning balances match, enter the ending balance from your statement in the Ending Balance field, enter the statement date, and continue reading. If the beginning balances do not match, skip to the Troubleshooting Reconciliation Issues section later in this chapter. After you resolve the beginning balance issue, return to the next section, Enter Interest Income and Service Charges, and keep reading from there.
N O T E : If you use online banking and you entered the interest payments and
bank charges into your register as a result of downloading transactions, dont enter them again in the Begin Reconciliation window.
280
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
By bank charges, I mean the standard charges that banks assess, such as monthly charges that may be assessed for failure to maintain a minimum balance. Bank charges do not include special charges for bounced checks (yours or your customers) or any purchases you made that are charged to your account (such as the purchase of checks or deposit slips). You should enter those types of transactions as discrete transactions, using the Memo field to explain the transaction, to create an audit trail, and to make them easier to find in case you have to talk to the bank about your account.
FIGURE 12-1
CHAPTER
12
RECONCILING
BANK
ACCOUNTS
281
the check from the box so you can clear the transactions in case one of the following scenarios applies:
You issued a postdated check and the recipient cashed it early. Since its rare for
may have entered a wrong month or even a wrong year, which resulted in moving the transaction date into the future. You can also change the columns that display on each pane of the Reconcile window by clicking Columns To Display. You can add or remove columns, depending on their usefulness to you, as you clear transactions.
Ill 12-2
Clearing Transactions
To reconcile the bank statement with your QuickBooks bank account, you need to mark the transactions that appear on the bank statement as cleared transactions in QuickBooks. In the Reconcile window, click each transaction that appears on the bank statement. A check mark appears in the leftmost column to indicate the transaction has cleared the bank. If you clear a transaction in error, click again to remove the check markits a toggle. Use the following shortcuts to speed your work:
If all, or almost all, of the transactions have cleared, click Mark All. Then, click
Cleared column.
If the account youre reconciling is enabled for online access, click Matched to
automatically clear all transactions that were matched in the QuickStatements youve downloaded over the month. QuickBooks asks for the ending date on the statement and clears each matched transaction up to that date.
282
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
As you check each cleared transaction, the Difference amount in the lower-right corner of the Reconcile window changes. The goal is to get that figure to $0.00.
To open the bank account register, right-click anywhere in the Reconcile window and choose Use Register from the shortcut menu. When the account register opens, record the transaction. Return to the Reconcile window, where youll see that transaction. Pretty nifty! Check it off as cleared, of course, because it was on the statement. You can switch between the Reconcile window and the register for the account youre reconciling all through this process. Just click anywhere on the window you want to use to make it active. Sometimes youll want to change some of the information on a transaction. For example, you might realize the amount you entered in QuickBooks is wrong or you might have the wrong date on a check. Whatever the problem, you can correct it by editing the transaction. Double-click the transaction in the Reconcile window to display it in the transaction window where you created it. Enter the necessary changes and close the window. Answer Yes when QuickBooks asks if you want to record the changes. QuickBooks then redisplays the Reconcile window, where you see the changed transaction. Its also possible youll find a transaction in the Reconcile window that shouldnt be there, such as an ATM withdrawal you entered twice. Because Im not a fan of deleting transactions, I suggest you void the transaction. Double-click the transaction when it appears in the window where you created it, right-click it and select Void or choose Edit | Void. Close the window and save your changes. When QuickBooks redisplays the Reconcile window, the transaction will be gone.
CHAPTER
12
RECONCILING
BANK
ACCOUNTS
283
If a missing check number on your bank statement is puzzling, you can check its status. To see if the check cleared in the last reconciliation, open the Previous Reconciliation report (discussed later in this chapter) by choosing Reports | Banking | Previous Reconciliation. To investigate further, right-click anywhere in the Reconcile window and choose Missing Checks Report from the shortcut menu. When the Missing Checks Report dialog box appears, select the appropriate account and click OK. QuickBooks displays the Missing Checks report (see Figure 12-2).
FIGURE 12-2
284
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If the Missing Checks report indicates check numbers are missing, it means they dont exist in the account register for one of the following reasons:
You deleted the check. The check is physically missing. While you were printing checks, your printer jammed, and you restarted check
printing with the number of the first available check. In this case, QuickBooks doesnt mark checks as void. It just omits the numbers in the register.
CHAPTER
12
RECONCILING
BANK
ACCOUNTS
285
QuickBooks offers two reconciliation report types: Detail and Summary. The Reconciliation Detail report, shown in Figure 12-3, shows all the transactions that have cleared and all the transactions that havent cleared as of the statement closing date. The Reconciliation Summary report, shown in Figure 12-4, breaks down your transactions in the same way, but it doesnt list the individual transactions. It only shows the totals for each category: Cleared and Uncleared, breaking down the total for uncleared transactions into two categories and listing the number of transactions in each category.
Checks and Payments Deposits and Credits
Selecting the Detail Report makes it easier to resolve problems in the future. You have a list of every check and deposit and when it cleared. You also have to decide whether to print or display the report. I suggest you print both versions of the reconciliation report and attach them to your bank statement. Then, file both the bank statement and the report. Having these documents can make the difference between being able to fix the problem or having to undo the reconciliation and start from scratch, which can take hours.
FIGURE 12-3
286
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 12-4
CHAPTER
12
RECONCILING
BANK
ACCOUNTS
287
If the numbers differ, the problem lies in your QuickBooks companyperhaps theres a transaction you should have cleared but didnt, or a transaction you cleared that you shouldnt have. If youre sure you didnt make any mistakes clearing transactions, do the following:
Check for transposed figures by adding the digits of the amount QuickBooks
displays as the Difference. If the digits sum to 9, or a multiple of 9, youre working with a transposed number. For example, its possible you recorded a transaction for $549.00 and the bank cleared the same transaction for $594.00. Check the amount of each transaction against the amount in the bank statement. Check your transactions and make sure a deposit wasnt inadvertently entered as a payment (or vice versa). A clue for this is a transaction thats half the difference. If the difference is $220.00, find a transaction that has an amount of $110.00 and make sure its a deduction if its supposed to be a deduction (or the other way around).
T I P : You might want to let somebody else check over the statement and the register, because sometimes you cant see your own mistakes.
You changed the amount on a transaction you previously cleared. You voided a transaction you previously cleared. You deleted a transaction you previously cleared. You removed the cleared check mark from a transaction you previously cleared. You added the cleared check mark to a transaction in the register.
QuickBooks has a tool to help you figure out which one of those actions you took after you last reconciled the account. If youre viewing the Begin Reconciliation window, click the Locate Discrepancies button to open the Locate Discrepancies window and then click Discrepancy Report. If youve paused the reconciliation
288
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
process and arent viewing any of the reconciliation windows, you can choose Reports | Banking | Reconciliation Discrepancy to view the report.
Ill 12-4
Means you removed the check mark in the Cleared column of the register even though QuickBooks warned you about the dangers of taking this action. Amount Means you changed the amount of the transaction by the amount shown in the Effect Of Change column. Deleted Means you deleted the transaction. If you void a previously reconciled transaction, QuickBooks marks it as changed, and the Type Of Change is Amount. A transaction with a changed amount equal to, and opposite of, the original amount was almost certainly a transaction you voided after it cleared.
T I P : Even though the Discrepancy Report doesnt specify Void as the reason for a change in the beginning balance, the audit trail is quite clear about what happened. See Chapter 23 to learn about the QuickBooks audit trail.
CHAPTER
12
RECONCILING
BANK
ACCOUNTS
289
For transactions where the Type Of Change is either Uncleared or Amount, open the register and correct the transactioneither check the Cleared column or change the transaction amount back to its original amount to undo your mistake. Read the next section to learn how to handle discrepancies that result from deleted or voided transactions you previously cleared.
Click Continue to display the Reconcile window. Clear only the transactions you reentered. Click Reconcile Now. Print the reconciliation report.
register for amounts that changed after the account was reconciled. If you find any, restore the original amount.
290
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
reconcile it using the steps in the preceding section, Correcting Deleted or Voided Transactions. That transaction wasnt void when you performed the last reconciliation; it had cleared and shouldnt be marked void. If a transaction appears on the reconciliation report but not in the register, it was deleted. Reenter it and reconcile it using the steps in the preceding section, Correcting Deleted or Voided Transactions.
Choose the type of reconciliation report you want to view. (See the Finishing the Reconciliation section earlier in this chapter for details on each type of reconciliation report.) Then, select the transactions you want to include in the report. Choose Transactions Cleared At The Time Of Reconciliation (Report Is Displayed As A PDF File) to view an accurate account of your last reconciliation. If you printed a reconciliation report the last time you reconciled the account, the PDF file matches your printout. Transactions Cleared Plus Any Changes Made To Those Transactions Since The Reconciliation is a report on the current state of the account register, sorted in a way to display the accounts transactions according to cleared/uncleared/new categories. You can compare this report to the PDF version to help determine what has changed since a prior reconciliation if you suspect cleared transactions were altered.
CHAPTER
12
RECONCILING
BANK
ACCOUNTS
291
FYI
However, youll be best equipped to track down discrepancies if you print and file a reconciliation report every time you reconcile a bank account.
T I P : Just in case this process doesnt resolve your problem, back up your company file before you undo the last reconciliation so you can restore the data in its reconciled state. See Chapter 23 for details on backing up.
Follow these steps to undo the last reconciliation: Choose Banking | Reconcile to display the Begin Reconciliation dialog box.
Ill 12-6
292
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Click Undo Last Reconciliation. Click Continue. QuickBooks performs the following actions:
Removes the cleared status of all transactions you cleared during the last
reconciliation Leaves the amounts you entered for interest and bank charges When QuickBooks finishes, a message appears telling you the actions I just described were performed. Click OK to redisplay the Locate Discrepancies window. If you let QuickBooks make an adjustment entry during the last reconciliation, which is often the catalyst for undoing and redoing reconciliation, click Cancel to close the window. Open the accounts register and delete the adjustment entryits the entry posted to the Reconciliation Discrepancies account. Start the reconciliation process again. When the Begin Reconciliation window opens, the data that appear are the same data that appeared when you started the last reconciliation. Thus, the last reconciliation date, the statement date, and the beginning balance are back. Enter the ending balance from the bank statement. Do not enter the interest and bank charges again. They werent removed when QuickBooks undid the last reconciliation. Good luck!
Chapter 13 Chapter 13
n this chapter:
Understanding budgets and QuickBooks Creating a budget Reporting on budgets versus actual figures Exporting budgets Projecting cash flow Using QuickBooks decision tools
293
294
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
A budget is a tool used to help track your progress against your plans. A wellprepared budget can also help you draw money out of your business wisely because knowing what you plan to spend on staff, overheads, or other expenses in the future prevents you from carelessly withdrawing profits when you have a good month.
Types of Budgets
QuickBooks offers several types of budgets, and you can create one of each for a particular time period:
Budgets based on your Balance Sheet accounts Profit & Loss budgets based on your income and expense accounts Profit & Loss budgets based on income and expense accounts and a customer
or job Profit & Loss budgets based on income and expense accounts and a class (if youve enabled class tracking) You can create Profit & Loss budgets from scratch or use actual figures from the previous year. You can also generate Balance Sheet budgets from scratch. You can create only one of each type of budget for a particular time period. If you want to redo, for example, a Profit & Loss budget you created, you must edit the existing budget. The data for the existing budget reappear in the Set Up Budgets window whenever you open that window.
Deleting a Budget
Although you cant create two budgets of the same type for the same time period, you can delete an existing budget. Once you delete a budget, you can generate a new budget of that type for that time period.
T I P : If you really want two budgets of the same type for the same time period, export the first budget to Excel before you delete it and then create your second budget. See the section, Exporting Budgets, later in this chapter.
To delete a budget, choose Edit | Delete Budget from the QuickBooks menu bar while viewing the budget in the Set Up Budgets window.
C H A PT ER
13
USING
BUDGETS
AND
PLANNING
TOOLS
295
The Clear button deletes all figures in the budget windowyou cannot use this
can continue to work. The OK button records the current figures and closes the window. The Cancel button closes the window without saving any changes. The Create New Budget button opens the Create New Budget wizard. If youve entered any data, QuickBooks asks if you want to record your budget before closing the window. If you record your data (or have previously recorded your data with the Save button), the next time you open the Set Up Budgets window and view this budget, it will contain the data you recorded. The Show Next 6 Months button appears only if the display resolution of your computer is set lower than 1024768. In this case, QuickBooks displays only six months of the budget in the window and adds buttons to the window to move the display to the next six-month period, simultaneously changing the button name to Show Prev 6 Months. If your display resolution is equal to, or higher than, 1024768, all 12 months of the year appear in the Set Up Budgets window, and you wont see these buttons.
296
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
You use the other buttons in the Set Up Budgets window when entering data, so Ill go over them later in this chapter in the section, Enter Budget Amounts.
accounts while working in a budget, and you cannot budget for any account you marked inactive. (For details on adding an account, see Chapter 2.) The first month of the budget should be the same as the first month of your fiscal year for your budget to work properly. If you dont run your company on a calendar year or if you want to create a budget thats not based on your fiscal year, make sure your company setup uses the correct starting month. To enter the correct starting month for your fiscal year, choose Company | Company Information from the menu bar, set your fiscal year, and then click OK.
Creating a Budget
Budgets for Balance Sheet accounts predict the balance of the account as of the budget date while budgets for Profit and Loss Accounts predict the activity for the period of the budget. Because you cant predict the amounts for most Balance Sheet accounts, most companies budget for only a few Balance Sheet accountsfor example, most companies will have a budget to purchase and replace equipment and other fixed assets. Since budgeting for Profit & Loss accounts is more multifaceted than Budgeting for Balance Sheet accounts, Im going to focus on creating Profit & Loss budgets. To create a Profit & Loss budget, follow these steps: Choose Company | Planning & Budgeting | Set Up Budgets. If this is the first budget youre creating, the Create New Budget wizard opens automatically. If youve already created a budget, the Set Up Budgets window displays with your existing budget. Click Create New Budget to start the wizard.
C H A PT ER
13
USING
BUDGETS
AND
PLANNING
TOOLS
297
Ill 13-2
N O T E : If youre not operating on a calendar year, the budget year field spans
two calendar yearsfor instance, 200809 to accommodate your fiscal year.
Select Profit & Loss and click Next. Choose any additional criteria for this budget and click Next. You can include customers and jobs or classes in your budget. For this example, Ill create a Profit & Loss budget unconnected to customers or classes. Ill explain later in this chapter how to budget for customers and jobs, and for classes. Choose between creating a budget from scratch or from the figures from last years activities. Ill start by creating a budget from scratch; you can read about using last years data to create a budget later in this chapter in the section, Creating a Budget from Last Years Data. Click Finish to display all your income and expense accounts in the Set Up Budgets window (see Figure 13-1).
298
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 13-1
All active income and expense accounts appear in the Set Up Budgets window.
FIGURE 13-2
QuickBooks takes care of tracking the running total of your budget entries.
C H APT ER
13
USING
BUDGETS
AND
PLANNING
TOOLS
299
N O T E : If you see the Show Next 6 Months button when you enter the
amount for the sixth month, click it to continue entering budget values for the th rest of the months. When you finish entering the figures for the 12 month, click Show Prev 6 Months to redisplay the first half of the year and the next row.
300
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
The Set Up Budgets window appears, displaying last years actual data. For each account that had activity, the ending monthly balances appear in the appropriate month. When you build a budget using last years figures, you can use some techniques that are effective once numbers appear in the Set Up Budgets window.
T I P : If you intend to adjust all amounts starting from the first month, it doesnt matter where the insertion point appears on the accounts row.
Choose 1st Month or Currently Selected Month as the starting point for the calculationsfor this example, I chose Currently Selected Month. To increase the existing amount by a specified amount, click the first option and enter the amount. You also can increase the existing amount by a percentage, just enter the percentage rate and the percentage sign. To decrease the existing amount by a specified amount, click the second option and enter the amount. To decrease the existing amount by a percentage, enter the percentage rate and the percentage sign.
C H A PT ER
13
USING
BUDGETS
AND
PLANNING
TOOLS
301
T I P : Although the Enable Compounding option appears only when you select Currently Selected Month, if you place the insertion point in the first month and select the Currently Selected Month option, you can use compounding for the entire year.
When you enable compounding, QuickBooks increases or decreases the calculations for each month based on a formula starting with the currently selected month and taking into consideration the resulting change in the previous month. Use Table 13-1 to compare the results of using compounding versus not using compounding. For this example, assume the following conditions:
Initially all months for the row are empty. You enter $1,000.00 in the first month. You choose Currently Selected Month in the Start At box of the Adjust Row
Customer:Job Budgets
You can create a Profit & Loss budget for a customer or job. Usually, you only do this for a project that involves a substantial amount of money and/or covers a long period of time. For example, while looking at your Customer:Job reports, if you find yourself asking, Arent those expenses higher than they should be? or Why is one job less profitable than other similar jobs?, you might want to budget for that customer or job to get a handle on where and when expenses got out of hand. To create a budget for a customer or a job, follow these steps: Choose Company | Planning & Budgeting | Set Up Budgets. If this is the first budget youre creating, the Create New Budget wizard opens automatically. If youve already created a budget, the Set Up Budgets window displays with your existing budget. Click Create New Budget to start the wizard. Enter the year for which youre creating the budget. Select Profit & Loss and click Next.
Compounding Enabled?
Next Month
Next Month
Next Month
Next Month
Yes No
1,000.00 1,000.00
1,000.00 1,100.00
1,100.00 1,100.00
1,200.00 1,100.00
1,300.00 1,100.00
1,400.00 1,100.00
TABLE 13-1
302
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
On the Additional Profit and Loss Budget Criteria screen of the wizard, select Customer:Job and click Next.
Ill 13-5
Choose to create a budget from scratch and click Finish. QuickBooks displays your income and expense accounts in the Set Up Budgets window. The Set Up Budgets window contains a new fieldthe Current Customer:Job drop-down list box. Select the Customer:Job for this budget from the drop-down list. You can enter a monthly budget figure for each account as you did for a regular Profit & Loss budget. Or, you can enter a total budget figure in the first month. The latter option lets you compare accumulated data for expenses against the total budgeted figure by creating modified reports, where you change the report date to reflect the elapsed time for the project, and filter the report for this job only. If the project is lengthy, you may budget some accounts for some months and other accounts for other months. For example, if you have a project that involves purchases of goods, followed by installation of those goods, or training for the customers employees, you might choose to budget the purchases for the first few months and then the cost of the installation or training for the months in which those activities occur. Dont forget to click the Save button to save your work.
C A U T I O N : Customer:Job budgets dont work unless youre faithful about assigning transactions to the customer or job. If youve only been filling in the Customer:Job fields when the customer is billable, you wont be able to produce accurate budgets versus actual reports.
After youve created one budget based on a customer or job, creating a budget for a different customer or job is simple. After you save the first Customer:Job budget,
C H A PT ER
13
USING
BUDGETS
AND
PLANNING
TOOLS
303
select a different Customer:Job customer from the drop-down list and begin entering data. When you finish, click the Save button to save the budget for the second Customer:Job.
Class Budgets
If youre using class tracking, you can link your budget to any class youve created. If youre using classes to track income and expenses for branch offices, company divisions, or company departments, you can create useful budgets. While looking at your class-based reports, if you find yourself asking, Arent those expenses higher than they should be? or Why is one class less profitable than the other classes?, you might want to budget for that class to get a handle on where and when expenses have gotten out of hand. If you find yourself asking, Is this department contributing the income I expected?, include income accounts in your budget. You can use income accounts in class budgets to provide incentives to your employeesperhaps a bonus to a manager if the reality is better than the budget. To create a class-based budget, use the steps described earlier to create a budget and choose Class on the Additional Profit And Loss Budget Criteria Wizard screen. When QuickBooks displays the Set Up Budgets window, a Current Class field appears. Select the class for which you want to create a budget from the drop-down list and begin entering data.
Budget Repor ts
QuickBooks provides a number of budget reports you can use to see how youre doing. To print these reports, choose Reports | Budgets & Forecasts from the menu bar and then select one of the following reports:
Budget Overview Budget vs. Actual Profit & Loss Budget Performance Budget vs. Actual Graph
Budget Overview
QuickBooks supplies a wizard to help you produce an overview of a Profit & Loss budget, a Balance Sheet budget, a Customer:Job budget, and, if you use classes, a Class budget. Regardless of the type of budget you choose, the report shows the accounts you budgeted and the amounts you budgeted for each month. The report doesnt include accounts you didnt include in the budget.
304
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 13-3
The Profit & Loss Budget Overview displays your budget in an easy-to-read format.
C H A PT ER
13
USING
BUDGETS
AND
PLANNING
TOOLS
305
If you want to tweak the budget, or play what if games by experimenting with different numbers, click the Export button to send the report to Microsoft Excel. See the Exporting Budgets section later in this chapter for more information on exporting budget reports to Excel.
total budget amounts (for all customer budgets you created) for each month that has data. No budget information for individual customers appears. Account By Customer:Job lists each account you used in the budget as a row on the report, and each customer appears in a column. This report also includes a column that displays the annual total for each account. Customer:Job By Month displays a row for each customer that has a budget and a column for each month. The report includes budget totals for each month and each Customer:Job. No individual accounts appear on this report. Each job that has a budget appears as a row under the appropriate customers row.
total budget amounts for each month that has data. No budget information for individual classes appears. Account By Class lists each account you used in the budget as a row and each class as a column. This report also includes a column that displays the annual total for each account. Class By Month displays a row for each class that has a budget, and shows a column for each month. The report includes totals for each month and each class; no individual accounts appear on this report.
306
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Like the Budget Overview report, you produce this report using the Budget Report Wizard, and the choices for the budget type are the same as the Budget Overview. This report lists all of the accounts in your general ledger, even if you didnt include them in your budget. However, only the accounts you used in your budget show budget figures. You can remove accounts that dont show budget figures by customizing the report. Click the Modify Report button at the top of the report window. In the Modify Report dialog box, click the Advanced button to open the Advanced Options dialog box. Click the Show Only Rows And Columns With Budgets option. Click OK twice to redisplay the Budget vs. Actual Report window, which now displays only data connected to your budgeted accounts.
T I P : You can memorize the report settings so you dont have to make these modifications the next time you want to view the report. Click the Memorize button at the top of the report window and then give the report a meaningful name. To view the memorized report, choose Reports | Memorized Reports.
C H A PT ER
13
USING
BUDGETS
AND
PLANNING
TOOLS
307
Click Export. Excel opens, containing your report. You can use the Auto Outline and Auto Filtering features of Excel to hide and display data.
308
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Chapter 14 Chapter 14
n this chapter:
Understanding the QuickBooks journal entry window Entering the opening trial balance Making adjustments to the general ledger Depreciating fixed assets Recording entries for outside payroll services
309
310
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
As you work in the transaction windows in QuickBooks, it transfers the amounts involved in the financial transactions to your general ledger. In addition to updating the general ledger using transaction windows, you can enter numbers directly into the general ledger using a journal entry transaction. You should use journal entries, also called general journal entries, only when you cant find a standard transaction window to accomplish the task of updating the general ledger. Also, dont be afraid to ask your accountant for help setting up a journal entry.
FIGURE 14-1
As you enter a journal entry, QuickBooks displays the remaining balance of the entry on the last line so you dont have to recalculate.
CHAPTER
14
USING
JOURNAL
ENTRIE S
311
To create a journal entry, follow these steps: Choose Company | Make General Journal Entries. A message appears telling you that QuickBooks automatically assigns numbers to journal entries. You can enable and disable the automatic numbering feature in the Accounting category of the Preferences dialog box. Check the Do Not Display This Message In The Future box and then click OK. Click in the Account column, and then click the arrow to see a drop-down list of your chart of accounts. Choose the account you need. Press TAB to reach either the Debit or Credit column, whichever is appropriate for this line of the entry, and enter the amount for the selected account. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for all the lines of the journal entry. As you enter each amount, QuickBooks displays the offsetting total in the next line. For example, if the lines youve entered so far have a higher total for the debit side than the credit side, then the next line presents the balancing offset. Use the columns QuickBooks adds to a traditional journal entry window in the following ways:
Use the Memo column to describe the purpose of the journal entry, which will
T I P : By default, QuickBooks automatically transfers any text you enter in the Memo field on the first line of the transaction to all subsequent lines of the transaction. If you dont like this behavior, you can change it by choosing Edit | Preferences, clicking the Accounting Category, clicking the My Preferences tab, and removing the check from the Autofill Memo In General Journal Entry checkbox.
You can use the Name column to link the selected line of the journal entry to a
customer, vendor, employee, or other name. You must supply a name if you assign a journal entry line to an A/R account, an A/P account, or the Sales Tax Payable account. If you select an expense account and assign a customer name to it, you can make the expense reimbursable if you click in the Billable? column. If you enabled classes, you can use the Class column to assign the line to a class. (See Chapter 23 for information about classes.)
312
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FYI
Previous Equity
You can create a separate equity account for your previous equity. Indeed, using a separate account makes it easier to manage numbers at the end of the year when youre closing books. QuickBooks will post profit (or loss) to the Retained Earnings equity account, and you can scroll down into the details of the account to see the closing entries to Retained Earnings separately by year, making it less necessary to set up a separate equity account for previous equity.
CHAPTER
14
USING
JOURNAL
ENTRIE S
313
If you start QuickBooks so late in the year that you dont want to enter individual transactions since the beginning of the year, you can create a separate journal entry for the opening balances of income and expense accounts and post the amount needed to balance the entry to the Opening Bal Equity account. If you post one journal entry per month, youll be able to produce monthly Profit & Loss reports for the current year, as well as monthly comparison reports for years to come.
Entering Opening Balances for Bank Accounts and Credit Card Accounts
N O T E : Everything I say in this section about bank accounts also applies to
credit card accounts. To keep things simple, Ill talk in terms of bank accounts.
When most people start using QuickBooks, they already have a bank account that they must set up in QuickBooks. Establishing the correct opening information for an existing bank account that you set up in QuickBooks includes two kinds of information:
Setting the correct opening balance. Recording transactions that occurred but did not clear your bank before you
started using QuickBooks. Setting up the correct opening information is essential to successfully reconciling the accountboth the first time and in the futureso establish your bank and credit card account opening balances before you try to reconcile these accounts.
314
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Use the following steps to set the beginning balance for your checking account: Open the bank account register (press CTRL+R and select the appropriate account). Add a transaction dated earlier than the ending date on your bank statement. Set the amount of the transaction to the ending balance on your bank statement and dont enter anything in the Number column.
N O T E : If you originally set up this account with an amount other than $0 for
the opening balance, youll see an opening balance entry. Its probably the earliest entry in the register and uses the Opening Bal Equity account in the Account field. Instead of adding a transaction in Step 2, edit the existing transaction to change its amount to match the beginning balance on your bank statement. When you save the transaction, QuickBooks issues a warning message about changing this transaction and asks if you really want to record your changes. Click Yes.
If you prefer, you can use the Make Deposits window. When you choose Banking | Make Deposits and the Payments to Deposit window appears, click Cancel. Then, in the Make Deposits window, record one deposit for each date you made a deposit at the bank. Click Save & New as you complete each individual deposit. Using this technique to record the transactions that occurred but did not clear the bank before you started using QuickBooks creates an audit trail and makes reconciliation easy.
CHAPTER
14
USING
JOURNAL
ENTRIE S
315
So, I suggest that you enter individual transactions for outstanding invoices and bills. When you enter those invoices and bills, use the original dates you created those transactions. By using the original date, you retain aging for the outstanding transactions. You must post these transactions to the Opening Balance Equity account by setting up a special itemyou might call it OBE (for Opening Bal Equity)and using it on each invoice and bill you create. To avoid creating lots of items that youll only use while setting up QuickBooks, use the Description field to describe the detail that appeared on these invoices and bills created before you started using QuickBooks.
When you complete this process, along with the other opening balance entries described in this chapter, the balance in the Opening Bal Equity account should be $0.
C A U T I O N : As you create the customer, QuickBooks offsets any opening balance you enter for that customer to Uncategorized Income, not to Opening Bal Equity. If you entered opening balances for customers as you set up the customers, create a journal entry that debits Uncategorized Income and credits Opening Bal Equity. Then, use the approach I describe here.
316
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FYI
CHAPTER
14
USING
JOURNAL
ENTRIE S
317
You also can print the Adjusting Journal Entries report to display adjusting journal entries you made. Click the arrow beside the Reports button in the Make General Journal Entries window and choose Adjusting Journal Entries.
N O T E : When you change the account an item uses, QuickBooks asks if you
want to change all previous uses of the item to the new account. Clicking Yes would be an easy way to move the income from the single income account to the more specific ones. However, if you click Yes, QuickBooks will move all transactions from all previous years. If you want to move just the transactions after a certain point in time (like the beginning of the current year), then the preceding method is required.
You may make the same decision about expenses, deciding to break down an expense to better manage it. For example, you may want to separate your insurance account into several subaccounts for car insurance, equipment insurance, building insurance, malpractice insurance, and so on. For this example, you would credit the original expense account for the amount youre taking out of it and then debit each new expense subaccount(s) for the appropriate amount(s). You can apply this logic to a fixed-asset account named Vehicles that you want to divide into more specific accounts to track a truck separately from a car, especially if you purchase them in different years. You can also separate out any accumulated depreciation to assign it to the correct asset.
318
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
I never post any information to the parent account. I post asset purchases to a subaccount and I post my journal entry for depreciation to a subaccount for the following reasons:
I can look at either the asset subaccount or the depreciation subaccount to see a
running total instead of a calculated net total. Tracing the year-to-year depreciation is easy. Each line in the depreciation subaccount register represents a year. Its quick and easy to open the depreciation subaccount if Im asked about the depreciation totalwhich is handy if you sell the asset and have to add back the depreciation. The net value of my fixed assets is easily visible on my Balance Sheet report (see Figure 14-2).
CHAPTER
14
USING
JOURNAL
ENTRIE S
319
FIGURE 14-2
To depreciate fixed assets, you record a journal entry that uses a depreciation account in the Expense section of your chart of accounts. Follow these steps: Choose Company | Make General Journal Entries from the menu bar. Choose the first asset accumulated depreciation subaccount. Enter the depreciation amount in the Credit column. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for each asset you need to depreciate. QuickBooks automatically tracks the offsetting amount in the Debit column as you work. Choose the Depreciation Expense account. The total amount of the credits appears automatically in the Debit column (see Figure 14-3). Click Save & Close.
320
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 14-3
Reversing Entries
Reversing entries are general journal entries you enter on one date and then reverse on another (later) date. For example, you may need to accrue wages and salaries for amounts earned in one year but paid in the next year. You can use a reversing journal entry to handle this situation. When QuickBooks reverses the journal entry on the first of the new year, the net expense for each year will be just what was earned in that year. To enter a reversing journal entry, click the Reverse icon at the top of the Make General Journal Entries window after you save the journal entry. By default, QuickBooks creates the new reversed journal entry and dates it the first day of the following month.
CHAPTER
14
USING
JOURNAL
ENTRIE S
321
company use direct deposit, and most companies prefer to use direct deposit because it is cheaper than printing paychecks. You can use the report you get from the outside payroll service to enter a journal entry in QuickBooks that accounts for the payroll transactions that took place. There are three parts to recording payroll:
Transferring money to the payroll account Entering the payroll figures Entering the employer expense figures
Employer-matching contributions to FICA and Medicare Employer-matching contributions to pension plans Employer-matching contributions to benefits Employer state unemployment assessments Employer FUTA Any other government or benefit payments paid by the employer
322
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Account
Debit
Credit
Salaries and wages expense FIT liability FICA liability Medicare liability State income tax liability Local income tax liability State SDI liability State SUI liability Benefits contribution liability 401(k) contribution liability Other deductions liability Payroll Cash account
Gross payroll Total federal income tax withheld Total FICA withheld Total Medicare withheld Total state tax withheld Total local tax withheld Total state SDI withheld Total state SUI withheld Total benefits withheld Total 401(k) withheld Total other deductions withheld Net amount on paycheck
TABLE 14-1
In this journal entry, you post payments to the same account you used when you withheld the amounts, effectively washing the liability accounts. Youre not really spending money; youre remitting money youve withheld from employees. You can have as many individual employer expense accounts as you think you need, or you can post all the employer expenses to one account named payroll expenses.
Account Debit Credit
Federal payroll tax expense Federal withholdings liability State and local withholdings liability SUTA expense FUTA expense Employer contributions expense Payroll bank account TABLE 14-2
Employer FICA and Medicare All federal withholding All local withholding Employer SUTA Employer FUTA All employer benefit, pension, etc. Total of checks written
CHAPTER
14
USING
JOURNAL
ENTRIE S
323
N O T E : Dont let your payroll service take their fee from the payroll account.
Instead, write them a check from your operating account. The fee for the service is not a payroll expense; its an operating expense.
Close the Make General Journal Entries window. QuickBooks displays a message asking if you want to save the transaction you just created. Click No and then repeat this process for the journal entry you create to record employer payments. When youre ready to record payroll, use the Memorized Transaction List to open the memorized transactions, fill in the correct figures, and save them.
324
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Chapter 15 Chapter 15
n this chapter:
Creating and modifying reports Working with memorized reports Exporting report information Reviewing financial reports Reporting on deleted and voided transactions Consolidating reports for multiple companies ODBC reporting and QuickBooks Enterprise Customizing Forms
325
326
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
After you spend a considerable amount of time entering information about the state of your business, youll want to produce reports that show you that information in a variety of ways. QuickBooks contains a wide variety of reports that show you the information you enter from a variety of perspectives. There isnt room in this chapter to cover every report available in QuickBooks, so the chapter focuses on helping you learn how to make reports work for you. In addition to learning how to print reports, you learn how to customize reports, memorize reports, and make memorized reports work for you. You also learn how to export report information to Excel and to comma-separated values files. In this chapter, I also review some of the various financial reports available in QuickBooks, as well as reports that help you track down deleted and voided transactions. These are only a few of the reports available in QuickBooks, but the information in this chapter should give you a good head start on exploring the other reports on your own.
Creating a Repor t
QuickBooks contains a wide variety of reports. If you know the report that you want to print, open the Reports menu, point at the general category for the report and click the report title. However, if you dont know what report to print, you can use the Report Navigator to help you find the report that meets your needs. The Report Navigator feature shows you a sample of each report before you print it and a brief description of the information that the report provides. You can view samples and descriptions of many different reports to help you identify the report that is appropriate for your needs. Once you find the report, you preview it onscreen, and then, if necessary, you can set the criteria you need to modify the report to display the information you want to see. Lets take a look at the way you use the Report Navigator. Choose Reports | Report Navigator or click the Report Center button on the Icon Bar. The Report Center window appears (see Figure 15-1). Click one of the categories along the side of the window to select a report typefor this example, we selected Accountant & Taxes. Descriptions of each report appear beside the report name. Move the mouse pointer over the icon that appears beside any report. A sample of the report appears. To preview the report onscreen, click the report name link (see Figure 15-2). Ive chosen to use the Transaction Detail By Account report for this example because I find that whenever I want to create a custom report, this report or the Transaction List By Date report typically provide a good foundation because of the level of detail they display.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
327
FIGURE 15-1
Use the mouse to point at a reports icon and see a sample of the report.
At this point, if the report looks the way you want, you can print it by clicking the Print button at the top of the report. Or, you can work onscreen. For example, you can move the mouse point over an entry on the report and the mouse pointer changes to a magnifying glass, indicating that you can zoom in to see the details of the entry. Double-click the entry and QuickBooks displays details. On a report like the Transaction Detail By Account, when you double-click, QuickBooks displays the transaction in the window where you created it. On reports that summarize information, such as the A/R Aging Summary or the Balance Sheet, QuickBooks displays a detail report of the entry you double-clickand you can double-click that report to display transactions. When you redisplay the original report, QuickBooks remembers your location in the report.
328
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 15-2
A report onscreen
T I P : You can rearrange the columns of reports that list details, like the Transaction Detail By Account report. Hold your mouse pointer over a column heading, and youll see the mouse pointer change to a hand. Then, drag the column heading to a new location on the report. As you drag, you will see the name of the column you are moving attached to the mouse pointer. As the mouse pointer reaches a location where you can place the column, you will see a red arrow pointing upward. When you release the mouse button, QuickBooks rearranges the report.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
329
FYI
If you are more comfortable, you can work from the Modify Report dialog box to do everything except rearrange report columns. Click the Modify Report button to display the Modify Reports dialog box. In the Modify Reports dialog box, youll find four tabs that help you modify the information in the report. If you make changes that dont work as you thought they would, click the Revert button on any tab of the Modify Report dialog box to reset all options to their default state.
FYI
330
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 15-3
cases, you can select a date range for the report and a sorting order for the report. You can also typically select the columns that appear on the report. For some reports, you can also select rows. And, in many cases, you can choose whether to print the report on a cash basis or an accrual basis.
T I P : You wont see a column in the Sort By list unless you have placed a check beside it in the Columns list.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
331
FIGURE 15-4
You can change what QuickBooks displays on the report by filtering the data.
a particular account or types of accounts. Or, you can filter to include only certain types of transactions, such as checks or invoices. Once you select a filter and the options for it, the filter appears in the Current Filter Choices list on the right side of the dialog box. If you change your mind about a filters settings, click the filter in the Current Filter Choices list and either modify its settings or click Remove Selected Filter.
332
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 15-5
Set up the information in the top and bottom of the report page using the Header/Footer tab.
FIGURE 15-6
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
333
On the right side of the dialog box, you can change the way QuickBooks displays numbers on your report. Select a method for showing negative numbers. If you wish, you can also choose a method for displaying all the numbers on the report. The options available vary from report to report:
Divided By 1000 reduces the size of the numbers by showing them as
multiples of 1000. This is useful for companies that report seven- and eightdigit numbers. Except Zero Amounts removes all instances of $0.00 and leaves the entry blank. Without Cents eliminates the decimal point and the two digits to the right of the decimal point from every amount. Only the dollars show, not the cents. QuickBooks rounds the cents to the nearest dollar. When you finish making changes, click OK and QuickBooks displays your modified report.
N O T E : You can memorize any report, but theres more reason to memorize
a customized report because memorizing saves customized settings.
Once youve memorized a report, you can display it by choosing Reports | Memorized Reports from the QuickBooks menu bar and selecting the report name from the submenu.
334
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
T I P : You can rearrange memorized reports and groups in the Memorized Report List window using the same technique you use to rearrange other lists in QuickBooks. Note the diamond that appears to the left of each report and report group name in the Report Name column. Drag the diamond to move the report. And yes, you can move a report from one report group to another.
To create a Memorized Report Group, follow these steps: Click Reports | Memorized Reports | Memorized Report List. The Memorized Report List window appears. Click Memorized Report | New Group. The New Memorized Report Group window appears. In this window, you can only type a name for the Report Group and click OK or Cancel. Type a namesuch as EOM for End of Monthfor the report group and click OK. The Memorized Report List window reappears, and your new group appears alphabetically in the list.
FIGURE 15-7
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
335
Next, you add reports to the group. Follow these steps: Print the report to your display. Click the Memorize button in the report window. The Memorize Report dialog box appears.
Ill 15-1
Place a check in the Save In Memorized Report Group box. Choose the group from the list. Click OK to save the report to the memorized report group. Repeat these five steps for each report you want to include in the group. When you redisplay the Memorized Report List, youll see all your reports listed under your report group in alphabetical ordernot in the order you memorized them.
336
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 15-8
C A U T I O N : Dont include custom fields that you added to the company file youre using when you memorize the report. Those fields wont exist in other QuickBooks company files.
To export a memorized report template, follow these steps: Choose Reports | Memorized Reports | Memorized Report List. Click the report you want to export. Click the Memorized Report button at the bottom of the window and select Export Template. QuickBooks displays the Specify Filename For Export dialog box. Navigate to the drive and folder where you want to save the report. Click Save. QuickBooks saves the report template, supplying by default, a .QBR extension. You can now send the report template to a QuickBooks user via e-mail or disk. If you receive an exported report template, the process of importing it converts the template into a memorized report thats added to the currently open company file.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
337
To import a template, follow these steps: Choose Reports | Memorized Reports | Memorized Report List. Click the Memorized Report button at the bottom of the window, and select Import Template. QuickBooks displays the Select File To Import dialog box. Navigate to the drive and folder that contains the template file you received, and double-click it. QuickBooks displays the Memorize Report dialog box. Enter a name for the report or accept the displayed name, which is the name used by the person who exported the template. You can place the report in an existing memorized report group. To do so, check the Save In Memorized Report Group box and use the drop-down arrow to select the group. Click OK. The report now appears in the Memorized Report List.
FIGURE 15-9
338
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
select the type of exported file you want to create. When exporting to Excel, you can export to a new or existing Excel workbook, and QuickBooks can include a worksheet that explains how to link Excel worksheets so that updating one worksheet updates another. The Advanced tab contains options you can use to preserve report formatting and set a variety of Excel features when you export the report. None of these options is available if you export the report information to a comma-separated values file.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
339
FIGURE 15-10
a report on your financial health. The Balance Sheet is based on the following formula:
L 15-1
QuickBooks offers several Balance Sheet reports (Table 15-1 describes the information that QuickBooks displays on each of these reports by default). Select the one you want to see by choosing Reports | Company & Financial and then choosing the report. Figure 15-11 shows the Balance Sheet standard report.
340
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Description
Balance Sheet Standard Report Balance Sheet Detail Report Balance Sheet Summary Report Balance Sheet Prev Year Comparison Report
Reports the year-to-date balance in every Balance Sheet account (unless the account has a zero balance) and subtotals each account type: asset, liability, and equity. Displays, for the current month-to-date, every transaction in every Balance Sheet account, making this a lengthy report. Displays totals by account type. For example, you wont see individual bank accounts on this report, but youll see one line for Checking/Savings accounts. Shows you what your financial situation is now compared to a year ago. For each balance sheet account, the report displays four columns of information: the year-todate balance; last years year-to-date balance; the amount of change between last year and this year; and the percentage of change between last year and this year.
TABLE 15-1
FIGURE 15-11
Check your financial health with the Balance Sheet standard report.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
341
liabilities. This figure appears as a small yellow box, and if its a positive figure, its above the line. If you double-click an asset bar, liability bar, or equity box, QuickBooks displays a pie chart graph representing the percentage that each account balance contributed to the total.
FIGURE 15-12
342
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
N O T E : If you dont sell inventory items, you probably dont have a Cost Of
Goods Sold section in your Profit & Loss.
QuickBooks contains seven variations of the Profit & Loss report, as described in Table 15-2 (Figure 15-13 shows the Profit & Loss standard report). All of the Profit & Loss reports are available by choosing Reports | Company & Financial. You can change the date range to view a variety of different scenariosthe current month, the current quarter, and the current year, just to name a view.
Description
Profit & Loss Standard Report Profit & Loss Detail Report Profit & Loss YTD Comparison Report Profit & Loss Prev Year Comparison Report Profit & Loss By Job Report
Shows the totals for each income, COGS, and expense account, and the calculations for Gross and Net Profit for the current month-to-date. Lists every transaction for every account in the Profit & Loss format. Compares the current months income and expense totals with the yearto-date totals. Shows income and expenses for the current year-to-date, last years figure for the same period, and the difference between the years in dollars and in percentage. Presents a year-to-date summary of income and expenses posted to customers and jobs. Each customer or job appears in a separate column, and the bottom row of each column is the net income or loss for each customer or job. If youve enabled class tracking to track income and expense for, say, branch offices or company divisions, this report shows the Profit & Loss for each class. If youve enabled class tracking, this report displays a Profit & Loss generated from transactions to which you didnt assign a class.
Profit & Loss By Class Report Profit & Loss Unclassified Report TABLE 15-2
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
343
FIGURE 15-13
344
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 15-14
See how your cash position changed during the period you specified in the date fields.
You can see where your cash came from and where it went, categorized as follows:
Operating Activities
The transactions involved with maintaining the business. Investing Activities The transactions involved with the acquisition of fixed assets. Financing Activities The transactions involved with long-term liabilities and owners activities (such as investments and draws). QuickBooks generates this report on an accrual basis, and you cant specify accrual or cash-based calculations. Because cash flow is a cash-based figure, QuickBooks adjusts amounts to turn this accrual-based report into a cash-based report.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
345
FIGURE 15-15
Check with your accountant before you make any changes here.
The bottom line is cash-based, but instead of just displaying cash-based figures, QuickBooks takes an accrual-based report and shows you the adjustments that had to be made to create a cash-based report. If you dont owe money to anyone and nobody owes you money, you wont see any adjustments. QuickBooks predetermines the accounts used in the Statement Of Cash Flows report, and you can view the account list by choosing Edit | Preferences and selecting the Reports & Graphs icon in the left pane. On the Company Preferences tab, click Classify Cash to open the Classify Cash dialog box seen in Figure 15-15. The default settings that QuickBooks established work quite well. You can add and remove accounts and move selected accounts to a different category, but thats dangerous unless your accountant recommends such a step. If your accountant knows youre using an account thats not selected for transactions that should be included in the report, or vice versa, its okay to make changes.
C A U T I O N : Make sure your accountant knows that QuickBooks doesnt permit Balance Sheet accounts to be removed from the list, although they can be moved to a different category.
346
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 15-16
QuickBooks produces this forecast using the assumption that all accounts receivable will arrive when due and all accounts payable will be paid when due. However, that assumption may not be realistic for your business. To enhance the reality of the report, you can use the Delay Receipts field at the top of the report to tell QuickBooks to assume that your customers will pay late by the amount of days you specify in that field. This is useful if you know that your customers pay late by an average of x number of days.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
347
N O T E : The Audit Trail is most useful if you set up roles in QuickBooks and
assign passwords so each user logs in using his or her own name. Dont let everyone log in as Admin. Youll find it very difficult to track down honest mistakes, not to mention embezzlement. When everyone signs in using his or her own name, the Audit Trail report shows exactly who made what changes and when.
348
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 15-17
If you have separate QuickBooks company files for multiple companies, or for multiple locations, divisions, and so forth, you can use the Combine Reports feature to get a consolidated view of all the data files. You can create the following reports as consolidated reports:
Balance Sheet Standard Balance Sheet Summary Profit & Loss Standard Statement of Cash Flows Trial Balance
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
349
You set up the consolidated reports in QuickBooks, selecting the companies and the report types. Then, QuickBooks sends the data to Microsoft Excel for consolidation, so you must have Excel installed on your computer to use this feature. If you have permission to create consolidated company reports, follow these steps to create a combined report: Open one of the companies you want to include in the report(s). Choose Reports | Combine Reports From Multiple Companies. The Combine Reports From Multiple Companies window appears (see Figure 15-18). The open company appears in the window by default. Click the Add Files button to navigate to the locations of other companies you want to include in the combined reports. You can include any QuickBooks Enterprise company with a company filename extension of .qbw or .qba. Click beside each report you want to combine to select the report. If necessary, change the report date range. Select Cash or Accrual for the report basis. If you want, change the name in the Company Name To Be Shown On Reports box. You can click the Excel Options button to turn on Excel features such as Auto Outline and Auto Filtering. Click Combine Reports in Excel. QuickBooks opens each company you included in the Combine Reports From Multiple Companies window in multiuser mode and collects the data it needs to send to Excel. Excel opens and displays your combined report.
FIGURE 15-18
Use this window to select companies to combine and produce combined reports.
350
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
T I P : A single-user access read-only version of the ODBC driver is included in the box with QuickBooks Enterprise. Users of other editions of QuickBooks can purchase the driver. Versions of the driver are available for all current versions of the QuickBooks product line. See the Upgrade tab of the Configure ODBC Driver For QuickBooks dialog box for more information. N O T E : While ODBC allows ODBC-compliant access to QuickBooks .qbw
files, it does not provide direct access to the QuickBooks data tables.
To install the ODBC driver, choose File | Utilities | Set Up ODBC and follow the prompts that take you to the Internet to download and install the driver. Or, you can use the driver that comes on your QuickBooks Enterprise CD. Insert your QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions 8.0 installation disk into the drive. If setup starts, cancel it. Using Computer or My Computer, navigate to X:\QBooks\ODBC (where X is the drive containing your installation disk) and double-click ODBC.exe. Whether you download the driver from the Internet or use the one on your installation CD, the welcome screen of an installation wizard appears. Click Next and the ODBC driver is installed. Click Finish to close the setup wizard.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
351
Once you complete the installation, you can configure the ODBC driver. For the most part, you want to accept the default options youll see while configuring. To configure the driver, choose File | Utilities | Configure ODBC. The Configure ODBC Driver For QuickBooks dialog box appears. The dialog box contains nine tabs: General, Messages, Optimizer, Server Edition, Remote Connector, Online Edition, Advanced, Activate, and About. From the General tab, you can:
Select the company data file to which the ODBC driver will connect/
communicate. Assign a unique DSN name for the connection. Test the connection to make sure that the driver is communicating properly with the QuickBooks company data (QBW) file. You should use the default settings for these options. From the Messages tab, you can:
Check and clear the ODBC Message Log. Check the SDK Message Log. Review and clear the optional Trace Log. Turn the ODBC Status Panels on and off.
Use the three logs listed earlier for troubleshooting purposes. Status panels notify you when the ODBC driver is accessing QuickBooks data. Youll want to enable the Display Optimizer Status Panel option and the Display Driver Status Panel option. From the Optimizer tab, you can turn the Optimizer on and off, and you can specify the frequency with which you optimize your data. The ODBC Optimization routine takes the information from the QuickBooks company file, optimizes it, and stores it in an encrypted file outside the QuickBooks company file. The Optimizer stores the optimized file on a local drive on your network even if your QuickBooks company file resides on your server. You want to use the Optimizer because it speeds up the rate at which third-party applications are able to pull information from QuickBooks company files. However, you should consider changing the default frequency to The Last Time I Pressed One Of The Load Data Buttons.
352
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Intuit feels this option offers you the best trade-off between up-to-date data and performance.
Ill 15-2
The first time you optimize any QuickBooks company file, youll need to fill out a security certificate that allows the ODBC driver to access that QuickBooks company file. Youll also need to fill out a security certificate to allow third-party applications to access your QuickBooks company file. From the Server Edition tab, you can choose to use DCOM servers to connect QODBC to system service applications like IIS and Microsoft SQL Server. If you prefer, you can use the Remote Connector tab to configure /n Softwares IBiz Integrator to connect remotely to another process that is running QuickBooks and the Remote Connector Server Application. From the Online Edition tab, you can configure the QODBC driver to connect to a QuickBooks Online Edition company file. From the Advanced tab, you can set options that tweak a configuration. For most users, the defaults should work just fine. The last two tabs are informational: from the Activate tab, you can purchase the version of the ODBC driver that permits you to write data back to your QuickBooks file as well as read data from your QuickBooks data file. From the About tab, you can identify your version of the ODBC driver.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
353
Customizing Templates
QuickBooks makes it very easy to customize the templates you use to create transactions such as invoices, purchase orders, and statements. You can use an existing template as the basis of a new template, copying what you like, changing what you dont like, and eliminating what you dont need. Customizing a template impacts the printed look and feel of the selected form and adds fields to the onscreen version of the form. You can preview the form in the Manage Templates dialog box that appears later in this section. In the following sections, Im using invoice templates, but you can customize other templates just as easily. Youll find the templates you can customize on the Templates list. Choose Lists | Templates. Double-click the template you want to customize and then follow along in the upcoming discussion. Or, you can open the window where you use the template, select the template from the Template dropdown list, and click the Customize button on the toolbar.
T I P : If you dont see the Customize button, make the window wider.
T I P : QuickBooks copies your logo file to an image folder located below the folder containing your data file.
354
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 15-19
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
355
To begin, select the template you want to customize and click the Customize button on the window toolbar. QuickBooks displays the Basic Customization dialog box that you saw in the preceding section. Click the Additional Customization button and QuickBooks displays a message indicating that you must make a copy of the template to customize it. When you click the Make A Copy button, QuickBooks creates a copy of the template, initially named Copy of whatever template you originally selected, and then displays the Additional Customization dialog box, which contains a plethora of options you can set. Well explore these options in the sections that follow.
T I P : After customizing the template, Ill walk you through changing the name of the template.
FIGURE 15-20
Change the information that appears in the header section of the form.
356
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
T I P : As you add fields, watch the Preview window. Notice that QuickBooks adds the field to the layout.
Notice that two columns of checkboxes appear for each field. These checkboxes control where the field appearsonscreen, when you print the form, or both. For example, in Figure 15-20, the Project/Job field will appear on the printed invoice for the customer, but not on the screen.
The following are some common changes you might want to make:
Add a field that is displayed onscreen to the printed copy of the form so that
the customer can see the field and its information. Add a field to the screen copy to display data not currently displayed on the screen, providing information to the person who is entering the data. Add a field to both the printed form and the screen display so that everyone can see the data. Remove fields from the printed copy of the form, the screen display, or both, if its appropriate to skip that data. Add custom fields you created (as discussed in Chapter 2) to the printed form, the onscreen display, or both.
T I P : The custom fields that are available are the custom fields you created for Name lists (Customer:Job, Vendor, Employee). Custom fields created for items are available in the Columns tab, covered in the next section.
N O T E : Some columns can only be removed from the printed version of the
form, not the onscreen display.
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
357
FIGURE 15-21
Change the line item columns or the order in which they appear.
QuickBooks provides two extra columns for your use, Other 1 and Other 2. Check the appropriate boxes to add these columns to the screen or print version of the form (or both). Then, enter the text for the title that should appear at the top of the column. For example, you may want to add a column for Quantity Shipped, where you can enter the number of items youre shipping with this order. The number of items ordered appears in the Quantity column, and in this case you could change the text for the Quantity column to Qty Ordered.
358
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
The Prog Cols tab appears when youre customizing invoice forms and you use the Estimates feature in QuickBooks. On the Prog Cols tab, you can set options for progress billing invoices (covered in Chapter 3). On the Print tab, youll find self-explanatory options that control printer settings for the form.
FIGURE 15-22
C H A PT ER
15
CREAT ING
REPORTS
AND
FORMS
THAT
WORK
FOR
YO U
359
Click any element to display a frame (a rectangle in diagonal hatch marks) with sizing handles (small black squares) around it. Then, do any of the following:
To change the size of the element, position your mouse pointer on one of the
pointer turns into a four-headed arrow, drag the frame to a different location on the form. Double-click an elements frame to see a Properties dialog box that permits all sorts of option changes for the selected element.
Ill 15-3
To change the margin measurements, click the Margins button at the bottom of
change the spacing between grid lines, or to turn off the Snap To Grid option, which automatically aligns objects to the nearest point on the grid. Use the toolbar buttons to align, resize, and zoom into the selected elements. Theres also an Undo/Redo choice. When you finish with the Layout Designer, click OK to redisplay the Basic Customization window. Once everything is just the way you want it, click OK. QuickBooks redisplays the Additional Customization dialog box. Click OK again, and QuickBooks displays the Basic Customization dialog box you saw earlier in Figure 15-19.
360
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
T I P : You can also use this new template as the basis for other customizations.
FIGURE 15-23
Chapter 16 Chapter 16
n this chapter:
Understanding online banking Setting up a connection to QuickBooks on the Web Setting up online bank accounts Performing online transactions Receiving online payments from your customers
361
362
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
If you have an Internet connection, you can use the wide range of online services offered by QuickBooks, including Internet-based banking, which is the subject of this chapter. Youll discover that QuickBooks and most banks have taken advantage of the Internet to make banking a snap. Using QuickBooks, you can sign up for the following online features:
Online banking, which enables you to view the status of your bank accounts,
see which transactions have cleared, download transactions, and generally maintain your accounts via your Internet connection. Online payments, which enables you to send money to vendors via the Internet instead of writing checks. If your vendor accepts electronic deposits, the bank deposits the money directly into your vendors bank account; otherwise, the bank generates and mails a check to the vendor. Online receipts, which enables you to accept payments from your customers electronically. Online services are also available for your credit card accounts, so you can view credit card transactions online and download them to enter them in your credit card account register. To take advantage of online credit card tracking, you must set up your credit cards as liability accounts in QuickBooks, which is discussed in Chapter 11.
Use this method when your bank doesnt provide a way to connect QuickBooks directly to the banks server. Instead, the bank maintains a page on its web site that lets you view and download your bank statement. You then import the downloaded file into QuickBooks, and the import process is quick and easy. Direct Connect Use this method when your bank exchanges data interactively with QuickBooks. This method allows you to download transactions, transfer money between bank accounts, e-mail messages to the bank, and pay bills online from within QuickBooks instead of working from your banks web site. Banks that offer both methods may charge fees for Direct Connect while Web Connect is usually free.
N O T E : You can make transfers between accounts within the same financial
institution, but you cannot transfer funds between accounts at different banks.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
363
Instructions for using the Web Connect and Direct Connection features appear later in this chapter in the section, Getting Bank Account Data Online.
Setting Up a Connection
Before you can use online services with QuickBooks, you have to tell QuickBooks about your Internet connection. After this simple step, QuickBooks does its online work on autopilot. Choose Help | Internet Connection Setup from the menu bar. This launches the Internet Connection Setup Wizard (see Figure 16-1).
N O T E : No matter which selection you choose, when you click Next, the last
wizard window appears (its a small, efficient wizard). Click Done when youve read the information in the second window.
Dial-up Connections
The option Use The Following Connection refers to a dial-up connection, using a modem. Any dial-up connections youve configured appear in the Internet Connection Setup window. If no connection appears and you know youve configured a dial-up connection, QuickBooks had a problem finding it or identifying it. Close the window but leave QuickBooks open. Connect to the Internet and, while still connected, choose Help | Internet Connection Setup again; QuickBooks should find your Internet connection. Highlight the connection, click Next, and click Done on the next window and youre ready to work online with QuickBooks.
FIGURE 16-1
364
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
C A U T I O N : If QuickBooks doesnt detect your connection and you had to connect to the Internet before configuring this wizard, youll probably have to connect manually every time you want to use Internet services in QuickBooks.
Network or Always-on Connections
If you connect to the Internet via a DSL/ cable modem or through another computer on your network using Internet connection sharing, select the option Use My Computers Internet Connection Settings.... Then, click Next to see an explanation of the connection QuickBooks found. Afterward, click Done. No Internet Connection If you dont have an Internet connection and you click the third option and then click Next, youll see a message that explains that you must sign up for Internet service before using the Internet Connection Setup Wizard. The window has an option to launch the Windows Internet Connection Wizard, which walks you through the process of setting up a new connection. After you sign up with an Internet Service Provider (ISP), return to this window and set up your QuickBooks online connection.
If your bank only supports online account access, and you want to pay bills over the Internet, you can sign up for QuickBooks Bill Pay, a fee-based service that lets you use QuickBooks to pay bills over the Internet. See the Using the QuickBooks Bill Pay Service section later in this chapter for details. If your bank doesnt support online credit card services, you can sign up for a QuickBooks credit card. See the Using a QuickBooks Credit Card section later in this chapter. You take three steps to enable online banking: Apply for online services with your bank. Receive a password or personal identification number (PIN) from your bank. Enable a QuickBooks account (or multiple accounts) for online services. To get started, choose Banking | Online Banking from the menu bar.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
365
FIGURE 16-2
Select the type of online service you want to use and then look for your bank in the list.
to travel to the Internet. Click OK, and when youre connected to the Internet, you will see the Financial Institutions Directory web site (see Figure 16-2). The four buttons in the upper left corner of the left pane determine the contents of the Financial Institution Directory list below the buttons. The window displays the results of selecting Any Services, and all the listed banks provide some type of online service. If youre interested in a particular online service, select that option, and the list of banks changes to display only those banks that offer the selected service. Scroll through the list to find your bank and click its listing. The right pane of the Financial Institutions Directory window displays information about the banks online services (see Figure 16-3) and a telephone number you can call for more information or to apply for online services. You may also see an Apply Now button if your bank supports online signup. Click the Apply Now button if you want to start the application process here and now. If no Apply Now button appears, follow the instructions for setting up online services at the bankusually the bank displays a phone number. If you can apply online, fill out the form and submit the information. Your bank will send you information about using its online service, along with a PIN. All banks provide
366
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 16-3
Check to see if your bank offers the services you want to use.
a method of changing the PIN to one of your own choosing. In fact, many banks insist that you change the PIN the first time you access online services.
C A U T I O N : You may see a warning that you are about to send information to an Internet zone in which it might be possible for other people to see the data you send. Select Yes to continue (you might want to choose the option not to be warned in the future). The information you send is encrypted with the same kind of technology used on secure web sites such as amazon.com, so if youre comfortable buying products online with a personal credit card, then you should be comfortable with online banking services.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
367
You can pay bills electronically from within QuickBooks if you sign up for the QuickBooks Bill Pay service. Choose Banking | Online Banking | Participating Financial Institutions. When the Financial Institutions list appears, scroll through the list to find QuickBooks Bill Pay Service in the left pane. Youll see two listings:
QuickBooks Bill PayNew!, which is the listing you should select. QuickBooks Bill PayTM, which is the listing for existing customers who use
older versions of QuickBooks; you cant sign up for this service anymore. When you select QuickBooks Bill PayNew!, the right pane displays information about this service (see Figure 16-4). To sign up, click Apply Now. After you answer a couple of questions about your business, click the Continue button. An application form appears on your screen. Follow the prompts and instructions to complete the enrollment process.
FIGURE 16-4
If your bank doesnt offer online bill paying, you can sign up for the QuickBooks Bill Pay service.
368
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
T I P : You can create online bank accounts in QuickBooks for as many accounts and different financial institutions as you need (and have signed up for).
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
369
FIGURE 16-5
When you set up a Web Connect account, QuickBooks displays your banks web site and generalized help about downloading transactions.
Click Continue. Your web site downloads recent transaction information into the selected bank account, and a message appears indicating that QuickBooks has successfully imported your Web Connect data. In the future, youll work inside QuickBooks when you want to download transaction information from your bank to QuickBooks, as described in the section, Exchanging Data with Web Connect.
370
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 16-6
top of the window. The window has two sections: Items To Send and Items Received From Financial Institution. Any items in the Items Received From Financial Institution section that do not have check marks beside them are items you havent yet reviewed.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
371
To import a downloaded QuickBooks transaction file, follow these steps: Choose File | Utilities | Import | Web Connect Files from the QuickBooks menu bar. The Open Online Data File dialog box appears. Select the file you downloaded (the file extension is .QBO) and click Open. A message appears indicating that QuickBooks has successfully imported your Web Connect data. Click OK and QuickBooks redisplays the Online Banking Center.
Exchange e-mail messages with your bank. Transfer funds between accounts at the bank. Receive a list of transactions that have cleared your account. Pay bills.
Some banks wont let you pay bills interactively through QuickBooks, although they may have a bill-paying service available outside of QuickBooks, which you can access on the banks web site. If thats the case, and you prefer to pay your bills online through QuickBooks, see the section earlier in this chapter on using the QuickBooks Bill Pay Service. Banks that support Direct Connection have a two-way message feature: you can both send and receive messages while working in QuickBooks. To send a message to your bank, choose Banking | Online Banking | Create Online Banking Message. Enter the message text in the Online Banking Message dialog box, and click OK. You send the message when you connect to your bank. For more, read on.
remove it. You can edit any item except a request to receive bank data. To edit an item, select it, click the Edit button, make the necessary changes, and click OK. You can remove any item except a request for bank data. Select the item you want to remove and click the Delete button.
372
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 16-7
You can download banking information or send other requests by clicking the Go Online button. A dialog box opens to accept your PIN or password or launch a web browser to connect to your banks web site. Youll see progress messages as QuickBooks contacts the banks server, sends any messages you created, and downloads any new transactions that cleared the bank since the last time you went online. If your bank account hasnt cleared any new transactions since your last online visit, youll see a message with that information. In the bottom half of the window, the Items Received From Financial Institution section displays all of the items QuickBooks downloaded from your bank during the online session. You use this information to match downloaded transactions to transactions in QuickBooks.
Matching Transactions
In the bottom half of the Online Banking Center, select an item and click View. QuickBooks opens the Match Transactions window, shown in Figure 16-8, where you can enter downloaded transactions into your QuickBooks account register. Like the Online Banking Center window, the Match Transactions window is divided into two parts. At the top of the window, you see your QuickBooks account register, which contains the transactions you entered into QuickBooks. In the bottom portion of the window, you see the transactions QuickBooks downloaded from your financial institution.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
373
FIGURE 16-8
Use the Match Transactions window to match downloaded transactions to transactions entered into QuickBooks.
QuickBooks automatically tries to match downloaded transactions to the transactions in your register and marks each downloaded transaction as either matched or unmatched. Youll see a message box summarizing the results of the download and automatic matching when you first open the Match Transactions window. If QuickBooks matches all of the downloaded transactions, you have nothing else to do. QuickBooks clears every matched transaction and displays a lightning bolt in the Cleared column of your register. If QuickBooks doesnt match some transactions that exist in your QuickBooks register, you can manually match transactions individually or in a batch. To match individually, click the unmatched transaction in the bottom portion of the window and the matching transaction in the upper portion of the window. Then, click the Match button. QuickBooks displays a lightning bolt in the Cleared column of the register. If you have many unmatched transactions, you can click Add Multiple to try to add multiple transactions to the register simultaneously. QuickBooks displays one of three possible windows. If there are unmatched transactions in the Downloaded Transactions pane, and QuickBooks recognizes all of the payees, the Add Multiple Transactions To The Register window appears (see Figure 16-9).
374
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 16-9
Use this window to add more than one transaction to the register.
If QuickBooks recognizes only some of the payees, a variation of the Add Multiple Transactions To The Register window appears, displaying the unrecognized payees at the bottom of the window. You cant take any action concerning the unrecognized payees in the Add Multiple Transactions To The Register window. QuickBooks simply provides the information for you. Read the section, Using Aliases to Match Transactions, for details on handling these unmatched transactions. If QuickBooks doesnt recognize the payees on any of your unmatched transactions, then QuickBooks cant add multiple transactions to the register simultaneously. Youll need to handle each unmatched transaction on an individual basis, either matching them manually as described in the preceding paragraph or using the techniques described in the next section, Unmatched Transactions.
Unmatched Transactions
To match transactions, click the View button in the Online Banking Center. QuickBooks automatically tries to match downloaded transactions to the transactions in your register and marks each downloaded transaction as either matched or unmatched. Youll see a message box summarizing the results of the download and automatic matching. If QuickBooks matches all of the downloaded transactions, QuickBooks clears every matched transaction and displays a lightning bolt in the Cleared column of your register.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
375
If QuickBooks doesnt match some transactions, you must correct the register. QuickBooks may not match a transaction for the following reasons:
The check numbers and amounts dont match. Transactions are missing from the register. A transaction is missing account information.
Missing Transactions
Sometimes, the transactions you download dont appear in your register. For example, bank charges download when theyre assessed. A check that has no matching transaction means you wrote and sent a check but didnt enter it into QuickBooks. You may also download an ATM withdrawal that you forgot to enter into QuickBooks. If QuickBooks downloads a deposit that doesnt match any transaction in the register, either a deposit still appears in the Undeposited Funds account or you didnt record the deposit. Add the bank charges, missing checks, or ATM withdrawals to the register by selecting the transaction in the Downloaded Transactions section and clicking the Add One To Register button. In the Add Unmatched Transaction dialog box, select the method you want to use to add the transaction. The choices differ depending on whether youre working with a bank account or a credit card account.
376
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Follow the prompts and enter the information. You dont have to enter a payee for a bank charge, you just have to enter the account to which you post bank charges.
Ill 16-1
N O T E : If you print checks, or you know you entered every manual check you
wrote in your QuickBooks register, you may have a more serious problem someone may have stolen a check. Call your bank immediately.
For missing deposits, use the Make Deposits window to move money from the Undeposited Funds account to your bank account (see Chapter 4 for details) or enter a Sales Receipt or a Receive Payments transaction to account for the missing deposit. As soon as you finish adding a missing transaction, QuickBooks automatically matches the missing transaction to the downloaded transaction in the register.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
377
This commonly occurs for transactions created using your banks online bill-paying service on the banks web site and for credit card transactions. To resolve theses issues, you can create an alias for each online payee whose name doesnt match the name of a vendor in your QuickBooks company file. Follow these steps: In the Match Transactions window, select an unmatched transaction and click Add One To Register. Select the way to add the transaction (Add To Register, Write Checks, or Pay Bills). Because the Payee in the downloaded transaction doesnt match a name that exists in QuickBooks, the Name Not Found message box appears. Choose Create Alias to open the Create Alias dialog box. Select an existing name from the drop-down list. Click OK and confirm the addition of this alias. The next time you download transactions with this payee name, QuickBooks recognizes the alias and matches the transaction if the transaction also appears in the register. If necessary, you can add multiple aliases to the same name.
T I P : You can later view and delete aliases by going to the Edit window for that payee, selecting the Additional Info tab, and clicking the Manage Aliases button.
378
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
enter the amount you want to transfer. Check the Online Funds Transfer box and click Save & Close.
Ill 16-2
Afterward, choose Banking | Online Banking Center, make sure the transaction has a check mark, and click Go Online.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
379
FYI
If the vendor is set up to receive electronic payments, the bank transfers the money from your bank account to the vendors bank account. If the vendors account is not accessible for online payments, your bank writes a check and mails it, along with all the necessary payment information.
You can use the Write Checks window, the Pay Bills window, or the bank account register to create the transaction in QuickBooks. In each case, you need to indicate that youre paying electronically. In the Write Checks window, check the Online Payment box. In the Pay Bills window, select the Online Bank Pmt option from the Payment Method list box. In the register, type Send as the check number.
380
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
C A U T I O N : If you add a memo, your text can be delivered only as a voucher or stub. This means that your bank wont make the payment electronically even if the vendor is able to accept electronic payments. Instead, the bank will send a paper check, which delays the payment.
Choose Banking | Online Banking | Online Banking Center, open the Online Banking Center window, and then click Go Online. QuickBooks sends your electronic payments to the big bill-paying machine on the Net.
C HAPT ER
16
USING
ONLINE
BANKING
SER VICE S
381
You can notify the customer about this online service by e-mailing the invoice with the online service URL in the cover note, or by snail-mailing the invoice and sending an e-mail message with the online service URL. The customer clicks the URL link to visit the QuickBooks web site and then arranges to pay your invoice. QuickBooks notifies you that the customer has paid the invoice, and you can download the payment information into your bank register, using the standard online banking procedures. To learn more about this service or to sign up, visit the web site www.quickbooksmerchantservice.com/services/billing_solutions/features.php.
Chapter 17 Chapter 17
Year-End Procedures
n this chapter:
Running reports on your financial condition Printing 1099 forms Making year-end journal entries Getting ready for tax time Closing the books
383
384
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
The end of the year is a madhouse for bookkeepers, and thats true for major corporations as well as for small businesses. There is so much to do; so many reports to examine, corrections to make, entries to create, adjustments to applywhew! You can relax a bit. You dont have to show up at the office on January 1. You dont have to have everything done on the first day of your new fiscal year either. QuickBooks is date-sensitive so you can continue to work on finishing up the old year while you work in the new one. As long as you date new transactions after the last day of your fiscal year, QuickBooks will correctly assign the transactions to the new year.
to close.
Review fringe benefits and complete payroll tax forms. Verify and print 1099 forms for eligible vendors. Review the records for assets you purchased during the year to make sure that
end accruals.
Perform a physical inventory, if appropriate, and reconcile the results with your
QuickBooks inventory. Review tax reports to verify tax tracking. Export tax data and prepare for the new year. Set a closing date in QuickBooks. Back up your data.
In this chapter, youll read about most of these tasks. Some tasks, such as reconciling bank and other accounts, preparing payroll tax forms, and performing a physical inventory, appear in appropriate chapters throughout the book. In addition to the information found in this chapter, the web site www.quickbooks .com/yearend/ contains a wealth of information about year-end tasks, so be sure to check it out.
CHAPTER
17
YEAR-END
PROCEDURES
385
you organize information for paying taxes. To run financial reports, click the Reports menu. For year-end reports, youll need several types of reports (see Chapter 15 for information about modifying and customizing the standard reports). Dont forget that reports have date ranges like current year and last fiscal year. If you perform these tasks before the end of your fiscal year, youre still in the current year. However, if youre working after the last date of your fiscal year, you want to make sure that you report on the last fiscal year.
386
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 17-1
The 1099 and 1096 Wizard makes it easy to issue 1099 forms to vendors.
CHAPTER
17
YEAR-END
PROCEDURES
387
FIGURE 17-2
Use this report to confirm that you have Tax ID and address information for all vendors who will receive 1099 forms.
completed the Tax ID and address for each 1099-eligible vendor; youll need this information to produce the form. If any 1099-eligible vendors dont appear on the report, edit the vendor in the Vendor List and, on the Additional Info tab, be certain you make the vendor 1099-eligible and supply the vendors Tax ID.
When you close the report, the 1099 and 1096 Wizard window reappears.
388
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 17-3
issuing Form 1099s to vendors. You can assign multiple accounts to a 1099 category, but you cannot assign the same account to more than one 1099 category. For example, if you have one expense account labeled subcontractors and another labeled outside consultants, you can assign both of the accounts to the same 1099 category (Nonemployee Compensation). However, once you assign those accounts to that category, you cannot assign those same accounts to any other 1099 category. To assign a single account to a category, click the text in the account column to select it. Then, click the arrow to select the account for this category. To assign multiple accounts to a category, instead of selecting an account after you click the arrow, choose the Multiple Accounts option at the top of the list. In the Select Account dialog box, click each account to check it. Click OK to assign all the accounts you checked. Then click OK to close the Preferences dialog box. The 1099 and 1096 Wizard window reappears.
CHAPTER
17
YEAR-END
PROCEDURES
389
QuickBooks displays the 1099 Summary report, which lists each vendor eligible for a 1099 with the total amount paid to the vendor.
Ill 17-1
If an entry on this report looks suspicious, double-click the suspect amount. QuickBooks will display the 1099 Detail report for the vendor of the transaction you double-clicked, showing you a list of the transactions that make up the total reported for the vendor. You can print this report for all 1099-eligible vendors by choosing Reports | Vendors & Payables | 1099 Detail.
FYI
390
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
When all the 1099 information is correct, close the reports to redisplay the 1099 and 1096 Wizard.
Click OK to display the Select 1099s To Print window. QuickBooks displays the vendors for whom it will print 1099s.
Ill 17-3
Click Preview 1099 to see what the form will look like when it prints. You can click Zoom In to make sure your company name, address, and EIN number are correct, and also check the vendors information. Click Close on the Print Preview window to return to the Select 1099s window. Then load the 1099 forms into your printer and click Print 1099. If youre using a laser or inkjet printer, set the number of copies to three: one for the vendor, one for your files, and one to submit to the government. After the forms print, click Print 1096 in the Select 1099s To Print window. Enter the name of the contact person in your company who can answer questions about these forms; QuickBooks prints the name on the 1096 Form. Print two copies of the 1096 so you have one for your files.
CHAPTER
17
YEAR-END
PROCEDURES
391
Ill 17-4
Send each vendor a copy of his or her 1099 by January 31. Send the government a copy of each 1099, along with a 1096 Transmittal Form.
reversed on the first day of the next fiscal year. For example, you may need to accrue wages and salaries for amounts earned in one year but paid in the next year. You can use a reversing journal entry to handle this situation. When QuickBooks reverses the journal entry on the first day of the new year, the net expense for each year will be just what was earned in that year. Adjustment of prepaid expenses from asset accounts to expense accounts.
You can send the Profit & Loss report and the Balance Sheet report to your accountant by e-mailing the reports as PDF files: click the E-Mail button at the top of the report window and then click Send Report As PDF Ask your accountant for . journal entry instructions. You can also send your accountant an Accountants Copy of your company data and let your accountant make the journal entries. You import the changes when your accountant returns the file to you. See Chapter 24 to learn how to use the Accountants Copy feature.
392
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
CHAPTER
17
YEAR-END
PROCEDURES
393
FIGURE 17-4
Use this report to identify accounts you have not assigned to a tax form.
Your selections vary depending upon whether your company is organized as a proprietorship, partnership, S corp, C corp, and so on.
N O T E : Be sure the Income Tax Form Used field is filled out properly in the
Company Information dialog box on the Company menu. If its blank, you wont see the tax information fields on any accounts.
If you dont know which form and category to assign to an account, heres an easy trick for getting that information: Choose File | New Company to open the EasyStep Interview Wizard. Click Skip Interview. On the Enter Your Company Information screen, enter a name in the Company Name field. It doesnt matter what name you use since youre not creating a company file that youll use to store transaction information. Click Next. On the How Is Your Company Organized? screen, select the option for the correct organizational type and click Next.
394
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
Select the month in which your fiscal year starts and click Next. On the Select Your Industry screen, select the type of company that best describes your business. If nothing comes close to matching your business, select General Product-Based Business or General Service-Based Business. Click Next and then click Finish. QuickBooks displays the Filename For New Company dialog box. Click Save to save the new company file. When the new company opens in QuickBooks, open the chart of accounts list and press CTRL+P to print the list, which has the tax form information you need. Reopen your real company, open the chart of accounts, and use the information on the printed document to enter tax form information.
Using TurboTax
If you purchase TurboTax to do your taxes, you dont have to do anything special in QuickBooks to transfer the information other than make sure you assign tax-related accounts to tax forms. Open TurboTax and tell it to import your QuickBooks company file. Almost everything you need transfers to TurboTax. However, youll have to enter some details directly into TurboTax, such as home-office expenses for a Schedule C Form. You can learn more about TurboTax at www.turbotax.com.
CHAPTER
17
YEAR-END
PROCEDURES
395
You close the books to lock them so that no user can add, remove, or change any transactions. After you have filed taxes based on the information in the system, you should never change anything.
396
PART TWO
BO O KKEEPIN G
FIGURE 17-5
Entering a closing date is the first step toward preventing changes to the previous years transactions.
years opening balances are not equal to last years closing balances, you can use this report to identify the cause of mismatched opening and closing balances. You can print the Closing Date Exception Report, shown in Figure 17-6, to view a list of all transactions that were added or changed after the closing date established for the company. A transaction that was changed shows the date and amount of the modification, as well as the date and amount of the original transaction. If you set up users for your QuickBooks company file, the report shows the name of the user who changed the transaction. To view the Closing Date Exception Report, choose Reports | Accountant & Taxes | Closing Date Exception Report. Any transactions that changed after the closing date appear in the report.
CHAPTER
17
YEAR-END
PROCEDURES
397
FIGURE 17-6
Use this report to identify transactions that were changed after the closing date.
Part Three
any businesses incur costs that they pass along to their customers as part of doing business. Their agreements with their customers include the understanding that the customer will pay these reimbursable costs. Tracking mileage is a universal need for any business in which vehicles are used to deliver services or products. Vehicle expense deductions on your tax return need to be able to pass an audit, and many companies insist that every employee keep a travel log. In addition, many service businesses bill clients for mileage when employees work at the client site or travel on the clients behalf. Most service businesses charge for their services by charging for the time they spend performing a service. Product-based businesses also might need to track time for employees or outside consultants. Part Three of this book covers all the steps you need to take to set your system up to track and recover reimbursable costs, mileage, and time with maximum efficiency and accuracy.
Chapter 18 Chapter 18
n this chapter:
Ways to manage reimbursable expenses Recording reimbursable costs Invoicing customers for reimbursable costs
399
400
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
A reimbursable expense is one that you incurred on behalf of a customer. Even though you pay the vendors bill, theres an agreement with your customer that youll send an invoice to recover your costs.
as long-distance telephone charges, parking and tolls, and other incidental expenses. When you enter the vendor bill, you record separately those portions of the bill that apply to customer agreements for reimbursement. Specific items or services that you purchase for a customer that you would not have purchased otherwise.
expense account that you use to record your portion of the expense. Let QuickBooks automatically post the reimbursable expense to an income account that you create for reimbursable expenses. This approach lets you track totals for both the original expense and the reimbursement. You may want to discuss these choices with your accountant. Many businesses prefer the second optiontracking reimbursable expenses separatelybecause its more accurate when youre analyzing your expenses and income. Ill therefore go over the steps you should take to set up to track reimbursable expenses. You can ignore the instructions if you prefer to post reimbursable expenses to the same expense account you use when you enter the vendors bill.
C H APT ER
18
MANAGING
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSE S
401
So, you tell QuickBooks that you want to track reimbursable expenses in the Preferences dialog box. Use the following steps: Choose Edit | Preferences to open the Preferences dialog box. Select the Time & Expenses icon in the left pane. Click the Company Preferences tab. Check the Track Reimbursed Expenses As Income box. Click OK.
When you enable this option, QuickBooks adds a new field to the window you use when you create or edit an expense account so that you can set up an expense account to assign reimbursable expenses to an income account of your choice. Whenever you post a vendor expense to this account and also indicate that the expense is reimbursable, QuickBooks automatically posts the reimbursable expense to the income account linked to this expense account when you invoice the customer. To assign an income account for reimbursable expenses to an expense account, press CTRL+A to open the Chart Of Accounts window, highlight the expense account, and press CTRL+E. In the Edit Account window that appears, check the Track Reimbursed Expenses In box and then use the Income Account drop-down list to select the income account you want to use for reimbursable expenses. You may have numerous expense accounts that you want to use for reimbursable expensesin fact, thats the common scenario. Portions of telephone bills, travel expenses, subcontractor expenses, and so on are frequently passed on to customers for reimbursement. QuickBooks expects a one-to-one relationship between a reimbursable expense and the reimbursement income from that expense. So if you have more than one expense account for which you may receive reimbursement, you must create an income account for accepting reimbursed expenses for each of these expense accounts. To easily view totals for income received from reimbursed expenses, set up the income accounts as subaccounts. You can name the parent account Reimbursements or Reimbursed Expenses. That way, your reports will show the total amount of income due to reimbursed expenses, and you can ignore the individual account totals unless you have some reason to audit a number.
402
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
Depending on the company type you selected during the EasyStep Interview, QuickBooks may have already created a Reimbursed Expenses account in the Income section of your chart of accounts. If so, you can use that account as the parent account. The following steps show you how to create both the parent account and the subaccounts. Use these steps to set up a parent account and subaccounts for tracking reimbursed income: Open the chart of accounts by pressing CTRL+A. Press CTRL+N to open a New Account window. Select Income as the account type. Enter an account number (if you use numbers) and name the account Reimbursements (or something similar). Click Save & New. Youve created the parent accountnow create the subaccounts using these steps: If youre using numbered accounts, assign a number to the subaccount that leaves ten numbers between the subaccount number and the number you used for the parent account. Also enter a name for the account, such as Telephone Reimbursements. Select the Subaccount Of checkbox and link it to the parent account you created. Click Save & New to create the next account. Repeat this process as many times as necessary, clicking OK in step 5 when you finish. For example, my chart of accounts has the following accounts for this purpose:
4200 Reimbursements 4210 Equip Rental Reimbursements 4220 Telephone Reimbursements 4230 Travel Reimbursements 4240 Subcontractor Reimbursements
My reports show information for the subaccounts as well as a total of all transactions for the parent account. Dont forget to edit your existing expense accounts to link the income accounts you just created to the appropriate expense account. Check the box to track reimbursed expenses and select the appropriate income account.
C H APT ER
18
MANAGING
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSE S
403
404
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 18-1
you create an invoice for a customer for whom reimbursable expenses exist, or
You can produce invoices for reimbursable expenses using a list of customers
C H APT ER
18
MANAGING
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSE S
405
Ill 18-1
N O T E : If the customer has open Sales Orders, QuickBooks will alert you of
them before checking for billable time/costs.
If you select the second option, QuickBooks doesnt place any of the outstanding time and cost entries on the invoice, but you can click the Add Time/Costs button on the invoice to add them later. If you select the first option, QuickBooks displays the Choose Billable Time And Costs window (see Figure 18-2).
T I P : You can set your preferences (choose Edit | Preferences and click the Sales & Customers icon and then the My Preferences tab) so that QuickBooks automatically opens the Choose Billable Time And Costs window when you select a customer with outstanding reimbursable expenses.
FIGURE 18-2
Use this window to decide how you want QuickBooks to handle outstanding reimbursable expenses.
406
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
Use the following steps to include reimbursable expenses on a customer invoice: Click the Expenses tab to display the reimbursable amounts you posted for this customer when you entered vendor bills. Click in the leftmost column to place a check mark next to the expense(s) you want to include on the invoice youre currently creating. Some notes about including reimbursable expenses: You dont have to include all available reimbursable expenses. The ones you dont select will be available the next time you invoice this customer. You can change the amount of a reimbursable expense in the Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box or in the Amount column of the Create Invoices window. If you reduce the amount, QuickBooks does not keep the remaining amount on the Billable Time And Costs window. Instead, QuickBooks assumes that youre not planning to pass the remaining amount to your customer in the future. Ill talk about marking up expenses later in this chapter in the section, Marking Up Reimbursable Expenses. To charge sales tax for a reimbursable expense (assuming the customer is not tax-exempt), check the Selected Expenses Are Taxable box, which will only appear if you enabled sales tax tracking in the Preferences dialog box. If you need to charge sales tax on some but not all reimbursable expenses, add them to the invoice in two groups. Click the Add Time/Costs button in the Create Invoices window and add the nontaxable items to the invoice. Then, click the Add Time/Costs button in the Create Invoices window again to reopen the Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box and add the taxable items, making sure that you also check the Selected Expenses Are Taxable box. If you prefer, you can add both taxable and nontaxable expenses at the same time and then change the tax status in the Tax column on the invoice. If you include more than one reimbursable expense on an invoice, QuickBooks places an item called Reimb Group on the invoice, lists the individual items in the group, and enters the total for the reimbursable items (see Figure 18-3).
N O T E : If you want to print only the total for the group of reimbursable
expenses, you can check the Print Selected Time And Costs As One Invoice Item. Onscreen, the invoice looks like the one in Figure 18-3, but when you print the invoice, QuickBooks prints only the total for the group.
Click OK. QuickBooks adds the selected reimbursable expense(s) to the invoice. Fill in the data in the invoice header. You can include other lines on the invoice in addition to reimbursable costs, as I did in Figure 18-3. Click Save & Close.
C H APT ER
18
MANAGING
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSE S
407
FIGURE 18-3
Notice that QuickBooks uses the text you entered in the Memo column when you entered the vendors bill for the description of the reimbursable item. If you dont enter information into the Memo column when you enter the bill, youll have to enter text manually in the Description column of the invoiceand that could turn out to be a real test of your memory. If you dont enter anything, the customer sees only an amount and no explanation for it.
408
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
To remove an expense from the Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box, place a check mark in the Hide column beside the item. This action has the same effect as clicking the Billable? column in the Enter Bills windowQuickBooks continues to track the expense and assign it to a Customer:Job, but QuickBooks no longer considers the expense reimbursable.
FIGURE 18-4
Applying a markup changes the Total Expenses With Markup and Total Billable Time And Costs fields.
C H APT ER
18
MANAGING
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSE S
409
FIGURE 18-5
Although it would be unusual for you to be marking up items without having discussed this with your customer, if you dont want your customer to see the markup amounts, check the Print Selected Time And Costs As One Invoice Item box in the Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box. Youll see the breakdown on the screen version of the invoice, but the printed invoice will contain only the grand total. There is a difference between using the markup function and just increasing the amount of the reimbursable expense in the Amount column. If you use the markup function, the difference between the actual expense and the charge to your customer is posted to the markup account. If you change the amount of the expense, the entire increased amount is posted to the income account you linked to the reimbursable expense account. Essentially, you dont track markup income.
410
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 18-6
Use the Invoice For Time & Expenses window to select a set of reimbursable expenses to include on an invoice.
reimbursable expenses based on a date range. In Figure 18-6, Ive set no beginning date so that I dont accidentally exclude any unbilled reimbursable expenses. To view the Invoice For Time & Expenses window, you need to set a preference. To do so, choose Edit | Preferences and then click the Time & Expenses icon (see Figure 18-7). On the Company Preferences tab, place a check beside the Create Invoices From A List Of Time And Expenses option in the Invoicing Options section and then click OK. To open the Invoice for Time & Expenses window, choose Customers | Invoice For Time & Expenses or work from the QuickBooks Home page. Click the down arrow beside the Invoices icon and choose Invoice For Time & Expenses. In addition to setting a date range at the top of the window, you can customize the window to display only certain types of reimbursable expenses. Right-click any column heading to display a shortcut menu that lists the titles of the four types of reimbursable expenses: Time, Expenses, Mileage, and Items. A check mark appears beside each title. Simply click a title to hide it from view. In Figure 18-8, Ive set up the window to display only those customer:jobs that have outstanding reimbursable expensesno reimbursable time, mileage, or items charges appear.
C H APT ER
18
MANAGING
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSE S
411
FIGURE 18-7
Set preferences so that you can view a list of available reimbursable expenses.
FIGURE 18-8
To focus on only certain types of reimbursable expenses, hide the other types.
412
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
To create an invoice, click the line of the customer:job. Then, click the Create Invoice button. QuickBooks creates an invoice that contains the selected reimbursable expenses. On the invoice, QuickBooks includes all expenses of the type you made visible in the Invoice For Time & Expenses window, and QuickBooks uses the settings you previously established in the Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box to display and print the reimbursable expenses on the invoice. For details on these settings, see the Including Reimbursable Expenses When Prompted section earlier in this chapter. You can add other charges to the invoice if you want, the same way you would add lines to any invoice (see Chapter 3 for details). You can reduce or increase the amount of any reimbursable charge on the invoice, and, you can click the Add Time/Costs button and add other types of reimbursable charges to the invoice. However, you cannot use the Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box to change any reimbursable expense you included on the invoice via the Invoice For Time & Expenses window. To mark up reimbursable expenses on an invoice you create using the Invoice For Time & Expenses window, you can use one of two methods:
You can type a standard markup for all reimbursable expenses in the Default
Markup Percentage in the Preferences dialog box (shown earlier in Figure 18-7). You can check the Let Me Select Specific Billables For This Customer:Job box in the Invoice For Time & Expenses window. If you use the first method, QuickBooks automatically includes a markup on every invoice you create when you click the Create Invoice button. If you use the second method, QuickBooks automatically displays the Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box (shown earlier in Figure 18-4), where you select reimbursable expenses to include on the bill and set the markup value as described earlier in the section, Marking Up Reimbursable Expenses. When you click Save & Close in the Create Invoices window, the Invoice For Time & Expenses window refreshes. As a result, the row you added to an invoice will either disappear or have its dollar amount reduced. You can then repeat the process and create other invoices.
Chapter 19 Chapter 19
n this chapter:
Establishing mileage rates Creating a mileage item Recording mileage Reporting on mileage Reimbursing for mileage
413
414
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
Using QuickBooks, you can track the mileage of your vehicles. You can use the mileage information to track the expenses connected to vehicle use, to use mileage as part of your job-costing efforts, to reimburse employees or subcontractors for mileage expenses, or to bill customers for mileage expenses.
T I P : Your accountant may be able to use the vehicle mileage data on your income tax return.
Setting Up a Vehicle
To track a vehicle and its mileage, you must add that vehicle to the Vehicle List. You can use the mileage information for tax deductions for your vehicles and to bill customers for mileage expenses. However, even if you dont bill customers for mileage or your accountant uses a formula for tax deductions, the Vehicle list is a handy way to track information about the vehicles (yours or your employees) used for business purposes. To add a vehicle to the list, choose Lists | Customer & Vendor Profile Lists | Vehicle List. While viewing the Vehicle List window, press CTRL+N to open a New Vehicle dialog box. The box has two fields:
Vehicle, in which you enter a name or code for a specific vehicle. For example,
you could enter Blue Truck, Mikes Toyota, Ford Mustang Convertible, or any other recognizable name. Description, in which you enter descriptive information about the vehicle. While the Description field is handy for standard description terms (such as black, or blue/white truck), take advantage of the field by entering information you really need. For example, enter the VIN, the license plate number, the expiration date for the plate, the insurance policy number, or other official information. You can enter up to 256 characters in the field. You can learn how to track mileage and bill customers for mileage in Chapter 6. Once you have set up a vehicle, you can begin tracking its mileage. If more than one person uses the vehicle, you may want to create a form that contains the following information to track mileage on the vehicle effectively:
Trip Start Date Trip End Date Starting Odometer Ending Odometer Customer:Job or Purpose of the Trip
CHAPTER
19
HANDLING
MILEAGE
EXPENSE S
415
In the Effective Date column, select a date from the calendar. In the Rate column, enter the IRS rate for that date. Click Close. Notice that you can continue to add dates and rates and QuickBooks will use the appropriate rate, based on the date of your mileage entry, to calculate costs.
416
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
it when the IRS rate changes. You can use the same rate you used in the Mileage Rates window or enter a different rate to create a markup (or a markdown, if you wish to take that approach).
Entering Mileage
Use the following steps to enter mileage: Choose Company | Enter Vehicle Mileage. QuickBooks displays the Enter Vehicle Mileage window (see Figure 19-1). Select the vehicle from the drop-down list in the Vehicle field. Enter the dates of the trip. Enter the odometer readingsQuickBooks calculates the total miles.
N O T E : If you didnt track the odometer readings, you can enter the total
mileage.
If you want to bill the customer for mileage, place a check mark in the Billable checkbox and select the Customer:Job, the item you created for mileage, and the Class (if youre tracking classes). If you dont want to bill a customer but still want to track job costs, do not place a check mark in the Billable checkbox. However, do go ahead and assign a Customer:Job, the Mileage Item, and, if appropriate, a Class. Optionally, enter a note. Click Save & New to enter another trip, or click Save & Close if youre finished entering mileage.
FIGURE 19-1
CHAPTER
19
HANDLING
MILEAGE
EXPENSE S
417
FIGURE 19-2
418
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 19-3
No customer information appears in the report, but you can add the Customer and Billing Status fields to the report from the Display tab of the Modify Report dialog box, or you can double-click any listing to open the original mileage slip. Either method shows you whether the trip is linked to a job and whether its marked billable.
CHAPTER
19
HANDLING
MILEAGE
EXPENSE S
419
FIGURE 19-4
Trip End Date Billing Status Item Total Miles Sales Price Amount
You can modify the report to display additional information by clicking the Modify Report button on the report window. See Chapter 15 for details on modifying reports. For example, you may want to add columns for the Mileage Rate, the Mileage Expense,
420
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 19-5
or both. You may even want to add the start date for the trip. If you modify the report and like the results, memorize the report so you dont have to repeat the modifications next time.
CHAPTER
19
HANDLING
MILEAGE
EXPENSE S
421
If youre doing your own payroll, QuickBooks cannot transfer mileage reimbursements directly to paychecks the way QuickBooks transfers time, but you can modify the Mileage By Vehicle Detail report so that you can reimburse each individual and simultaneously provide them with a copy of the report. Use the following steps to create a copy of the Mileage By Vehicle Detail report for each individual: Open the Mileage By Vehicle Detail report. Enter the date range for which youre reimbursing individuals. Click the Modify Report button. QuickBooks displays the Modify Report dialog box. On the Filters tab, open the Vehicle drop-down list and select the first vehicle (see Figure 19-6). Click OK to return to the report window, which now displays information about that persons mileage only. Memorize the report, naming it Person Mileage (substitute the real name for Person). Repeat the process for each remaining person. Print each persons report and attach it to the reimbursement check.
FIGURE 19-6
422
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
T I P : You might want to create a Memorized Report Group and put all the reports in this group. That way you can run all the reports at the same time.
Chapter 20 Chapter 20
n this chapter:
Setting up time tracking Filling out timesheets Editing timesheets Billing for time
423
424
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
QuickBooks includes a time-tracking feature that lets you record the amount of time you and your staff spend completing a project, working for a customer, or working for your company (administrative tasks). You can use that information to invoice customers for time, to pay employees, or to track job costing. In addition to tracking billable time, you can also use this information to analyze your business. For example, if you charge retainer fees for your services, time tracking is a terrific way to figure out which customers may need to have the retainer amount raised.
By default, QuickBooks assumes your workweek starts on Monday. However, if your business is open every day of the week, you might want to use a Sunday-toSaturday pattern for tracking time.
CHAPTER
20
USING
TIME
TRACKIN G
425
Setting Up Workers
You need to set up each person for whom you will track time in QuickBooks:
Employees Outside contractors Other workers
N O T E : If your company does not use the Payroll feature in QuickBooks but
does wish to track employee time for the purposes of billing customers, you can set up your employees on the Other Names list.
To change the employees record, follow these steps: Open the Employee Center by clicking the Employees icon on the left side of the Home page, or by clicking the Employee Center icon on the toolbar. Select the Employees tab to display the Employee list. Double-click an employee. In the Change Tabs drop-down list, choose Payroll And Compensation Info. Check the Use Time Data To Create Paychecks box (see Figure 20-1). Click OK to close the employee record and redisplay the Employee list. If you do follow the preceding steps, QuickBooks may display a message while the employee is filling out timesheets, saying that the activity the employee is reporting is not linked to an hourly rate. QuickBooks will report the rate at $0.00/ hour, which is fine, especially for employees on salary.
426
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 20-1
To pay an employee based on hours reported, check the Use Time Data To Create Paychecks box.
because you take a draw instead of a paycheck. In this case, you must add your name to the Other Names list to track your own time. You have no employees and your business is a proprietorship or a partnership. Owner or partner names must be entered into the Other Names list in order to track time.
CHAPTER
20
USING
TIME
TRACKIN G
427
Using Timesheets
You can record time using either the Time/Enter Single Activity window or the Weekly Timesheet window. In the Time/Enter Single Activity window, you record one entry at a time, entering what you did, when you did it, and how long you spent doing it. The Single Activity window also contains a stop watch that you can use to time work as you do it. Use the Weekly Timesheet to record many single activities at the same time. You record the same information, but you have the opportunity to record more than one activity in the window. Because of the nature of the window, you wont find a timer in this window. The window you choose to use is a matter of personal preference. Some people track time more accurately if they use the Single Activity window and the timer. Other people find the Weekly Timesheet window more efficient to use because they are recording time they already tracked.
428
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
T I P : When you fill out a Single Activity window, QuickBooks automatically displays that activity in the Weekly Timesheet window in the week corresponding to the entrys date.
N O T E : Everyone tracking time may not have access to QuickBooks, but you
can use the Timer program to handle this situation. The Timer is an independent program that you can legally distribute to anyone whose time you need to track. You send a file containing your companys list entries to each Timer user, and the Timer user periodically sends you a file of time entries. The Timer program ships on your product CD. You can read more about using it in Chapter 22.
Follow these steps to fill in the window: QuickBooks automatically fills in the Date field, but you can change the date if necessary. Click the arrow to the right of the Name field and select the name of the person who performed the work from the list that appears. The list contains vendors, employees, and names from the Other Names list.
FIGURE 20-2
Fill out the details to describe how you spent your time.
CHAPTER
20
USING
TIME
TRACKIN G
429
FYI
In the Customer:Job field, select the customer for whom the work was performed. You dont need to select a customer:job if you dont intend to invoice for the work. In the Service Item field, select a task, and in the Duration box, enter the amount of time youre reporting, using the default format hh:mm or the stopwatch to time your work (see the Using the Stopwatch section later for details).
T I P : If youve changed the time format preference to decimal, QuickBooks automatically converts minutes to fractions of an hour.
QuickBooks checks the Billable checkbox by default. If youre not going to invoice for the time, click the box to remove the check mark. If the Payroll Item field appears, select the appropriate wage payroll item. The Payroll Item field appears only if you selected an employee in the Name field that you set up to be paid for hours recorded using time tracking, as explained earlier in this chapter. Use the Notes box to enter any comments or additional information you want to record about this activity. Be aware that the information you enter here may appear on customer invoices.
C A U T I O N : Dont enter anything in the Notes box that you wouldnt want anyone to see. You never know when somebody will accidentally include the contents of the Notes box.
When youve finished creating the activity, click Save & New to fill out another Single Activity form, or click Save & Close to finish.
N O T E : When you select an employee, the Workers Comp field appears if you
(a) use QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions or any version of QuickBooks Premier and subscribe to Enhanced Payroll or Assisted Payroll services and (b) have enabled Workers Comp tracking.
430
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FYI
You can set the format for reporting time, both on the activity sheet and in the stopwatch window. Some companies prefer the hh:mm format; others prefer a decimal format (such as 1.5 hours). To establish a default based on your preference, choose Edit | Preferences and click the General category. Then select the Company Preferences tab and use the options in the Time Format section of the dialog box to select the format you want to use. By default, QuickBooks chooses Minutes.
Ill 20-2
CHAPTER
20
USING
TIME
TRACKIN G
431
FIGURE 20-3
Use the following steps to fill out the timesheet: In the Name field, select the name of the person for whom you are recording time from the list that appears when you click the arrow beside the Name field. Click the Calendar icon beside the currently displayed date to select a week in which to enter time. Click the Customer:Job column to open the Customer List and select the customer connected to the activity you want to record. If you dont intend to bill for the time you are recording, you dont need to select a customer. Enter the service item that describes the activity. If you are recording time for an employee whose paycheck is linked to his or her timesheets, select the Payroll Item that fits the activity. The Payroll Item field doesnt appear if, in the Name field, you selected an employee who is not paid from the timesheets or a name from the Other Names list or the Vendor list.
In the Notes column, enter any comments you feel are necessary. Be aware that the information you enter here may appear on customer invoices.
432
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
C A U T I O N : Dont enter anything in the Notes box that you wouldnt want anyone to see. You never know when somebody will accidentally include the contents of the Notes box.
In the column that represents the day for which you are entering this activity, enter the number of hours the person worked on this task. Repeat this step for each day that he or she performed this activity. In the Billable column, indicate whether the time is billable. QuickBooks marks all time entries billable by default if the person selected in the Name field is an employee or appears on the Other Names list. If you dont select a customer in Step 3, remove the check from the Billable column. Repeat Steps 3 to 8 for each activity that the person performed this week. Click Save & Close.
T I P : If timesheet information is similar from week to week, you can copy the previous weeks timesheet by clicking the Copy Last Sheet button after you enter the current date in the timesheet window and select a name.
T I P : To learn how to use timesheet information to bill customers, see Chapter 18.
CHAPTER
20
USING
TIME
TRACKIN G
433
FIGURE 20-4
Create a report to check everything before billing customers or entering payroll information.
If youve made it a practice to encourage people to enter comments in the Notes section of the timesheet, you should customize the Time By Job Detail report format so it includes those comments. While viewing the report, click the Modify Report button. On the Display tab of the Modify Report dialog box, select Notes from the Columns list and then click OK. You can have QuickBooks memorize this report so that you dont need to set it up each time you want to view notes. Click the Memorize button on the report button bar to open the Memorize Report dialog box, and enter a name for the report. You can then view and print the report using the Memorized Reports list.
434
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
C A U T I O N : If youve already used the timesheet data to create an invoice for the customer or to pay the employee, dont make changes. Quite correctly, QuickBooks doesnt update existing customer invoices and payroll records.
If you have made changes, when you click Save & Close to return to the report window, QuickBooks displays a message asking whether you want to refresh the report to accommodate the changes. Click Yes to see the new, accurate information in the report.
selection, click the checkmark beside it. You can also click Select None and then choose one or more specific users. To see the complete text of notes on timesheets, select the Print Full Activity Notes option. QuickBooks selects the Print First Line Only option by default.
FIGURE 20-5
CHAPTER
20
USING
TIME
TRACKIN G
435
You can click the Preview button to display the selected timesheets onscreen (see Figure 20-6). If you click the Print button in the Preview window, QuickBooks prints the timesheets immediately, giving you no opportunity to change the printer or any printing options. Click the Close button in the Preview window to redisplay the Select Timesheets To Print dialog box. Here, you can click OK to display the Print Timesheets dialog box where you can change the printer or printing options.
T I P : Change the number of copies to print to match the number of people to whom youre distributing the timesheets.
The last column on the printed or previewed timesheet displays the billing status using codes.
B Billable but not yet invoiced to the customer N Not billable D Billable and already invoiced to the customer
FIGURE 20-6
Chapter 21 Chapter 21
n this chapter:
Configuring payroll from timesheets Configuring services and reports for job costing
437
438
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
When you turn on time tracking (covered in Chapter 20), you can connect it to your QuickBooks payroll functions. You just move the information about each employees time into the employees paycheck. In addition to speeding up the process of creating paychecks, this means you can improve job costing by tracking your payroll expenses against jobs.
paychecks.
Set preferences to include job information from paychecks in payroll reports. Evaluate using class tracking in conjunction with payroll job costing
information.
rate and the overtime hourly rate, QuickBooks automatically inserts that information in the employees timesheet. If you havent entered an hourly rate for the employee during the data entry process in the timesheet, QuickBooks displays a message indicating that it will use a rate of $0.00 because no hourly rate exists. You can enter a rate when youre creating paychecks, or you can go enter a rate in the Edit Employee dialog box and set a rate. For salaried workers, QuickBooks still displays the message about no hourly rate, but you dont need to worry about it for payroll purposes. You will still be paying a salary to your employee. If you want to track payroll expenses as part of job costing, enable time tracking for salaried employees. To modify employees to use time data on paychecks, follow these steps: Open the Employee Center by clicking the Employees icon on the left side of the Home page or by clicking the Employee Center icon on the toolbar. Select the Employees tab to display the Employee list. Double-click an employee. In the Change Tabs drop-down list, choose Payroll And Compensation Info.
C H APT ER
21
USING
T IMESHEETS
FOR
PAY R O L L
J OB
COSTIN G
439
Click OK to close the employee record and return to the Employee list.
440
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 21-1
employee or an earnings item to a class, which are the two class-related payroll options available in the Payroll & Employees category of the Preferences dialog box you saw in Figure 21-1:
Entire Paycheck
Means you assign all payroll expenses on a check, including company-paid taxes, to one class. Earnings Item Means you can assign each payroll item that appears in the Earnings section of the paycheck to a class. If your classes provide a tidy way to fit each employee into a class, the entire paycheck option will work. For example, if you have branch offices, each of which is a class, you can assign the paychecks according to the location of the employee. If your classes divide your company by the products or services you provide, you should track classes by payroll item to produce useful reports. If your classes dont match the tracking options, you can just ignore the Class column when youre entering data or creating reports.
C H APT ER
21
USING
T IMESHEETS
FOR
PAY R O L L
J OB
COSTIN G
441
your own company as a customeryou can name this customer something like In Houseand assign this customer to nonbillable hours. Make sure employees account for every hour of the day on their timesheets, including sick time and vacation time.
FIGURE 21-2
For the current pay period, employees accounted for the number of hours displayed in the Total Hours column.
442
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
Select the employees to pay by placing a check in the leftmost column beside the employees name. When you run a scheduled payroll, QuickBooks, by default, selects all employees for you. To edit any employees check, click the employees name. The Preview Paycheck window appears (see Figure 21-3). For employees whose paychecks are generated from timesheets, QuickBooks displays the timesheet information in the Earnings section. Make any changes and click Save & Close to redisplay the Enter Payroll Information window. Click Continue. The Review And Create Paychecks window appears, letting you review payroll information and select options to produce paychecks by hand or by printing. You also have another opportunity to edit any paycheck by clicking the employees name. Click Create Paychecks.
N O T E : Chapter 8 has all the information you need to create checks and
direct deposit stubs.
FIGURE 21-3
You can make changes to the paycheck before you print it.
C H APT ER
21
USING
T IMESHEETS
FOR
PAY R O L L
J OB
COSTIN G
443
Its possible that the timesheet data that appear on the paycheck wont account for all of the employees time. In this case, when you edit the paycheck, enter a nonbillable administrative payroll item in the Earnings section and supply the employees rate and the number of hours needed to account for the balance of the employees time. QuickBooks does not update the employees timesheet with the changes you make to the employees paycheck. If you want accurate historical timesheets, dont make the changes while creating a paycheck. Instead, use the Weekly Timesheet window.
444
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 21-4
This customized report is a quick and accurate view of payroll job costs.
button and, in the Modify Report dialog box, click the Header/Footer tab. Change the contents of the Report Title box to something meaningful to you and click OK. Then, click the Memorize button to memorize the report.
Chapter 22 Chapter 22
n this chapter:
Installing the Timer Making copies for other users Using the Timer Exporting information to Timer users Importing files from the Timer
445
446
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
QuickBooks includes QuickBooks Timer, a program that permits you and people who perform work for you to track time automatically and to import the time into QuickBooks, where you can report on it, pay employees based on it, or bill clients for it. The Timer works by providing an onscreen clock that ticks away as you perform tasks. Each time you start a task, you tell Timer what youre doing, and the program keeps track of the amount of time it takes to complete each task.
FYI
www.quickbooksgroup.com/webx/forums/payroll/Employee%20Time%20Sheets/288/0
If you received a CD when you purchased QuickBooks, put your QuickBooks software CD in the CD-ROM drive. If AutoRun launches the CD and asks if you want to install QuickBooks, click No. Choose Start | All Programs | QuickBooks | Install QuickBooks Timer. When the installation program launches, follow the prompts that appear onscreen. When the installation finishes, the QuickBooks Pro Timer program listing appears in the QuickBooks Timer program group on the All Programs menu.
CHAPTER
22
USING
QUICKBOOKS
TIME R
447
Now youre ready to distribute the Timer to those who will be using it. You can distribute the program by placing it on a CD or by e-mailing it.
T I P : You can use the QuickBooks software CD to install the program for someone who works in your office but doesnt have QuickBooks installed on his or her computer. At the computer where you want to install the Timer program, insert the QuickBooks CD, navigate to the QBTimer folder, and double-click the setup.exe file. Afterward, follow the prompts onscreen.
To place the Timer program on a CD so that you can distribute it, unzip the file you downloaded from the QuickBooks Community forums or copy the QBTimer folder from the QuickBooks 2008 CD and paste it to a location on your hard drive. Then, use your CD recording software or Windows to burn a CD of the files in the QBTimer folder.
T I P : When you burn the CD, select only the files in the QBTimer folder. Dont select the folder that contains them. If you select the folder, recipients will have to drill down into the folder to find the installation file.
If you and your recipients have high-speed Internet connections and your ISP permits large attachments, you can e-mail the Timer software files instead of placing the files on a CD. The Timer files are about 5MB in size.
448
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
N O T E : Importing and exporting Timer data can only be done in single user
mode.
When the Export window opens (see Figure 22-1), choose a location for the file and give the file a name. The following are some guidelines for saving the file:
You can save the file to a portable thumb drive. If you are creating an export file that youre going to send on a disk, save the
file to a folder on your hard drive and use Windows or your CD-burning software to place the file on a CD.
FIGURE 22-1
CHAPTER
22
USING
QUICKBOOKS
TIME R
449
If you are creating an export file that youre going to send via e-mail, you can
save it to any folder on your hard drive, making sure that you remember where you saved it so that you can attach it to an e-mail. Give the file a name that will remind you of the company associated with the information. For instance, if the company name is A. J. Backstroke Inc., you might want to name the export file AJB.iif. I also suggest you add a number to the filename (see the filename I used in Figure 22-1), because you may be sending replacement lists as you add customers, services, or other items to your QuickBooks company file. The increasing number in the filename clearly identifies the latest file. QuickBooks adds an .iif file extension automatically. Click Save to save the export file, and QuickBooks displays a message indicating that the data have been exported successfully. Now you and other Timer users can use the file. You must go through the process of exporting lists each time you add items, names, or other important data to your company so that you can provide the new information to Timer users.
450
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
The Timer opens the New Timer File window. Enter a location and a filename for the information youll record while you use the Timer. By default, the Timer offers to save the file in the same folder in which the software exists. Click Save to save the file.
Ill 22-2
The Timer displays a message telling you that you must import company information before you can use your new file. It also offers to open a Help file that explains how to perform this task. You can click No to that offer, because the instructions are available right here.
Ill 22-3
To import the file containing QuickBooks company list information, choose File | Import QuickBooks Lists from the menu bar to open the Import QuickBooks Lists introductory window.
T I P : You can click the option to stop displaying this window in the future.
Click Continue to display the Open File For Import window. Select the folder or drive that contains the file of list information you received, select the file, and click Open. The Timer imports the file and then displays a message telling you that the file was imported successfully. Click OK to dismiss the message and then start using the Timer to track your time as you work.
Ill 22-4
CHAPTER
22
USING
QUICKBOOKS
TIME R
451
N O T E : From time to time, the person who uses QuickBooks will send you a
newer file of list information that youll need to import. You can import it easily by choosing File | Import QuickBooks Lists. This is a safe normal operation that doesnt harm the Timer file.
The Timer saves each activity you set up as a template, and you use that activity template as the foundation for creating a timed activity. Click the New Activity button to open the New Activity window and complete the form to set up an activity (see Figure 22-2). The Timer automatically fills in the current date, and you fill in the other fields by selecting from the listsclick the arrow beside each list to see your choices. The lists display the information you imported earlier in this chapter. In the Notes field, type a description of the work associated with this activity. When your activities are imported into QuickBooks, the first 1000 characters from the Notes field appear thats around 150 words. If the activity is billable to the customer, be sure to check the Billable box.
FIGURE 22-2
452
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
C A U T I O N : You cant add new entries to any list. You can only work with the items stored in the companys imported file.
After youve filled in the window, click Next to set up another activity or click OK to return to the Timer window. Having the template available saves you the time of selecting the customer, the service, and your name (the user) each time you want to time an activity. All thats missing from the template is the amount of time and any notes that might change.
T I P : You can edit any activity. Select it from the Current Activity list and click the Edit Activity button to open the window you saw in Figure 22-2. Make the changes you need to make and click OK.
FIGURE 22-3
Timing an activity
CHAPTER
22
USING
QUICKBOOKS
TIME R
453
reduce the size of the Timer window to display only the clock. To redisplay the full window, click the button again.
You can select a name that automatically appears in the Your Name field when you launch an activity. When you select this option, the Choose A Default Name window opens so you can select your name from the list. You also can choose to make your time billable or nonbillable by default. Number Of Days To Remember Activities You can specify the number of days that the Timer keeps an activity template (the default is 30). When the designated number of days elapses, the Timer removes the template. Turn On All One Time Messages You can bring back the message dialog boxes for which you selected the option Dont Show This Message Again. Show Time When Minimized Specify whether you want to see the elapsed time counter in the taskbar button when you minimize the Timer window. Minimizing the Timer window does not have the same effect as clicking the icon beside the digitally displayed time in the Timer window.
454
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 22-4
You can export specific entries or export all the information in your Timer file by following these steps: Stop all Timer activities. Choose View | Time Activity Log.
T I P : If you know you want to export all your activities, you dont have to open the Time Activity Log. Instead, from the QuickBooks Pro Timer window, choose File | Export Time Activities. Follow the onscreen prompts, and the Timer exports all your unexported time activities.
Choose the entries to export, as follows: To export all entries, click the Select All button. To export multiple entries, click the first entry you want to export and hold down the CTRL key as you click any additional entries. To export a single entry, click it. Click the Export button to start the Export Time Activities process. Click Continue if the opening explanation window appears. Remember, you can select the option to stop showing this window. In the Export Time Activities dialog box, choose All Unexported Time Activities Through and enter the date you want to use as the cutoff date for selecting activities. Or, choose Selected Activities if you chose one or more activities to export.
CHAPTER
22
USING
QUICKBOOKS
TIME R
455
Ill 22-5
Click OK and the Create Export File window opens. Select a location to store the file and give it an appropriate name. Its a good idea to use your initials in the name so that the user at the QuickBooks computer who imports Timer files can distinguish your file from other Timer files. Click Save. The Timer displays a message telling you that the file was exported successfully. Send the file back to the person whos responsible for entering this data into QuickBooks. You can send a disk or use e-mail.
N O T E : The first time you perform this task, you see another one of those
Timer explanatory windows. This one is welcoming you to the file-importing process. Select the option to skip this window in the future and click OK.
Locate and select the file. Click Open to import the file. QuickBooks notifies you when the file has been imported and displays a summary of the contents.
Ill 22-6
456
PART THREE
T RACKIN G
T IME,
M IL EAGE,
AND
REIMBURSABLE
EXPENSES
FIGURE 22-5
If you want to see details, click View Report. QuickBooks then displays the Timer Import Detail report (see Figure 22-5). Double-click a line item in the report to view the details of the entry in the Time/ Enter Single Activity window that QuickBooks created for the entry (see Figure 22-6).
FIGURE 22-6
CHAPTER
22
USING
QUICKBOOKS
TIME R
457
You can edit the entry if you wishits common to make the final decision at this point about whether you want to bill the activity to the client. You can also edit or remove any notes added by the user. If you prefer, you can view the information in the Weekly Timesheets window (click Timesheet in the Time/Enter Single Activity window, or choose Employees | Enter Time | Use Weekly Timesheet) and edit the information there. You can use the information to create reports and paychecks. See Chapter 20 for more information about using timesheets, and check out Chapter 21 for information about integrating timesheets with payroll.
Part Four
Managing QuickBooks
ll software needs TLC, and accounting software needs regular maintenance to ensure its accuracy and usefulness. In Part Four of this book, youll learn how to customize QuickBooks so that it works the way you work. The chapters in Part Four cover the features and tools you can use to make QuickBooks even more powerful. In addition, youll learn how to maintain the file system, create additional company files, and use QuickBooks in network mode (so more than one person can work in QuickBooks at the same time). Ill cover backing up your data, which is the most important maintenance task. Once you put your accounting data into QuickBooks, your business life depends on it. Hard drives die, motherboards freak out, power supplies go to la-la land, and all sorts of other calamities are just waiting to happen. Backing up saves your business life.
Chapter 23 Chapter 23
Customizing QuickBooks
n this chapter:
Setting preferences Managing users and passwords Creating classes Customizing the QuickBooks window
459
460
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
QuickBooks out of the box is set to run efficiently, providing powerful bookkeeping tools that are easy to use. However, you may want to do things a certain way, perhaps because of the way you run your company, the way your accountant likes things done, or the way you use your computer. If so, its likely that QuickBooks can accommodate you.
Setting Preferences
The preferences you establish in QuickBooks have a great impact on the way QuickBooks stores and reports information. Its not uncommon for QuickBooks users to change or tweak these preferences periodically. In fact, the more you use QuickBooks and understand the way it works, the more comfortable youll be about changing preferences. All the preferences you set appear in the Preferences dialog box; choose Edit | Preferences from the QuickBooks menu bar. The first time that you open the Preferences dialog box, QuickBooks displays the My Preferences tab of the General category (see Figure 23-1). If youve used the Preferences dialog box previously, it opens to the My Preferences tab of the category you were using when you closed the window.
FIGURE 23-1
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
461
You can view the preferences for any category in the Preferences dialog box by clicking the appropriate category in the left pane. No matter which category you view, you see two tabs: My Preferences and Company Preferences.
Use the My Preferences tab to set your preferences as a QuickBooks user.
Individual user options arent available for every category, so you wont always see options on the My Preferences tab. Each user set up in QuickBooks can set individual preferences. QuickBooks will apply the correct preferences as each user logs in to the software.
features work for the current company, regardless of the user who is using the company. As you set options and move from one category of the Preferences dialog box to another, QuickBooks asks whether you want to save the changes in the section you just left.
462
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
463
is useful for repeating transactions, even if one item (such as the amount) changes for the current transaction. If you choose Pre-Fill Accounts For Vendor Based On Past Entries, QuickBooks prefills accounts for a vendor transaction. QuickBooks reviews all recent transactions, looking for consistently used accounts. QuickBooks prefills the transaction if QuickBooks finds consistently used accounts. On the other hand, QuickBooks wont prefill the transaction if QuickBooks doesnt find consistently used accounts.
If you select Always, QuickBooks always keeps the descriptive text you wrote on the transaction, even though you selected a different item. If you select Never, QuickBooks always fills in the description that goes with the new item you selected. If you select Ask, QuickBooks prompts you each time you change an items description and then select a different item on the same line as the customized description.
464
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Time Format
You can select a format for entering time, choosing between decimal (for example, 11.5 hours) or minutes (11:30).
Accounting Preferences
Click Accounting on the left pane of the Preferences dialog box. The My Preferences tab contains only one optionthe choice to let QuickBooks automatically fill subsequent memo lines of a journal entry with the text entered on the first memo line. You can also set the following Company Preferences for the Accounting category (see Figure 23-2).
FIGURE 23-2
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
465
Require Accounts
When you enable the Require Accounts option , QuickBooks will require you to assign every item and transaction you create to an account. If you disable this option, QuickBooks posts transaction amounts that you dont manually assign to an account to Uncategorized Income or Uncategorized Expense. If you dont post transactions to accounts, you wont be able to produce reports that analyze your business, and so producing a tax return will be painful at best.
Date Warnings
By default, QuickBooks warns you if you set the date of a transaction 90 or more days in the past or 30 or more days in the future.
Closing Date
You can click the Set Date/Password button to set a password-protected closing date for your QuickBooks data file. Once you set the date and create a password, users cant manipulate any transactions that are dated on or before the closing date unless they know the password. See Chapter 17 for details on setting a closing date.
466
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Bills
The Bills category has no personal preferences to set. The Company Preferences tab has two configuration options for entering and paying vendor bills:
Entering Bills
Use the options in this section to set default payment terms for vendors in general and to display a warning if you enter a vendor bill that has the number of a bill you already entered from this vendor. QuickBooks uses the default terms you enter here for all vendors until you actually set each individual vendors terms. Paying Bills If you select the Automatically Use Discounts And Credits option, QuickBooks will apply any credits from the vendor to the open bills automatically and take any discount that the vendors terms permit based on terms stored in the vendors record. If you select this option, enter the account to which you want to post discounts taken. See Chapter 7 for detailed information about paying bills.
Checking Preferences
The Checking Preferences category has options on both the My Preferences and Company Preferences tabs. On the My Preferences tab, you can select default bank accounts for different types of transactions. You can skip these options if you only have one bank account. In addition, if you use online banking, you can select the Always Use The Register When Adding Downloaded Transactions option to avoid being prompted about the method you want to use to add downloaded transactions to QuickBooks. For details on online banking, see Chapter 16. From the Company Preferences tab (see Figure 23-3), you can set several options concerned with check printing, default payroll accounts, and online banking. These include the following:
Print Account Names On Voucher
If you print your checks and your check forms have stubs, you can select this option to print posting accounts on the stub. Change Check Date When Check Is Printed Select this option to assign the current date to checks when you print them. If you dont select this option, QuickBooks prints the check date you specified when you filled out the check window, even if that date has already passed. Start With Payee Field On Check By default, QuickBooks selects the Bank Account field as the first field when you open the Write Checks window. If you enable this option, QuickBooks places the insertion point in the Payee field when you open the Write Checks window. If you write most of your checks from one specific bank account, enable the option to save time.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
467
FIGURE 23-3
Set the options you need to make check writing more efficient.
By default, QuickBooks will warn you if a check number youre filling in already exists. Autofill Payee Account Number In Check Memo Most vendors maintain an account number for their customers. If you store your account number on the Additional Information tab of the Edit Vendor window, QuickBooks will print your account number in the lower-left section of the check. Select Default Accounts To Use You can set the default bank accounts for different types of payroll transactions. Then, when you print these checks, you dont have to select the bank account from a drop-down list in the transaction window. Payee Aliasing Is If you use online banking, you may want to create aliases so QuickBooks can more easily match downloaded transactions to names stored in QuickBooks. For example, you can create an alias so QuickBooks recognizes Home Depot Store 1234, Home Depot Store 4356, and Home Depot Store 8764 all as the vendor, Home Depot. To make sure QuickBooks lets you create aliases, leave the default option set to On.
468
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
FIGURE 23-4
In the View section, choose One Window to display only one window at a time, even if you have multiple windows open in QuickBooks. QuickBooks stacks the windows on top of each other, and only the top window is visible. In this mode, you cannot resize or minimize any windows other than the program window. To switch between multiple windows, use the Window menu or press CTRL+TAB. Choose Multiple Windows to view multiple windows on your screen at the same time. Often, you can switch from one window to another simply by clicking the window you want to use. In the Desktop section, you can specify what QuickBooks should do with the current desktop view when you exit the software.
Save When Closing Company
By default, QuickBooks saves the state of the desktop when you close the company or exit QuickBooks. Whatever QuickBooks windows were open when you left will reappear when you return so that you can pick up where you left off.
N O T E : If you select the option Show Home Page When Opening A Company
File, that option overrides any of the other options in the Desktop section. If you close the company file after closing the Home page, QuickBooks redisplays the Home page when you open the company file.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
469
When you select this option, QuickBooks displays the desktop as it was when you selected this option every time you open QuickBooks. Choose this option after youve opened only those QuickBooks windows you want to see each time you start the program. Dont Save The Desktop When you select this option, QuickBooks displays only the menu bar, Icon Bar, the Home page if you selected that option, and other navigation bars when you open this company file or when you start QuickBooks again after using this company file. Keep Previously Saved Desktop When you select this option, QuickBooks displays the desktop as it was the last time you used the Save Current Desktop option. This option only appears after youve used the Save Current Desktop option, and QuickBooks automatically selects it. Show Home Page When Opening A Company File Select this option to display the Home page when you open the company file. This option overrides the other desktop settings. Show Coach Window And Features Brand new QuickBooks users and upgraders from QuickBooks 2005 and earlier will see the Coach on the QuickBooks Home page by default, and everybody else can turn the Coach on if you want to use the Coach. For details on the Coach, see Chapter 1.
In the Color Scheme section, you can select a scheme from the drop-down list. In addition, you can click the Display or Sounds buttons to configure Windows settings for your monitor and sound card. Clicking either button opens the associated applet in the Windows Control Panel, and any changes you make to your display affect your computer and all your software, not just QuickBooks. On the Company Preferences tab, you can customize the content displayed on the QuickBooks Home page. You can also choose to include or exclude some of the default features that appear on the Home page if you enable those features.
470
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Select this option to tell QuickBooks that you want to enable the inventory and purchase orders features. Warn About Duplicate Purchase Order Numbers By default, QuickBooks displays a warning if you attempt to save a purchase order using a purchase order (PO) number that already exists. When Calculating Quantity Available For My Inventory, Deduct Use these options to control the way QuickBooks calculates Quantity Available. By default, QuickBooks excludes items that make up an assembly you plan to build and items that appear on sales orders. Warn If Not Enough Inventory To Sell Use these options to determine how QuickBooks calculates how much inventory is available to sell before it warns you of insufficient quantities. When you choose When The Quantity I Want To Sell Exceeds The Quantity On Hand, QuickBooks looks at the number you
FIGURE 23-5
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
471
have in stock. When you choose When The Quantity I Want To Sell Exceeds The Quantity Available, QuickBooks also considers quantities reserved for assemblies and sales orders. Unit Of Measure Click the Enable button to make the Unit Of Measure feature available. This feature functions differently for QuickBooks Premier and QuickBooks Enterprise. See Chapter 10 for details.
FIGURE 23-6
472
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
you in QuickBooks. If youre handling payroll in QuickBooks, you can set the following options:
Copy Earnings Details From Previous Paycheck
Select this option to save time and effort if your employees hours usually do not change from paycheck to paycheck or if you track paycheck expenses by Customer:Job or by class. When you select this option, QuickBooks copies earnings items, their rates, and hours from your employees previous paychecks onto their new ones.
N O T E : If you change an employees pay rate, you will have to make the
change manually on his or her next paycheck. QuickBooks does not transfer the new rate to the next paycheck.
Recall Quantity Field On Paychecks
Select this option when you have a fixed quantity that recurs from paycheck to paycheck and you want this quantity carried forward. When you select this option, QuickBooks carries forward quantities for all payroll items that are based on quantities and are part of the employees payroll record. The quantities are taken from the paycheck with the latest calendar posting date regardless of when the check was created. The latest calendar posting date may or may not be the latest date and could be a date in the future. For example, if you wrote a check last week and dated it October 1 and wrote a check today and dated it August 9, QuickBooks would carry forward the quantities from the October 1 check, even though that check would not be the most recent check you wrote. Recall Hour Field On Paychecks This option works exactly like the Recall Quantity Field On Paychecks option, except that it applies to hours instead of quantities. Job Costing And Item Tracking For Paycheck Expenses Select this option to track payroll costs by job, class, or service item. When you choose this option, QuickBooks prorates company-paid taxes on paychecks by your jobs, classes, and/or service items, using the ratios it derives from the way you split up earnings in the Earnings table. You can prorate additions and deductions in the same way. Set the preference in the Preferences dialog box and then edit each addition and deduction payroll item. Check the Track Expenses by Job option on the Name Used In Paychecks And Payroll Reports screen of the payroll item setup wizard.
You can select to display employee names in first name order or last name order. This option does not affect paychecks, on which the first name will appear first.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
473
When you select this option and create a new employee, QuickBooks automatically adds the employee to the Sales Rep list. Display Employee Social Security Numbers In Headers On Reports Select this option to display employee Social Security numbers on reports where data are broken out by employee.
Reminders Preferences
The Reminders category of the Preferences dialog box has options on both tabs. The My Preferences tab has one option, which turns on the Reminders feature. When you enable the Reminders feature, QuickBooks displays the Reminders List when you open a company file. The Company Preferences tab lists the available reminders, and you can select the ones you want to use (see Figure 23-7).
C A U T I O N : The Reminders List window is sometimes hidden behind the Home page. Click Window on the menu bar to switch to it, or minimize the Home page to reveal it.
FIGURE 23-7
474
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
For each item, decide whether you want to see a summary that lists the task and the total amount of money involved, a complete detailed list, or nothing at all. You can also determine the amount of lead time you want for your reminders.
T I P : If you choose Show Summary, the Reminders List window has an Expand All button you can click to see the details.
FIGURE 23-8
Set options for reports and graphs while using your company.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
475
report or graph with any changes you make. If you work with QuickBooks across a network, this could slow down your work a bit because QuickBooks will refresh the report whenever any user makes a change to data that are used in the report/graph. Choose Dont Refresh if you want to decide for yourself, without any reminder from QuickBooks, when to click the Refresh button on the report window.
Graphs Only
Give QuickBooks instructions about creating your graphs:
Choose Draw Graphs In 2D (Faster) to display graphs in two dimensions
instead of three. This doesnt impair your ability to see trends at a glance. Its just not as high-tech. Choose Use Patterns to draw the various elements in your graphs with black and white patterns instead of colors. For example, one pie wedge may be striped, another speckled. This is handy if you print your graphs to a black and white printer. On the Company Preferences tab of the Reports & Graphs category, you set company preferences for reports (see Figure 23-9).
Aging Repor ts
Specify whether you want to generate A/R and A/P aging reports using the due date or the transaction date.
476
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
FIGURE 23-9
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
477
If you choose not to add reimbursable expenses if they exist, then QuickBooks wont notify you if reimbursable expenses exist and it wont add reimbursable expenses to the invoice. Therefore, youll need to click the Add Time/Costs button in the Create Invoices window to check for reimbursable expenses and add them if appropriate. If you choose to be offered choices, QuickBooks will display a message each time you select a customer:job for whom reimbursable expenses exist; youll be able to choose between excluding the reimbursable costs or opening the Choose Billable Time And Costs dialog box. On the Company Preferences tab, youll find the following options (see Figure 23-10).
Sales Forms
In the Sales Forms section, you can set these options.
Usual Shipping Method
Set the default shipping method if you use the same shipping method most of the time. This saves you the trouble of making a selection from the drop-down list unless youre changing the shipper for a particular invoice. Usual FOB Set the FOB (Free On Board) language for invoices, which describes the location from which shipping is determined to be the customers responsibility. Youre limited to 13 characters, and the FOB has absolutely nothing to do with your finances. Warn About Duplicate Invoice Numbers When enabled, QuickBooks warns you if youre creating an invoice with an invoice number thats already in use.
FIGURE 23-10
478
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Miscellaneous
In the Miscellaneous section, you can use the Choose Template For Invoice Packing Slip option to select a default template to use when you print packing slips. If youve created customized packing slips, you can make one of them the default. Detailed information on customizing templates appears in Chapter 15.
Sales Orders
In the Sales Orders section, you can set these options.
Enable Sales Orders
Checking this box enables the sales order feature in QuickBooks. Warn About Duplicate Sales Order Numbers Checking this box makes QuickBooks display a warning if you attempt to save a sales order using a sales order number that already exists. Dont Print Items With Zero Amounts Use this option to control whether QuickBooks prints items with zero amounts on sales orders. Choose Template For Select default templates to use when you print packing slips and pick lists.
Receive Payments
In the Receive Payments section, you can set these options.
Automatically Apply Payments
Select this option to have QuickBooks automatically apply payments to open invoices. If the payment amount is an exact match for an open invoice, QuickBooks applies it to that invoice. If the payment amount is smaller than any open invoice, QuickBooks applies the payment to the oldest invoice. If the payment amount is larger than any open invoice, QuickBooks applies payments, starting with the oldest invoice, until the payment amount is used up. If you dont enable this option, you must manually apply each payment to an invoice. (Read Chapter 4 to learn about receiving and applying customer payments.) Automatically Calculate Payments When you select this option, you can select invoices to pay in the Receive Payment window before you enter the amount of the customers payment check. When youve finished selecting invoices, either paying them entirely or applying a partial payment, the amounts youve applied should equal the amount of the check you received. Use Undeposited Funds As A Default Deposit To Account Selecting this option automates the process of depositing all cash received into the Undeposited Funds account. Enabling the option helps you match deposits you make at your bank to the ones that will appear on your bank statement.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
479
Data Select this option if you want QuickBooks to allow you to save Web Connect data to import whenever you choose, instead of automatically importing downloaded transactions. If QuickBooks Is Run By My Browser, Dont Close It After Web Connect Is Done Select this option so that QuickBooks remains open after you process Web Connect data in a browser window that opened QuickBooks. From the Company Preferences tab, you can set the following connection options:
Automatically Connect Without Asking For A Password
Select this option to let all users log in to the QuickBooks Business Services network automatically. Always Ask For A Password Before Connecting Select this option to force users to enter a login name and password to access QuickBooks Business Services. Allow Background Downloading Of Service Messages Select this option to let QuickBooks check the Intuit web site periodically for updates and information when youre connected to the Internet.
480
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Spelling Preferences
The Spelling category contains options only on the My Preferences tab. From this tab, you can control the way the QuickBooks spell checker works. You can instruct QuickBooks to check spelling automatically before saving or printing any form. In addition, you can specify those words you want the spelling checker to skip, such as Internet addresses, numbers, and capital letters that probably indicate an abbreviation.
Tax:1099 Preferences
No options appear on the My Preferences tab for this category. Use the Company Preferences tab of this category to establish 1099 form options. For each type of 1099 payment, you must assign an account from your chart of accounts. (See Chapter 17 for more information about configuring and issuing 1099 forms.)
Check this option to be able to use the Invoice For Time & Expenses window to select reimbursable expenses to invoice. (See Chapter 18 to learn how to enter and invoice reimbursable expenses.) Track Reimbursed Expenses As Income Use this option to change the way your general ledger handles payments for reimbursements. When you enable the option, you can assign the reimbursement to an income account instead of posting back to the original expense account. If you enable the Track Reimbursed Expenses As Income feature, you can set a default markup percentage for expenses youre billing back to customers. (Read about tracking time in Chapter 20.)
Using Classes
You can use the Class Tracking feature to group items and transactions in a way that matches the kind of reporting you want to perform. Think of this feature as a way to classify your business activities. To use classes, you must enable the feature, which appears in the Accounting section of the Preferences dialog box. People commonly use classes to:
Report by location if you have more than one office Report by division or department Report by business type (perhaps you run both retail and wholesale businesses
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
481
FYI
Its important to understand that you should use classes for a single purpose. For example, you can use classes to separate your business into locations or by types of business, but dont try to do both. If you need to further define a class or narrow its definition, you can use subclasses. When you enable classes, QuickBooks adds a Class field to transaction forms. For each transaction or each line of any transaction, you can assign one of the classes you create.
Creating a Class
To create a class, choose Lists | Class List from the QuickBooks menu bar to display the Class List window.
N O T E : The Class List appears on the Lists menu only if you enable classes
on the Company Preferences tab of the Accounting category in the Preferences dialog box.
Press CTRL+N to add a new class. Fill in the name of the class in the New Class window. Click Next to add another class, or click OK if you are finished.
Ill 23-1
482
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Creating a Subclass
You can use subclasses to further refine the definition of your classes. Subclasses work similarly to subaccounts in your chart of accounts. If you set up a subclass, you must post transactions only to the subclass, never to the parent class. You create a subclass using basically the same steps required to create a class; when you create a subclass, you check the Subclass Of box and then choose the appropriate parent class from the drop-down list.
Reporting by Class
You can run two types of reports for classes.
Individual class reports Reports on all classes
To report on a single class, open the Class list and select the class on which you want to report. Then, press CTRL+Q to display a QuickReport on the class. When the Class QuickReport appears, you can change the date range or customize the report as needed. If you want to see one report in which all classes are used, open the Class list and click the Reports button at the bottom of the list window. Choose Reports On All Classes and then select either Profit & Loss By Class, Profit & Loss Unclassified, or Graphs. From the Graphs menu, you can produce an Income & Expenses graph or a Budget Versus Actual graph.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
483
FIGURE 23-11
The Profit & Loss By Class report is the same as a standard Profit & Loss report, except that each class appears in a separate column. The Totals column provides the usual Profit & Loss information for your company. This report is also available on the submenu under Reports | Company & Financial. The Profit & Loss Unclassified Report displays Profit & Loss totals for transactions on which you didnt assign classes. You can drill down to the transactions and add the appropriate class to each transaction. This is likely to be a rather lengthy report if you enabled class tracking after youd already begun using QuickBooks. You can find detailed information about running Profit & Loss reports and customizing reports in Chapter 15.
N O T E : You can customize many of the reports you run regularly to include
class information. Use the Filters tab to modify the report to include all, some, or one class.
484
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Icon Bar dialog box, which displays a list of the icons currently occupying your Icon Bar.
Ill 23-2
If you updated to QuickBooks 2008 from a previous version, the Icon Bar retains all the icons from the previous version. For new users or new companies, the default Icon Bar has a limited number of icons. The QuickBooks Centers icons are collectively called the Navigation Bar, so they dont appear in the Customize Icon Bar dialog box. If you want to hide the Navigation Bar, choose View | Navigation Bar. Use the same process to redisplay the Navigation Bar.
T I P : If your organization has set up usernames, each user can customize the Icon Bar without affecting any other users.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
485
To reduce the size of the icons on the bar, select Show Icons Only to remove the title text under the icons. As a result, you can see more icons on the Icon Bar without needing to click the button that appears at the far right edge of the Icon Bar. Positioning your mouse pointer over a small icon displays the icons description as a ToolTip.
N O T E : The Navigation Center buttons are not part of the Icon Bar and so
are unaffected by this option.
Separating Icons
You can insert a separator between two icons, which is an effective way to create groups of icons. The separator is a gray vertical line. In the Customize Icon Bar dialog, select the icon that should appear to the left of the separator bar and click Add Separator. QuickBooks inserts the separator on the icon bar and (space) appears in the Icon Bar Content list to indicate the location of the separator.
Removing an Icon
If there are any icons you never use or use infrequently, you can remove them. Select the icon in the Customize Icon Bar dialog box and click Delete. QuickBooks deletes the icon from the Icon Bar immediately. When you click OK, QuickBooks displays the new Icon Bar minus the icons you removed.
N O T E : Youre deleting the icon from the Icon Bar, not from QuickBooks. If
you want to display the icon on the Icon Bar again, read on.
486
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Adding an Icon
You can add an icon to the Icon Bar in either of two ways:
Choose Add in the Customize Icon Bar dialog box. Automatically add an icon for a window, transaction, or report youre currently
using.
Scroll through the list to select the task you want to add to the Icon Bar. QuickBooks selects a default graphic for the icon. If you dont like the default icon, choose a different graphic to represent the new icon. If you wish, you can change the Label, which is the title that appears below the icon or the Description (the text displayed in the ToolTip when you pause your mouse pointer over the icon). When you click OK, QuickBooks adds the icon to the right of the existing icon you selected.
N O T E : QuickBooks always adds your icon to the end of the Icon Bar. If the
Icon Bar is already full, click the button at the right edge of the Icon Bar that contains two right-pointing carats to see additional buttons that QuickBooks cant fit on your screen. To reposition the icon, choose View | Customize Icon Bar and drag the diamond beside the icon to a new position.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
487
T I P : You can also drag the Icon Bar down so that it appears below the Navigation Bar, which will display more icons.
The administrator determines who can use the various features in QuickBooks. Its a good idea to leave the administrators name as Admin, but you should assign an Admin password. To password-protect the administrators login, type a password in the Administrators Password box and then type the same password in the Confirm Password box.
488
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
C A U T I O N : Make a note of the Admin password and keep it in a secure place. In fact, you might consider using a password vault software package or placing the Admin password under lock and key. If you forget the administrators password, you can call QuickBooks support and arrange to have them recover the passwordfor a fee.
N O T E : To remove a user from the User List, select the name and then click
the Delete User button. You can delete any user except the administrator. When you edit a user, QuickBooks launches the same wizard you use to add a user. For more information, read on.
To add a new user to the list, click Add User to start a wizard that assists you in setting up the new user. In the first wizard window, fill in the necessary information as follows: Enter the username. The user types this name to log in to QuickBooks. Although passwords are optional, you should enter and confirm the users password to prevent unauthorized access to those areas in which the user has permission to work. Click Next to set up the users access to QuickBooks features. (See the next section Setting User Permissions.)
T I P : If a user comes to you, the Administrator, because he or she cannot remember a password, reset it by editing the user.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
489
C A U T I O N : Giving a user full access to all areas of QuickBooks doesnt provide any security. Think that decision through carefully.
If you want to limit the users access, click Selected Areas Of QuickBooks and click Next. The ensuing wizard windows take you through a series of screens, each representing an area of QuickBooks such as Sales and Accounts Receivable or Purchases and Accounts Payable. On each screen, you can assign one of the following permission options:
No Access
The user is denied permission to open any windows in that section of QuickBooks. Full Access The user can open all windows and perform all tasks in that section of QuickBooks. Selective Access The user can perform the tasks you select. When you choose this option, you also specify the rights this user should have. Those rights vary slightly from component to component, but generally youre asked to choose one of these permission levels: Create transactions only Create and print transactions Create transactions and create reports
T I P : You can select only one of the three levels, so if you need to give the user rights to more than one of these choices, you must select Full Access for the area instead of Selective Access.
Two of the wizard windows for setting permissions are not directly related to any specific area of the software: sensitive accounting activities and sensitive financial reports. Sensitive accounting activities are those tasks that arent directly related to QuickBooks transactions, such as:
Making changes to the chart of accounts Manipulating the register for any balance sheet account
490
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Using online banking Transferring funds between banks Reconciling bank accounts Creating journal entries Preparing an accountants review Working with budgets
Sensitive financial reports are those reports that reveal important financial information about your company, such as:
Profit & Loss reports Balance sheet reports Budget reports Cash flow reports Income tax reports Trial balance reports Audit trail reports
T I P : Dont forget that the Audit Trail report will tell you who did what and when they did it. (See Chapter 15 for details.)
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
491
Print 940, 941 Forms Adjust Payroll Liabilities Budgets Create Paychecks Assess Finance Charges Interviews (for 940, 941, East Step Interview, and so on) Mail Merge Sending or Receiving Payroll Service Data Make Deposits Online Account Setup Online Banking Download Online Banking Inset Transaction TABLE 23-1
Online Banking Matching Online Mail Pay Bills Pay Liabilities Pay Sales Tax Payroll YTD Print Paycheck/Paystub Print Statements Update/Autopatch W2, W3 Creation and Printing Batch Printing Checks (By Account)
In addition, you cant perform certain activities in Multiuser Mode, such as backing up your company file. For these activities, listed in Table 23-2, you need to switch to Single User Mode, and everybody needs to be logged out of the company file so that you can switch to Single User Mode. To switch, choose File | Switch To Single User Mode.
Backing up, condensing, converting, rebuilding, restoring, or updating the company data file Changing company information, including the closing date Setting up or changing preferences Importing or exporting data Merging, deleting, or resorting list items Changing list item fields that interact with other lists
Signing up for a payroll service Printing Form 1099-MISC Mapping a network drive from within QuickBooks Defining custom fields Linking to QuickBooks from TurboTax Accountants review activities
TABLE 23-2
492
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
N O T E : Access to this window can (and should) be limited using roles, since
you can control all aspects of permission to use your data from this window. Occasionally, QuickBooks users will need to know whos logged in to the company; any user can view the list of users in the system by choosing Company | Users | View Users.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
493
Youll also notice that the Users And Roles window contains a Role List tab; QuickBooks Enterprise uses roles to establish sets of permissions. For each role, you define the type of access you want to grant to any user assigned to that role. Then, you create users and assign a role to each one. The role you assign determines what that user can and cannot do in QuickBooks. By using roles, you can establish a set of permissions once but can assign it many times.
To get a good feel for the way roles work, select one and edit it so that you can see how it is set up. Dont make any changes; just look. Using roles, you can define a users permissions in extreme detail. Any filled-in symbol beside an area or activity indicates that the role has full access to that area or activity. When the symbol appears only partly filled in, the roles access to that area is limited, but the way in which the access is limited can vary. For example, in one area, the role may have permission to view information, but not create, modify, or delete. In another area, the same role may have permission to view and create but not modify or delete.
494
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
You can click the plus sign beside an area or activitythe plus sign changes to a minus signto view the roles permissions for that area or activity.
Ill 23-9
or activity of QuickBooks.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
495
Partial
The user can perform the tasks you select, and you specify the rights this user should have in relation to those tasks. Those rights vary slightly from component to component, but generally youre asked to make decisions about these permission levels: View and create transactions or reports View and modify transactions or reports View and delete transactions or reports View and print transactions or reports When appropriate, view balance information
When you give partial permission, you can mix and match the options. For example, you can give the role permission to view, create, and modify transactions but not delete or print them.
C A U T I O N : When you give a user permission to find all transactions, that user can find transactions that they might not otherwise have permission to view. For example, a user who doesnt have permission to view paychecks can find and view a paycheck amount and payee but not be able to zoom in on the paycheck to see details. N O T E : To give a user permission to view and print a memorized report, you
must also give the user permission to view the report from which the memorized report was created.
T I P : If you change the name from Admin to a users name, you can still log in using the name Admin.
As you set up the Admin username and password, you can also set up a challenge question and answer. This challenge question and answer come into play if you forget your Admin password. QuickBooks will ask the challenge question and, if you answer correctly, QuickBooks will open the company. QuickBooks will then delete the old password and make you enter a new one. Caution: If you forget the administrators password and the answer to the challenge question, you can call QuickBooks support and arrange to have them recover the password. Standard recovery is free for Enterprise users, but expedited recovery has a fee.
496
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
To create a new user, click the User List tab and then click New. QuickBooks displays the New User dialog box.
Ill 23-10
Enter the username; the user types this name to log into QuickBooks. If you want to establish a password for this user (its optional), enter and confirm the users password.
T I P : If a user comes to you, the Administrator, because he or she cannot remember a password, reset it by editing the user.
In the Available Roles list, click a role and then click the Add button. You can repeat this step to assign additional roles to the user. Click OK. QuickBooks redisplays the User List tab of the Users And Role window; the user you just created appears in the Users list. If you click the user, youll see the roles you assigned to the user in the Roles Assigned box.
CHAPTER
23
CUSTOMIZING
QUICKBOOK S
497
N O T E : To remove a user from the User List, select the name and then click
the Delete User button. You can delete any user except the administrator. When you edit a user, QuickBooks displays the same dialog box you use to add a user.
Reporting on Permissions
You can print a very useful report on the permissions granted to each user; using this report, you can identify modifications you want to make. The report lists all the areas and activities in QuickBooks for which you can assign permissions, along with a column for each user and that users permission for each area (see Figure 23-12). To view this report, click the View Permission button on either tab of the Users And Roles window. Then select the users you want to include as columns on the report and click Display.
T I P : Dont forget that the Audit Trail report will tell you who did what and when they did it. (See Chapter 15 for details.)
FIGURE 23-12
Use this report to identify permissions assigned to each user youve created.
498
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Print 940, 941 Forms Adjust Payroll Liabilities Budgets Create Paychecks Assess Finance Charges Interviews (for 940, 941, East Step Interview, and so on) Mail Merge Sending or Receiving Payroll Service Data Make Deposits Online Account Setup Online Banking Download Online Banking Inset Transaction TABLE 23-3
Online Banking Matching Online Mail Pay Bills Pay Liabilities Pay Sales Tax Payroll YTD Print Paycheck/Paystub Print Statements Update/Autopatch W2, W3 Creation and Printing Batch Printing Checks (By Account)
Chapter 24 Chapter 24
n this chapter:
Finding transactions Backing up and restoring company files Using a portable company file Creating an Accountants Copy of the company file Cleaning up data Updating QuickBooks software
499
500
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
In addition to performing bookkeeping chores in QuickBooks, you may need to take care of some computer file housekeeping tasks. In this chapter, well go over ways to find transactions outside the QuickBooks centers. Afterward, well look at creating new companies, backing up and restoring company data files, periodically sharing your data with your accountant, cleaning up your data, and updating your QuickBooks software.
Finding Transactions
In addition to the Transactions tab of the Customer Center, the Vendor Center, and the Employee Center that you learned about in Chapters 3, 6, and 8, QuickBooks contains other ways to find information in your QuickBooks company file:
The Simple tab of the Find window The Advanced tab of the Find window The Google Desktop designed especially for QuickBooks
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
501
In the Transaction Type list, click Bill and then type the number of the bill in the Ref. No. box. Click Find and QuickBooks displays the results of the search at the bottom of the window. You can double-click the entry to display it in the Enter Bills window. Then, click the History button at the top of the Enter Bills window to view details about the check that paid the bill. From the Transaction HistoryBill window that QuickBooks displays, you can double-click a payment to display the check in the Bill Payments window or print the check onto plain paper to fax to your vendor.
502
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
You can use the Google Desktop search engine to quickly and easily find transactions and list items in QuickBooks. Use this specialized version of the Google Desktop Search the same way that you use the popular Google search engine on the Internet, searching for multiple words or excluding items from your search results. The more words you include in your search, the more focused the search will be. If you use too many words, Google Desktop Search may not find any information. When you click the Search QuickBooks button, you search only your QuickBooks company file. But when you click the Search QuickBooks and Desktop button, you search your QuickBooks company file and other files on your computer, such as e-mail or Microsoft Word documents. When you use Google Desktop Search inside QuickBooks, you are not searching the Internet. Also, Google Desktop Search will not display any information that you do not have permission to view. In multiuser environments, all users will be able to see only the information that they have permission to view. In addition to using Google Desktop Search from inside QuickBooks, you may have noticed the Search box that appears on your Windows Task Bar. You can use this Search box to search your computer, but, for added protection, you cannot search your QuickBooks data unless you launch Google Desktop Search from inside QuickBooks. In addition, Intuit has set the preferences for this customized version of Google Desktop Search so that none of your information is transmitted over the Internet or shared with other computers. You can double-check your Google Desktop Search preferences by clicking the Google Desktop icon on the Windows taskbar and then clicking Preferences.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
503
up your company file quick and easy. Clients ask me why they need to back up daily. I usually answer by suggesting that they ask themselves the following questions:
How much is my datamy customer lists, my purchase historyworth? How much will it cost me to reconstruct my finances to do my taxes if I lose
my QuickBooks file? When you think about the effort you put in to record accurate data in QuickBooks, its hard to find a justifiable reason to risk losing the data to a hard drive failure, an office fire, or a burglary. I cant urge you strongly enough: Back up your data daily.
Backing Up
To create a backup of the current company, choose File | Save Copy or Backup from the menu bar to start the backup wizard. On the Save File: Type screen, choose Backup copy and click Next. On the next screen, shown in Figure 24-1, choose Local Backup.
T I P : You can sign up for the Online Backup subscription service through QuickBooks. Using this service, you back up your company file over the Internet to secure servers. QuickBooks Online Backup encrypts your data with bank-level security and stores it at two separate data centers to keep it secure. A 30-day free trial is available.
FIGURE 24-1
On this screen, you can choose to make a local backup or use the QuickBooks Online Backup subscription service.
504
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
The first time you create a backup in QuickBooks, you should click the Options button to display the Backup Options dialog box.
Ill 24-3
Choosing a Location
You can back up to an external drive, such as a CD or DVD drive, a flash drive, or a zip drive. You can also back up to a mapped drive or to a shared folder on another computer on your network. If youre using a zip drive, you cannot set the default unless you put a disk in the drive.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
505
FYI
hard drive that Windows uses as a temporary holding area. When QuickBooks finishes creating the backup file, a message appears, telling you that QuickBooks has successfully created the backup file but the file hasnt been written to CD yet. If you use Windows XP Windows Server 2003, or Windows Vista, QuickBooks , offers to open the Windows CD Burning Wizard, then Windows finishes the
506
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
burning process. If you dont use Windows XP Windows Server 2003, or , Windows Vista, you will need to use third-party burning software to finish the burning process.
N O T E : If your backup file is too large to fit on one CD, youll need to use a
different backup media, such as a DVD, a USB flash drive, or an external hard drive.
If you use any medium other than a DVD or CD, QuickBooks opens your
T I P : When you first start backing up data, once each week, test your backup by restoring it to a location other than your current company data file. By performing this test, you confirm that your backup procedure is working. Once you know the process works, you can reduce your backup tests to once a month. Read Restoring a Backup later in this chapter for details.
Automatic Backups
QuickBooks lets you schedule two types of automatic backups:
An automated backup when closing a company file A scheduled backup at a time you specify
To set up automatic backups, follow these steps: Choose File | Save Copy Or Backup. On the first screen of the wizard, click Backup Copy and click Next. On the second screen of the wizard, click Local Backup and click Next. On the third screen of the wizard, click Only Schedule Future Backups and click Next. The screen shown in Figure 24-2 appears. Read the next two sections for details on completing this screen; then click Finish.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
507
FIGURE 24-2
Although the descriptive name is optional, supplying a name is a good idea if youre going to create multiple unattended backup configurations. Location You can store the backup file on an external hard drive, CD or DVD drive, zip drive, or USB flash drive. If you back up to your network drive, use the UNC path (\\servername\sharename) and not a mapped drive because mapped drives are available only when you are logged in to Windows, and, typically, youll perform this task in the middle of the night when youre not logged in to Windows. If you set up the scheduled task using a mapped drive and log out of Windows, the task will fail. However, if you use the UNC path, the task will succeed.
508
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
FIGURE 24-3
C A U T I O N : Be sure the target drive is availableinsert the zip, USB, or other removable drive before leaving the computer, or be sure the remote network computer youre using for backup storage isnt shut down.
Number of Backup Copies to Keep
Use this option to avoid overwriting the last backup file. QuickBooks saves as many discrete backup files as you specify, each time replacing the first file with the most recent backup and copying older files to the next highest number in the filename, which always begins with SBU_0. SBU stands for Scheduled Back Up.
N O T E : Unattended backup files are saved with the filename pattern SBU_
0_<CompanyFilename><Date/TimeStamp>. If you specify two backup files in the Number Of Backups To Keep field, the second filename starts with SBU_1_. This pattern continues for the number of backups you specified.
Select The Time And Day You Want To Save The Back Up
Create a schedule for this unattended backup by selecting a time and a frequency.
When you click OK, QuickBooks displays the Set Password dialog box. The password in question is not your QuickBooks username and password; its your Windows username and password.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
509
N O T E : You cannot use a blank password. If you do, the scheduled task will
fail. If a scheduled backup fails for some reason, you should see a message when you open the company data file.
T I P : If you begin to experience performance issues after a period of performing automated backups, perform a backup when you exit QuickBooks. Your QuickBooks company file is actually a collection of three files: the .qbw file, the .nd file, and the .tlg file. Scheduled backups dont reset the .tlg file, so, over time, it may grow and affect performance. Performing a manual backup will reset the file and may improve performance.
When you finish setting options for your scheduled backup, click OK.
Restoring a Backup
There comes a time when you need to restore those backups youve been making so diligently. Perhaps your hard drive failed, or you upgraded to a new computer. Or perhaps you discovered damaged data and you want to roll back to a valid company file. Whatever the reason, restoring a QuickBooks backup is quick and easy.
Heres how to restore a local backup file: If you backed up to removable media, put the disk that contains your last backup into its drive. If you backed up to a network share, be sure the remote computer is running. Choose File | Open Or Restore Company from the QuickBooks menu bar. On the screen that appears, choose Restore A Backup Copy and click Next. On the new screen that appears, choose Local Backup and click Next. QuickBooks displays the Open dialog box. The Look In list box shows the backup location you originally selected when you set backup options. Select a backup file to restore and click Open. The next screen of the wizard indicates that you will need to select the location where you want to restore the file. Click Next. QuickBooks displays the Save Company File As dialog box. Select the folder in which to place the company you are restoring, or select the folder containing your regular QuickBooks company file and then change the file name.
510
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Click Save. If you use the original name of the backup file and you select the location where QuickBooks stores your company file, QuickBooks displays a warning that youre about to overwrite the existing file. Click Yes, because you want to entirely replace the existing company file with your backup file. QuickBooks asks you to confirm that you want to replace the file. Type Yes and click OK. QuickBooks restores the file. QuickBooks displays a message that your data files have been restored successfully. You did it! Arent you glad you back up regularly? Click OK and go to work!
C A U T I O N : E-mailing your QuickBooks data is not secure. E-mail is like a postcardanyone who rifles through your mailbox can read it. In addition, even though a .qbm file is much smaller than its .qbw counterpart, if your .qbw file is over 100MB, it may compress to a 10MB file, which generally isnt small enough to e-mail.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
511
You can also use a portable company file to move data between computers (such as your home computer and your office computer), so you can work at home, and then bring the updated file back to the office. You could also send the file to your accountant.
512
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Select the folder in which to place the company you are restoring or choose the folder containing your regular QuickBooks company file and change the file name of the company. Click Save. If you use the original name of the backup file and the location where QuickBooks stores your company file, QuickBooks displays a warning that youre about to overwrite the existing file. Click Yes because you want to entirely replace the existing company file with your portable company file. QuickBooks asks you to confirm that you want to replace the file. Type Yes and click OK. QuickBooks opens the portable company file.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
513
To create an Accountants Copy to send to your accountant via Intuits secure server, make sure that youre working in single-user mode and then follow these steps: Choose File | Accountants Copy | Send to Accountant. The Send Accountants Copy Wizard starts. Read the information on the first screen of the wizard and click Next. On the screen that appears (see Figure 24-4), supply a dividing dateyour accountant can work on transactions dated before this date, and you can work on transactions dated after this date. The date you supply should be a date in the past that represents the ending date of the period you want your accountant to review.
T I P : If youve enabled security, you can use the administrators login password to encrypt your file. If you use a different password to encrypt your file, make sure that you supply your accountant with both passwords.
FIGURE 24-4
514
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Click Next and supply your accountants e-mail address, your name, and your e-mail address.
Ill 24-4
Click Next and create a password to encrypt your file. You must use a password that is at least eight characters and contains one number and one uppercase letter.
N O T E : You can type a message to your accountant on this screen, but dont
include the file transfer password, because the message isnt secure.
C A U T I O N : Dont forget to give your accountant the password so that your accountant can open the file after downloading it.
Click Send. A message appears, telling you that QuickBooks must close all open windows. Click OK. QuickBooks creates the Accountants Copy file and transfers it to a secure server at Intuit.
A message appears, telling you that your file has been successfully uploaded and reminds you to give the file transfer password to your accountant. You can click OK to dismiss the message. In addition, the title bar of the program changes to display your company name followed by Accountants Changes Pending in parentheses.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
515
N O T E : If you prefer to give the Accountants Copy file that you create to your
accountant on a CD or on a flash drive, you can choose File | Save Copy Or Backup or you can choose File | Accountants Copy | Save File. In the wizard that starts, select the Accountants Copy option. You set a dividing date the same way that you would if you were using Intuits Accountants Copy File Transfer Service and then select a location to store the file.
516
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Client Transactions Prior Period Add Edit Delete Current Period Add Edit Delete
Banking Journal Entries Write Checks Make Deposit Transfers Credit Card Charge & Credit Reconciliations Sales and Customers Sales Orders Estimates Sales Receipts Invoices & Credit Memos Statement Charges Receive Payment Purchases and Vendors Purchase Orders Enter Bills Vendor Credit Item Receipt Pay Bills Pay Sales Tax Adjust Quantity/Value on Hand Build Assemblies Payroll Paychecks Pay Payroll Liabilities Payroll Adjustments N N N N N N N N N Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y
TABLE 24-1
What You Can and Cannot Do in Relation to the Dividing Date While an Accountants Copy Exists
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
517
To open your clients Accountants Copy file, choose File | Accountants Copy | Open & Convert Accountants Copy Transfer File. A wizard begins by giving you an overview of the process. While you work on the Accountants Copy, you can make changes that affect transactions dated on or before the dividing date the client set while creating the file. Your client can make changes to transactions dated after the dividing date. When you click Next, the wizard describes, in general, what you can and cannot do while working in the Accountants Copy. When you click Next, the wizard prompts you to navigate to the location containing the file and open it. Once you open the file, youll be prompted to name the file. QuickBooks suggests a name that includes your clients file name and an extension of .qba; you can accept the suggestion. QuickBooks converts the file for your use, and, when the process finishes, displays a message telling you the dividing date the client set when creating the file. Now you can go to work. You have some restrictions about the work you can perform in the Accountants Copy, but theyve been greatly reduced starting in QuickBooks 2007. Table 24-2 describes what you can and cannot do with the Accountants Copy file. In general, accountants:
Can reconcile a bank or credit card account and send the results of the
reconciliation back to the client Can edit or void deposits Can add, edit, merge, and sort accounts and make accounts inactive on the Chart of Accounts Can change the account type of any account Can add entries to the Chart of Accounts, Class, Customer, Vendor, Employee, Items, Fixed Assets, and Other Names lists Can edit items and vendors Cannot sort any lists or delete or merge list entries on any list except the Chart of Accounts Can view but not add or change budgets, forecasts, and memorized reports
518
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Journal Entries Write Checks Make Deposit Transfers Credit Card Charge Credit Card Credit Sales Orders Estimates Sales Receipts Invoices Pending Invoices Credit Memo Statement Charges Receive Payment Purchase Orders Enter Bills Vendor Credit Vehicle Mileage Item Receipt Pay Bills Pay Bills (credit card) Pay Sales Tax Adjust Quantity/Value on Hand Build Assemblies Enter Time Pay Employees Pay Payroll Liabilities YTD Adjustment Adjust Payroll Liabilities Reconciliation Print 1099/1096 Process Payroll Forms
Y Y Y N Y Y N N Y Y N Y Y Y Y Y Y N Y Y Y N Y N N N N N N Y Y N
Y Y N N Y Y N N Y Y N Y Y Y N Y N N N Y N N N N N N N N N Y N/A N/A
Y Y Y N Y Y N N Y Y N Y Y Y N Y Y N Y Y Y N Y Y N N N N N Y N/A N/A
Y Y Y N Y Y N N Y Y N Y Y Y Y Y Y N Y Y Y N Y Y Y N N Y N Y N/A N/A
N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N Y N/A N/A
N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N Y N/A N/A
TABLE 24-2
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
519
At any point while working in an Accountants Copy, you can choose File | Accountants Copy | View / Export Changes For Client to see what you have done so far. You can click on any entry on the report that appears and the corresponding transaction or list element will open.
Ill 24-5
When you are done reviewing changes and are happy with the results, you can export your changes by clicking the Create Change File For Client button on the report. QuickBooks prompts you to save a file with an extension of .qby; you can accept the suggested file name. No file transfer service exists for you to return updates to the client. But, you can safely e-mail the file, because it is not a complete file and, since it contains changes only, it will be small enough to make it through e-mail filters.
520
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
N O T E : The file you receive from your accountant will have an extension of .qby.
Follow these steps to make changes: Make the file you received from your accountant available. If your accountant gave you the file on a CD or flash drive, insert it. If you received the file via e-mail, detach it from the e-mail and note the folder you used to place it on your hard drive. Choose File | Accountants Copy | Import Accountants Changes. If you see a message telling you that QuickBooks must close all open windows, click OK. The Import Accountants Changes dialog box appears. Select the .qby file to import and click Open. QuickBooks displays the Import Accountants Changes window, which allows you to preview the changes that will be merged into your company data file. You can also print the changes or save them to a PDF file. Printing or saving changes to a PDF file is particularly helpful if you see something that concerns you and you want to discuss it with your accountant before you import the changes. You may also see a note from your accountant in this window.
Ill 24-6
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
521
Click Import. QuickBooks backs up your current file before importing and then merges the changes into your company data file. The Import Accountants Changes window appears, letting you know that the changes were merged successfully. Once again, you have the opportunity to print the changes or save them to a PDF file. Click Close. QuickBooks opens your company file, which now contains the changes your accountant made. QuickBooks displays the Closing Date dialog box, offering you the opportunity to update the closing date and password to prevent changes to the period on which your accountant just worked. You now can work with your file using all features available in QuickBooks.
C A U T I O N : You should not remove restrictions from your file unless you
are absolutely certain that your accountant will not be providing changes. Once you remove restrictions from your company data file, you will not be able to import any changes your accountant may provide.
Because you cannot import changes from your accountant if you cancel the Accountants Copy, QuickBooks asks you to confirm the cancellation. Check the Yes, I Want To Remove The Accountants Copy Restrictions box and click OK if youre sure you want to cancel.
Cleaning Up Data
QuickBooks provides a feature that enables you to remove certain data in your company file by replacing transaction details with summary information. Because you lose details about transactions, read on to understand the effects of the feature.
522
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Be aware that the cleanup process can take an extremely long time because of the intensive checking QuickBooks does to determine if each transaction can be removed. As long as you can move your mouse, and the hourglass mouse pointer moves, QuickBooks is still cleaning up your company data fileeven if the Task Manager indicates that QuickBooks is Not Responding.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
523
N O T E : You may see a warning that your budget data may be affected during
cleanup because some budgets are based on detailed postings. See Chapter 13 to learn how to export your budgets and import them back into QuickBooks.
The wizard offers two choices for proceeding: Remove Transactions As Of A Specific Date, or Remove ALL Transactions. Choose the first option. QuickBooks automatically displays the last day of the previous fiscal year as the cutoff date for this option. You can use this date or choose an earlier date (a date long past, so you wont care if you lose the transaction details). Be sure to choose the last day of a month, quarter, or year. The other option, Remove ALL Transactions, is really an option to wipe all your data so that you can create a new (empty) company file with the same name as your current company file. The new file will retain your list information, preferences, and service subscriptions but none of your data. Its unusual to do this, however, so before you choose this option, make sure that you have a backup that youve tested. Click Next to see a list of the transaction types that are not removed (see Figure 24-6). You can select any of them to include them in the to be removed list, if you know you dont need to keep details about those transaction types.
FIGURE 24-5
Select the option you want to use for the cleanup process.
524
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
FIGURE 24-6
You can remove transactions that QuickBooks would normally keep, but do this carefully.
Click Next and select the lists (accounts, customers, vendors, and so on) you want QuickBooks to empty of unused items. Click Next to see an informational window that explains the cleanup process. Click Begin Cleanup to start the process. QuickBooks displays a message telling you it will make a backup of your data file before proceeding with the cleanup process. This is not an everyday backup; its the last backup of a full data file before information is removed. I suggest that you add text to the name of the backup file to indicate that its special, such as Before Cleanup-My Company File (Backup Sep 30, 2008 07 22 PM).QBB. Click OK to start the Backup Wizard. As soon as QuickBooks finishes backing up, it starts removing data. Youll see progress bars on your screen as each step completes. When QuickBooks finishes the job, QuickBooks displays the name of the backup copy of your data file that QuickBooks created, which is intact, so you can open it if you need to see transaction details. QuickBooks calls this copy an archive copy.
Updating QuickBooks
QuickBooks provides a free automatic update service that you can use to make sure your QuickBooks software is up-to-date and trouble-free. This service provides you with any maintenance releases of QuickBooks that have been created since you purchased and installed your copy of the software. A maintenance release is distributed when a problem is discovered and fixed. This is sometimes necessary because its virtually impossible to distribute a program that is totally bug-free, although my experience has been that QuickBooks generally releases without any major bugs since Intuit does a thorough job of testing.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
525
The Update QuickBooks service also provides notes and news from Intuit so you can keep up with new features and information for QuickBooks.
The Update QuickBooks service is a free online service (see Chapter 16 for details on setting up online access for QuickBooks). When you want to check for updated information, choose Help | Update QuickBooks from the menu bar to open the Update QuickBooks window shown in Figure 24-7. You can set up QuickBooks to automatically check for updates, download them, and install them, or you can set up QuickBooks to download only updates when you manually run the feature. In most cases, automatically updating QuickBooks is the best approach since it keeps your software up-to-date with no real effort on your part. However, if you work in an environment where many people are affected by software updates, you may prefer to back up your QuickBooks data and then download updates manually so that you control the process.
FIGURE 24-7
You can use the Update QuickBooks dialog box to establish update options or to download an update manually.
526
PART FOUR
M AN AG IN G
Q UICKBOOKS
Automatic Updates
If you download updates automatically, QuickBooks checks the Intuit update web site periodically while youre connected to the Internet. QuickBooks doesnt need to be running to check for updates. If the Automatic Updates feature finds new information, it downloads that information to your hard drive without notifying you. If you happen to disconnect from the Internet while updates are downloading, the next time you connect to the Internet, QuickBooks will pick up where it left off.
Manual Updates
If you turn off automatic updates, you should periodically check for new software files manually. Click the Update Now button in the Update QuickBooks window to select and download updated files.
C H APT ER
24
MANAGING
YOUR
QUICKBOOKS
F ILES
527
Click the checkboxes next to each specific type of update to select/deselect those types of files. Then, click Get Updates to tell QuickBooks to check the Internet immediately and download any files. Most of the time, QuickBooks automatically integrates the downloaded files, but sometimes an information box will appear to tell you that QuickBooks will integrate the files the next time you open QuickBooks.
Part Five
Appendices
Appendix A Appendix A
he values of fixed assets decline over time, and calculating the decline is a thorny undertaking. The calculations for depreciation or amortization are extremely complicated, mostly due to the vast number of IRS regulations on the subject. To make it worse, the regulations change frequently, so keeping up with current rules is a complicated task.
529
530
PART FIVE
A PPEN D ICES
In addition to making sure your depreciation calculations dont cause a problem with the IRS, the amounts involved in depreciation transactions have a direct effect on your business.
The amount by which an asset is depreciated affects the worth of a business
because the net (reduced) current value is used on the balance sheet.
The depreciation amount affects the business tax bill (depreciation is
deductible). The QuickBooks Fixed Asset Manager makes it easier to track and depreciate assets, and enter the resulting calculations in both the tax return and the QuickBooks company file.
APPENDIX
F IXED
ASSET
MANAGE R
531
company, transfer prior-year clients from QuickBooks Fixed Asset Manager or ProSeries Fixed Asset Manager to the current year, reconnect the Accountants Copy with Fixed Asset Manager, or restore a previous QuickBooks Fixed Asset Manager file from a backup.
532
PART FIVE
A PPEN D ICES
When you choose to create a new client, the Fixed Asset Manager New Client Wizard launches, and you click Next to move through each wizard window. The first wizard windows display the company information for the client, and you cannot edit that information (see the previous sections on making sure the company information is correct before running Fixed Asset Manager). The wizard then asks you to respond to queries about the following data:
Current fiscal year Prior short years Qualification for the small corporation exemption from AMT Depreciation bases Default depreciation method for each selected basis Default methods for synchronizing data between QuickBooks and the Fixed Asset Manager
The wizard offers the chance to import the fixed assets for this company automatically, using the information in the Fixed Asset Item list in the company file. You can also enter the fixed assets manually. A client summary is displayed in the last wizard window. Click Finish to end the client setup and begin using Fixed Asset Manager. (If you automatically synchronized the fixed assets from the client company Fixed Asset Item list, a log appears to report the fixed assets that were imported.) When you opt to transfer information from client files for the prior-year version of QuickBooks Fixed Asset Manager, or from ProSeries Fixed Asset Manager, into this years version, the Transfer Client Wizard launches. Click Next to move through each wizard window. Select the client you want to transfer on the first wizard window that appears. The wizard then asks you to respond to the queries about the following data:
Calculation options Qualification for the small corporation exemption from AMT QuickBooks Asset Synchronization
When a client summary appears on the last wizard window, click Finish to complete the transfer and begin using Fixed Asset Manager.
APPENDIX
F IXED
ASSET
MANAGE R
533
If the other program cant save to a file in CSV format, but can save data in a file format that is readable by Microsoft Excel, open the file in Excel, and then save the file in CSV format. If youve been managing fixed assets in ProSeries tax software, you can import data directly from that software to Fixed Asset Manager.
534
PART FIVE
A PPEN D ICES
T I P : You can change information in the Asset tab to alter the projections available in the Projection tab. N O T E : The other tabs on the Fixed Asset Manager window are informational.
The Notes tab is a blank window where you can write notes and reminders. The Calendar tab displays information about an asset on the selected date (select date acquired, date of disposal, or both).
APPENDIX
F IXED
ASSET
MANAGE R
535
Calculating Depreciation
When the selected asset is properly configured, go to the Asset tab and choose Asset | Calculate Asset. If the command is grayed out, Fixed Asset Manager does not have all the information it needs to perform the calculation. Check all the fields to make sure youve entered the required information about this asset. You can set Fixed Asset Manager to automatically calculate assets after making modifications using the Program Options window. To select this setting, choose Tools | Program Options. Select the Automatically Calculate Assets option, and click OK to save the change.
Producing Repor ts
Fixed Asset Manager provides a variety of report options, including preconfigured report templates. You can sort and select the information you want to print, and the order in which you print it. Table A-1 describes the purpose of each predefined report.
536
PART FIVE
A PPEN D ICES
To determine the total ACE adjustment needed to compute a tax return for a corporation. Assets are grouped by category and sorted by asset number within each group. To see a summary of the activity of the amortized assets. Assets are grouped by general ledger account number and sorted by asset number within each group. To see a summary of the activity of the amortized assets, grouped by one user-defined classification. (Each user-defined field you use has a report.) Assets are grouped by the user-defined field and sorted by asset number within each group. To print the necessary information for AMT depreciation adjustment reporting (Federal depreciation AMT depreciation = AMT adjustment). Assets are grouped by category and sorted by asset number within each group. To see a summary of disposition information according to the sale description assigned to each asset. Assets are grouped by asset sale description and sorted by asset number within each group. To print the asset details for each asset in the Asset and Disposal tabs you see onscreen. To see a summary of each asset purchased in the current year. Assets are grouped by general ledger account number and sorted by acquisition date within each group. To see an activity summary for each asset, grouped by general ledger account number. Assets are sorted by acquisition date within each group. To see an activity summary for each asset, grouped by one userdefined category. (Each user-defined field you use has a report.) Assets are sorted by asset number within each group. To see an activity summary for each asset, grouped by category, in a traditional lead schedule format. Assets are sorted by asset number within each group. To see an activity summary for each asset, grouped by general ledger account number, in a traditional lead schedule format. Assets are sorted by asset number within each group. To see an activity summary for each asset, grouped by location, in a traditional lead schedule format. Assets are sorted by asset number within each group.
Asset Disposition by Asset Sale Description Asset, Basis, and Disposal Detail Report Assets Acquired in the Current Year Depreciation Schedule by G/L Account Number Depreciation Schedule by User Defined (1 to 5) Lead Schedule by Category
TABLE A-1
APPENDIX
F IXED
ASSET
MANAGE R
537
Lead Schedule by Tax Form and Property Description Monthly G/L Accumulated Account Summary
To see an activity summary for each asset, grouped by tax form and property description, in a traditional lead schedule format. Assets are sorted by asset number within each group. To see the total monthly cost additions and deletions and their beginning and ending balances. This report is grouped by General Ledger Asset Account. Assets without assigned account numbers are grouped by No Account Number. To see the total monthly accumulated depreciation/amortization additions, and deletions and their beginning and ending balances. This report is grouped by General Ledger Accumulated Depreciation and Amortization account. Assets without assigned account numbers are grouped by No Account Number. To see the total monthly depreciation/amortization expense additions and deletions, and beginning and ending accumulated depreciation and amortization balances. This report is grouped by General Ledger Depreciation and Amortization Expense account. Assets without assigned account numbers are grouped by No Account Number. To see a summary of depreciation amounts for assets that you marked as personal property. Assets are grouped by the year each asset was placed in service, and sorted by acquisition date within each group. To see a five-year projection for each asset. Assets are grouped by category, and sorted by asset number within each group. To identify assets that were not fully depreciated. Assets within this report are grouped and subtotaled by category.
TABLE A-1
You can select the reports you want to associate with your client using the Report List Organizer and create a custom report list. Having a custom report list allows you to batch print reports. To organize a report list, choose Reports | Report List Organizer.
538
PART FIVE
A PPEN D ICES
Tax Worksheets
Fixed Asset Manager provides the following tax worksheets that can help you complete the depreciation-related portions of your clients returns:
Form 4562 Part ISection 179 Summary Copy Form 4562 Part II & IIILines 15, 16, and 17 Form 4562 Part IIILines 19 and 20 Form 4562 Part IVSummary Form 4562 Part VListed Property Form 4562 Part VIAmortization Form 4797 Part IProperty Held More than One Year Form 4797 Part IIOrdinary Gains and Losses Form 4797 Part IIIGains from Disposition of Depreciable Property Form 4626Depreciation Adjustments and Tax Preferences Form 4626ACE Worksheet Form 4626Gain/Loss Adjustments
Fixed Asset Manager completes each worksheet automatically using the information in the clients file.
Appendix B Appendix B
he Financial Statement Designer (FSD) gives you the power to customize financial statements that are directly linked to a clients QuickBooks data. You dont have to export the data to other programs to create a customized statement. Instead, you can produce exactly what you want immediately. QuickBooks includes FSD with the Premier Accountant Edition and in all editions of QuickBooks Enterprise Solutions.
539
540
PART FIVE
A PPEN D ICES
balances, show percentages and variances between other columns, subtotals, and more. You can use your customized statement for any client. You can use the Supporting Document Editor to prepare your title pages, notes to financial statements, and compilation letters. You can format the statement any way you want using familiar spreadsheet-like tools. You can save your financial statements and supporting documents for each client to separate file locations. You can insert rows for subtotals, to group accounts in any way that you want, or even add blank rows for spacing. You can update your clients statement for the following period in seconds. You can print a complete set of financial statements and supporting documents by choosing which items you want to print, in the order you want. You can save reports as PDF files. You can export to Excel.
N O T E : With the Financial Statement Designer you can create a standard set
of financial statements that are in accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP).
APPENDIX
FINANCIAL
STATEMENT
DESIGNE R
541
FSD Components
The power of FSD comes from its three main components:
The Financial Statement Organizer The Financial Statement Editor The Supporting Document Editor
Using these three components, you can create professional financial statements including supporting schedules, title pages, and compilation letters.
Viewing the list of financial statements and supporting documents and templates. Creating a new set of financial statements and supporting documents. Editing saved financial statements and supporting documents. Creating folders to organize your statements and documents. Printing financial statements and supporting documents in any order you prefer. Saving statements and supporting documents as PDF files. Selecting a period for which a statement needs to be generated. Setting the statement basis. Select a template for the new financial statement (see the section, FSD Templates, later in this appendix).
To change the location where you save financial statements and supporting documents for the current QuickBooks client, choose Tools | Select File Locations, and select a new location. The new location of the financial statements and documents appears in the Details column in the Saved Financial Statements and Supporting Documents section. You can choose a discrete location for each client file.
FSD Templates
FSD comes with a large selection of customizable financial statement templates. Choose from a wide variety of balance sheets, income statements, statements of cash flows, statements of retained earnings, and financial ratio calculations. While you can easily create a financial statement from scratch, its quicker to use one of the financial statement templates as your starting point. You can easily make changes to the template to customize it for your clients needs or your own preferences. Give your altered template a new name so you can use it in the future.
542
PART FIVE
A PPEN D ICES
Editor Toolbars
The Financial Statement Editor includes three toolbars. If youve been using Windows software, youll be comfortable with their functions instantly because they provide standard Windows toolbar functions. The standard toolbar provides the normal file operation functions, such as New, Open, Cut, Copy, Paste, Save, Print, Print Preview, Undo, and Redo. In addition to these familiar icons, the Standard toolbar offers a Refresh icon (to refresh the data in your financial statement). The Format toolbar is similar to the Formatting toolbar in a Windows spreadsheet application such as Excel. Use the icons to apply fonts, font color, indentations, alignments, cell underlines, formats (for decimals, percentage, and currency), and AutoSum functions. Just like the familiar formula bar you use in spreadsheet software, the Financial Statement Editors Formula bar identifies the current location of the cursor and provides a text box for entering formulas into cells.
T I P : You can display or hide the toolbars by choosing View | Toolbars and selecting or deselecting the appropriate toolbar.
APPENDIX
FINANCIAL
STATEMENT
DESIGNE R
543
Use the Column Properties to set the date range for account balances. For example, you can configure one column for the prior-period balances and the next column for the current-period balances. Depending on the area selected in the Design Grid, you can use the Row Properties to repeat column headers on every page, change the account description that appears on the financial statement, quickly add and remove accounts for a combined account row, reverse the sign of an account balance, and print the account row on the printed financial statement even if the account balance is zero. The Cell Properties let you override the columns date range. (Changing the properties using the Cell Properties section only affects the selected cell.) The Statement Properties allow you to set the column spacing.
must insert both fields to print both on the report. Statement Date Prints the statement ending date. Statement Basis Prints the statement basis (cash or accrual). Client Information Prints the selected field from the Client Information window. Includes such fields as company name, e-mail address, the URL for the companys web site, and so on. Accountant Information Prints the selected field from the Accountant Information window. Includes such fields as firm name, e-mail address, the URL for the accounting firms web site, and so on.
544
PART FIVE
A PPEN D ICES
To access the Supporting Document Editor, double-click a document from the Financial Statement Organizer window, or select a document, and choose File | Open Selected.
If you select the option to use whole numbers, you can select the account to which rounding errors are posted from the drop-down list on the Print dialog. You can also suppress the printing of accounts with a zero balance.
N O T E : The settings on the Options tab of the Print window can also be
accessed in the Options window of the Financial Statement Editor (choose Tools | Options).
APPENDIX
FINANCIAL
STATEMENT
DESIGNE R
545
Index
Click on a page number to go to a terms location.
Numbers & Symbols 32-bit environments, requirements for, 7 40% Test tab in Fixed Asset Manager, using, 534535 64-bit environments, requirements for, 7 940 report, preparing, 238 940 tax liability, paying, 227 941 form, preparing, 237238 941 tax liability, scheduling for paying, 228 1096 forms, printing names on, 390 1099 balances, verifying for vendors, 388390 1099 forms issuing, 386 previewing, 390 printing, 390391 setting preferences for, 480 setting up, 387388 1099 Options, troubleshooting with, 389 1099 Summary report, displaying, 389 1099 vendor information, checking, 386387 : (colon), appearance in account names, 23 A access permissions, setting in Premier Edition, 489490 account names, printing on vouchers, 466 Account No. field in Payment Info tab, using, 35 account numbers adding for vendors, 41 considering for subaccounts, 23 using, 1821, 465 Account Prefill tab, using with vendors, 4142 account registers. See registers account type, selecting, 26 accountant, sending reports to, 391 Accountants Copy and accountant, 515, 517519 creating, 513514 delivering, 515 description of, 512 naming, 517 opening, 517 removing restrictions related to, 521 reviewing, 519
547
548
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
Accountants Copy (cont.) reviewing accountants changes in, 519521 using password with, 513 working during, 515 accounting preferences, setting, 464465 accounting programs, converting data from, 1718 accounts. See also bank accounts; nonposting accounts; subaccounts adding, 2527 adjusting for NSF (nonsufficient funds) checks, 267268 alphabetizing, 21 assigning to assembly items, 253 creating, 28 displaying, 27 editing, 27 including for payroll, 199 keyboard shortcut for, 25 maximum of, 27 merging, 29 naming, 2122 reactivating, 27 requiring, 465 saving, 27 selecting for deposits, 264 setting defaults for checks, 467 showing reports by, 476 sorting of, 22 splitting expenses among, 146147 transferring funds between, 265 viewing examples of, 26 Accounts Payable register, viewing, 156 Accounts Receivable Graph Report, description of, 130 accrual basis, printing reports for, 329
ACE Adjustment Calculation report, using, 536 Acrobat Reader, downloading, 9697, 545 activities exporting with Timer, 453455 tracking, 428430 tracking with stopwatch, 430 activity templates, setting up for Timer, 451452. See also templates Add New Account: Choose Account Type window, displaying, 25 Add New Account window, displaying, 26, 28 Add New Payroll Item Wizard, using, 201202 <Add New> entries, explanation of, 33 Add Related Units screen, displaying, 246 Add Your Excel Data to QuickBooks window, displaying, 15, 17 Additional Info tab for customers, 32 fields in, 3335 for vendors, 41 Adjust Quantity/Value On Hand window, using with inventory, 258 adjusting entries, making for reconciliations, 292 administrative tasks, using to track time, 427 administrator, setting up for Premier Edition, 487488 administrator passwords, assigning in Enterprise Edition, 495 Adobe Acrobat Reader, downloading, 9697, 545 aging reports producing, 128 setting preferences for, 475
INDE X
549
aliases, using to match downloaded transactions, 375376 Align button, using with forms, 89 Amortization Schedule reports in Fixed Asset Manager, using, 536 AMT Adjustment Calculation report, using, 536 applications, availability in Solution Marketplace, 8 A/R aging reports, descriptions of, 129 Area Access Level options, selecting for roles, 494495 assemblies, building, 253 assembly items. See also inventory items assigning accounts to, 253 as bills of goods, 253 costs of, 252 creating, 251253 disassembling, 255 pending builds of, 253255 printing components of, 255256 Asset Disposition by Asset Sale Description report, using, 536 asset purchases, posting to subaccounts, 318 Asset reports in Fixed Asset Manager, using, 536 Asset tab in Fixed Asset Manager, options on, 534 assets determining depreciation methods for, 534 disposing of, 534 Assign Check Numbers dialog box, displaying, 171 ATM withdrawals, recording, 117, 271 Attorneys Invoice template, using, 62
audit trail, creating for missing check numbers, 177 Audit Trail report, description of, 347348 automatic backups, types of, 506509. See also backups Automatic Updates feature, using, 525, 527 Available Sales Orders dialog box, displaying, 65 Average Costing inventory method, use of, 249 B backorders, checking on, 8384. See also sales orders backup files, identifying, 502 backup options, setting, 504 backups. See also automatic backups choosing location for, 504506 creating at years end, 396397 creating for current company, 503 restoring, 509510 Balance Sheet Budget Overview printing, 305 producing, 305 Balance Sheet reports generating, 338340 including fixed assets on, 318319 running at years end, 385 sending to accountants, 391 Balance Sheets contents of, 338 formula for, 339 balances configuring appearance on financial statements, 544 reconciling, 286287
550
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
bank account register displaying checks in, 172 opening, 282, 314 using for direct disbursement manual checks, 178179 bank accounts. See also accounts creating for Cash Register, 117 enabling for Direct Connect online banking, 368 enabling for Web Connect online banking, 368369 entering opening balances for, 313314 making deposits to, 105, 113114, 121 reconciling, 279 bank balances, adjusting for NSF (nonsufficient funds) checks, 267268 bank deposits. See also deposits choosing payments for, 120122 segregating by Payment Method, 121122 selecting items for, 121 banks connecting to, 369372 finding online, 364366 Basic Customization dialog box, displaying, 359360 batch printing, 9192 beep preferences, setting for transactions, 461 Begin Reconciliation window opening for bank accounts, 279 opening for credit card bills, 275276 undoing reconciliations from, 291292 beginning balances. See opening balances
benefits, configuring contribution rates for, 212 bill history, printing, 171 Bill Pay service, using, 366367. See also online banking Billing Rate Levels list, availability of, 5657 Billing Solutions, using, 380381 bills. See also recurring bills; unpaid bills applying discounts to, 168 associating checks with, 178 converting item receipts to, 155 entering for vendors, 144 entering transactions for, 315 entering transfers into, 466 memorizing, 158160 partial payment of, 167168 paying, 466 paying in full, 166167 paying online, 172, 378380 recording for received items, 153154 selecting for payment, 165166, 171 splitting among general ledger accounts, 147 bills and items, receiving simultaneously, 155156 Bills category, setting preferences for, 466 bills from vendors, filling out for vendors, 145146 books, closing, 394396 bounced checks. See NSF (nonsufficient funds) checks Browse button, using, 17 budget amounts, entering, 297298 budget overviews Balance Sheet Budget Overview, 305 Class Budget Overview, 305
INDE X
551
Customer:Job Budget Overview, 305 Profit & Loss, 304305 budget reports, availability of, 303 Budget vs. Actual Graph reports, producing, 307 Budget vs. Actual reports, creating, 306 Budget window, buttons in, 295296 budgets class budgets, 303 compounding changes in, 300301 copying numbers across months of, 299 creating, 296297 creating from last years data, 299301 Customer:Job budgets, 301303 deleting, 294 exporting, 307 increasing and decreasing monthly figures for, 300 preparing, 296 Profit & Loss budgets, 296297 types of, 294 Build Assemblies window, displaying, 253254 business, analyzing, 308 business expenses, spending cash for, 124 business forms, downloading, 64 Business Planner, availability of, 308 C C corporations entering payroll items for, 202 filing form 1120 for, 394 using Officer Compensation item for, 212 cash. See also funds getting back from deposits, 123124 tracking, 270272
transferring between online accounts, 377378 transferring to payroll accounts, 321 cash basis printing reports for, 329 running reports on, 316 cash drawers depositing cash collected in, 117118 handling overages and shortages for, 124 Cash Flow Forecast report, generating, 345346 Cash Flow reports configuring, 476 Statement of Cash Flows report, 343345 cash register, creating bank account for, 117 cash sales definition of, 114 handling batches of, 117 putting into petty cash, 271 recording, 115117 change orders, saving modifications to estimates as, 97 chart of accounts creating companies without, 13 editing, 392 keyboard shortcut for, 25 setting up for payroll, 199200 Chart Of Accounts window displaying for credit card accounts, 273 displaying for petty cash account, 271 displaying in hierarchical view, 29 check dates, changing when printing, 466
552
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
check numbers. See also missing check numbers creating audit trail for, 177 discrepancies in, 375 displaying, 172 warning about duplicates of, 467 check register, accessing, 178 check styles, choosing, 175 checking preferences, setting, 466467 checks. See also manual checks; NSF (nonsufficient funds) checks adding logos to, 175 applying as payments, 104105 assigning to expense accounts, 179 associating with bills, 178 changing fonts for, 175 deleting versus voiding, 270 displaying in bank account register, 172 entering on transaction line, 179 handling partial check pages on printers, 175176 including payee field on, 466 listing, 172 printing, 176178 printing quickly, 181 purchasing computer checks, 173174 reconciling missing numbers for, 278 recording for missing transactions, 314 using Print Batch option with, 182 writing for credit card bills, 276 Choose Billable Time and Costs window displaying, 405 removing reimbursable expenses from, 408
Class Budget Overview, selecting report layout for, 305 class budgets, creating, budgets, 303 Class list, setting up, 49 Class List window, displaying, 481 Class Tracking setting preferences for, 480483 using, 465 classes assigning to invoices, 482483 creating, 481 editing, deleting, and merging, 482 features of, 481 reporting by, 482483 using for payroll job costing, 439440 using in transactions, 482 Cleanup utility, running, 523524 client files, setting up for Fixed Asset Manager, 531532 Client Totals Summary in Fixed Asset Manager, using, 535 closing books, 394396 Closing Date Exception report, printing, 396 closing date, setting preferences for, 465 Coach, features of, 34, 469 Coarse button, using with dot matrix printers, 89 codes, assigning to customers, 187 COGS (Cost Of Goods Sold), listing totals of, 342 Collapse button, using with subaccounts, 304 collection reports, displaying, 133134 Collections Report, description of, 130 colon (:), appearance in account names, 23
INDE X
553
Color Scheme section, using with desktop views, 469 columns changing in templates, 356357 rearranging on reports, 328 removing from reports, 328 Combine Reports feature, availability of, 348349 Comma Separated Value (CSV) format, importing data from, 532533 companies backing up, 503 creating, 1214 setting up as customers, 440441 company files. See also portable company files cleaning up data in, 521524 compressing, 510 extensions for, 509 removing restrictions from, 521 storing, 14 Company Preferences tab, using, 461, 463464 compensation information, entering for employees, 205208 computer checks, purchasing, purchasing, 173174 connections, setting up for online banking, 363364 consolidated company reports, creating, 348349 continuous-feed printers, using, 8990 Conversion Tool, downloading, 18 Convert utility, using, 1718 Copy Across option, using with budgets, 299 cost information, running payroll reports for, 443444
Cost Of Goods Sold (COGS), listing totals of, 342 CPU architecture, impact of, 8 Create Your Company File screen, displaying, 14 Create Invoices window, opening, 62, 81, 269 Create New Budget window, displaying, 296297 Create Statements window, displaying, 136137 credit card accounts creating, 273274 entering opening balances for, 313314 credit card bills paying, 276 reconciling, 275276 Credit Card No. field in Payment Info tab, using, 3637 credit card payments, receiving for invoices, 119 credit card sales, considering as cash sales, 119 credit card transactions, daily recording of, 120 credit cards entering charges for, 274275 setting up acceptance of, 118 treating as liability accounts, 273276 treating as vendors, 272273 Credit Limit field in Payment Info tab, using, 35 credit memos e-mailing, 9394 versus invoices, 85 printing, 9192
554
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
credits. See also general ledger entries applying, 170171 applying to invoices, 8788, 109110 applying to jobs, 111 issuing refunds for, 8687 recording for vendors, 157158 retaining, 86 CSV (Comma Separated Value) format, importing data from, 532533 CTRL key. See keyboard shortcuts Current Availability window, displaying, 99 custom fields for items, 5455 for names, 53 Custom Invoice template, using, 62 Custom S.O. Invoice template, using, 63 Customer & Jobs list, filling Customer Center window with, 62 Customer Balance Detail Report, description of, 130 Customer Balance Summary Report, description of, 130 Customer Center customizing, 62 listing customers and jobs in, 30 opening, 60 resizing panes in, 62 tabs in, 61 Customer Contact List Report, description of, 130 Customer Credit Card Protection, enabling, 37 customer invoices. See invoices customer jobs. See jobs customer lists, creating, 31 Customer Message list, setting up, 51
Customer Name field, creating standard for, 32 customer payments. See payments Customer Phone List Report, description of, 130 customer records, editing, 3738 customer register, recording statement charges in, 135136. See also registers customer statements. See statements customer type choosing customers by, 138 creating for cash sales, 115 Customer Type list, setting up, 50 Customer:Job Budget Overview, printing, 305 Customer:Job budgets, creating, 301303 customers assigning codes and items to, 187 assigning sales representatives to, 3536 billing for mileage, 422 creating estimates for, 74 creating Profit & Loss budgets for, 301303 displaying transactions for, 61 entering opening balances for, 315 linking mileage to, 418420 listing prior to invoicing, 64 maintaining shipping addresses for, 32 selecting for statements, 137138 sending e-mail to, 93 setting up, 3031 setting up companies as, 440441 sorting by type, 33 storing notes about, 3738 Customers & Jobs list, displaying in hierarchical view with, 24
INDE X
555
Customize Icon Bar dialog box adding icons with, 486 opening, 484 customized reports, memorizing, 333337. See also reports D daily cash sales, handling batches of, 117 data advisory about e-mailing of, 510 backing up, 506 cleaning up in company files, 521524 entering for items, 4346 importing from other software, 532533 data files consolidating, 348349 restoring, 509510 data lists, exporting to Timer users, 448449 date for new transactions, setting preferences for, 463 date ranges selecting for payroll liabilities, 231 selecting for reports, 330 selecting for statements, 136137 date-driven terms, using, 51 dates changing for invoices, 65 importance to transactions, 289 setting warning preferences for, 465 debits. See general ledger entries decimal point, setting preferences for, 462 deductions, entering as payroll items, 202 Define Fields dialog box, opening, 5354 deleted transactions, correcting, 289 deleting versus voiding checks, 270
deposit slips filling out, 122124 printing, 125 deposits. See also bank deposits; direct deposits adding items to, 124 getting cash back from, 123124 making, 105, 113114 recording for missing transactions, 314 recording in registers, 264 selecting accounts for, 264 depreciation, calculating in Fixed Asset Manager, 535 depreciation data, exporting in Fixed Asset Manager, 537538 depreciation entries, making, 318319 depreciation method, determining for assets, 534 Depreciation reports in Fixed Asset Manager, using, 536 Desktop View preferences, setting, 467469 Dial-up Connections, selecting for online banking, 363 Direct Connect online banking enabling bank accounts for, 368 exchanging data with, 371 explanation of, 362 direct deposits. See also deposits entering for employees, 208 sending information for, 221 direct disbursement checks, printing, 181182 direct disbursements general ledger entries for, 182 making, 178 writing manual checks for, 178181
556
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
disbursements recording for petty cash, 271272 voiding, 270 discount accounts, using, 169170 Discount And Credits dialog box, displaying, 110 Discount item type, description of, 44 discounts applying, 168169 applying for timely payments, 111113 entering on invoices, 68 taking after discount date, 169 discrepancies, searching manually, 289290 Discrepancy Report, purpose of, 288289 disk space, requirements for, 7 Display tab, using with reports, 329 Disposal tab in Fixed Asset Manager, options on, 534 Divide by 1000 option, using with balances on financial statements, 544 dividing date restrictions related to, 515517 supplying in Accountants Copy, 513514 dot matrix printers, aligning, 8990 double-entry bookkeeping program, QuickBooks as, 72 downloaded transactions. See also transactions absence from register, 375 discrepancies in, 375 without account numbers, 375 drop-down lists, setting preferences for, 461 duplicate check numbers, warning about, 467
E earned discounts, explanation of, 169 earnings details, copying from previous paychecks, 472 Earnings items, assigning to company officers, 212 EasyStep interview starting, 12 using with tax line information, 393 Edit Account dialog box, opening, 27, 29 Edit Customer dialog box, options in, 37 Edit Employee window, displaying, 426, 439 Edit Role window in Enterprise Edition, displaying, 494 Edit Vendor dialog box, Notes button in, 43 E-File & Pay feature, availability of, 226 electronic payments, receiving, 379 e-mail changing default message in, 96 deselecting, 96 editing message text of, 96 sending in batches, 96 sending invoices by, 9495 sending to customers, 93 e-mail attachments, sending invoices and credit memos as, 9394 E-mailing data, advisory about, 510 e-mailing financial statements, 545 Employee Center customizing, 198 Employees tab in, 196 opening, 196 Transactions tab in, 197 Employee Defaults dialog box, displaying, 203
INDE X
557
Employee list displaying columns in, 198 filling up Employee Center with, 197 setting preferences for display of, 472 Employee Organizer, using with Enterprise Solutions, 223 employee records displaying, 213 modifying, 438439 employee time. See also time linking to payroll or job costing, 438 tracking, 425 employees editing information about, 425426 entering missing information for, 213 entering payroll and compensation information for, 205208 entering personal information about, 205 entering sick and vacation pay information for, 208 entering tax information for, 207208 paying, 440441 reimbursing for mileage, 420422 reviewing for payment, 217218 setting up direct deposits for, 208 setting up in Payroll Setup Wizard, 213 types of, 209 employer payments, recording as journal entries, 321322 employment questions, getting help with, 224 Employment tab, options on, 208209 Enable Compounding option, using with budgets, 300301
ending balances, reconciling with cleared balances, 286287 Enter Bills option, using with vendors, 144 Enter Bills window displaying, 156 recording vendor credits in, 157158 Enter Credit Card Charges window, opening, 274 Enter Payroll Information window, displaying, 217 Enter Sales Receipts window modifying appearance of, 116 opening, 115 Enterprise Edition assigning administrator passwords in, 495 creating roles in, 494495 creating users in, 496 managing multiple users in, 492494 maximum names in, 56 Multiuser Mode actions in, 498 reporting on permissions in, 497 Single User Mode actions in, 498 Enterprise Solutions Client, system requirements for, 7 Enterprise Solutions, Employee Organizer in, 223 Enterprise Solutions Server, system requirements for, 7 Enterprise-specific solutions, resource for, 9 envelopes, using for mailing invoices, 358 equity accounts, creating, 312 estimates creating, 7475 creating boilerplate for, 78 creating invoices from, 7577
558
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
estimates (cont.) duplicating, 7475 and reporting, 78 versus sales orders, 79 saving modifications to, 97 setting preferences for, 73, 471 using, 73 Excel exporting budgets to, 307 exporting reports to, 338 Excel data, using to set up lists, 1517 expense accounts assigning checks to, 179 example of, 26 using for payroll entries, 199 expense tracking, setting preferences for, 480 expenses. See also reimbursable expenses breaking down, 317 splitting among accounts, 146147 Export Report dialog box, displaying, 307 Export Timer Activities window, displaying, 455 Export window, using with Timer lists, 448 exporting memorized reports, 335337 reports, 337338 F F2 key, displaying accounts with, 27 Federal 940, setting up payment schedule for, 227 Federal 941 tax liability, scheduling tax payments for, 228 federal deposits, creating liability payments for, 228 Federal Form 940 (FUTA) report, filing, 238
federal forms, availability of, 223 federal taxes, setting up, 214. See also tax forms field navigation, setting preferences for, 461 fields adding to templates, 356 customizing, 5355 Figures. See also Tables 1099 and 1096 Wizard, 386 1099 preferences, 388 accounting programs, 18 accounting-related options, 464 Add New Account window, 28 Add Your Excel Data to QuickBooks window, 17 aging reports, 128129 assembly items, 252 Audit Trail report, 348 backorders report, 84 balance sheet, 319 Balance Sheet standard report, 340 bank account register, 179 bank deposit transactions, 121 bill for reimbursable expenses, 404 Bill Pay service, 367 bills from vendors, 145 bills selected for payment, 165 Build Assemblies window, 254 Cash Flow Forecast report, 346 chart of accounts, 14 Chart of Accounts window in two views, 24 check assigned to multiple accounts, 180 checking account register, 173 checking preferences, 467
INDE X
559
Choose Billable Time and Costs window, 405 class assigned to invoice, 483 Classify Cash window, 345 Clean Up Company Data window, 523524 Closing Date Exception report, 397 Coach, 5 company information screen, 13 Create Estimates window, 75 Create Sales Orders window, 80 credit card bills posted to multiple accounts, 273 credit card transactions, 274 credit memo, 86 credits applied to bills, 170 credits for customer, 109 Current Availability window, 99 custom fields, 54 Customer & Jobs tab, 60 customer information, 31, 34 customer register, 136 customers and jobs, 30 deduction payroll items, 203 depreciation journal entry, 320 Desktop View preferences, 468 discount for early payment, 112 dividing date in Accountants Copy, 514 Edit Employee window, 426, 439 Employee Defaults dialog box, 204 Employees tab in Employee Center, 196 Enter Payroll Information window, 441 Enter Sales Receipts window, 115 estimates and progress invoicing, 471
Export dialog box, 337 Export file for Timer users, 448 Export Report dialog box, 307 Export Timer Activities, 455 filtering report data, 331 finance charge assessment, 133 Finance Charge options, 131 Financial Institutions Directory, 365 Fonts & Numbers tab for reports, 332 graph preferences, 474 Header/Footer tab for reports, 332 Help feature, 6 hourly employees, 218 Income Tax Preparation report, 393 Internet Connection Setup Wizard, 363 Inventory and Purchase order features, 147 inventory and purchase order preferences, 470 inventory count and value, 259 inventory items, 247248 Inventory Part item, 45 inventory preferences, 243 inventory worksheet, 257 invoice created from sales order, 82 invoice items, 82 invoice with credit applied, 87 invoice with discount, 69 invoice with reimbursable expense, 407 invoices created from estimates, 77 item receipt for bill, 154 items received against purchase orders, 153 items received without bills, 152 job information, 39
560
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
Figures. See also Tables (cont.) job status labels, 3940 journal entry, 310 Layout Designer window, 358 liability checks for taxes, 230 Make Deposits windows, 123 Make General Journal Entries window, 320 Manage Templates dialog box, 360 markup on invoice, 409 Match Transactions window, 373 Memorized Report list, 334 Mileage By Detail report filtered, 421 Mileage By Job Summary report, 419 Mileage By Vehicle Detail report, 418 Mileage By Vehicle Summary report, 417 Mileage Rates window, 415 mileage tracking for vehicles, 416 Missing Checks, 283 net worth graph, 341 New Activity window in Timer, 451 New Employee dialog box, 205 New Item dialog box, 186, 188 New Price Level dialog box, 4748 New User dialog box in Enterprise Edition, 496 New Vendor dialog box, 42 NSF check redeposit attempt, 269 number format for accounts, 19 Online Backup subscription service, 503 Online Banking Center, 370, 372 online banking services, 366 partial bill payment, 167 Partial Page window for checks, 176 Pay Bills window, 165 paycheck changes, 222
Payment Info tab, 36 Payment Summary for tax liability checks, 230 payments applied to invoices, 106 pay-related information for employees, 207 payroll costs in job costing, 440 Payroll Item List window, 202 payroll liabilities for taxes, 229 payroll schedule, 200 Payroll Setup Wizard, 212, 215 Payroll tab in Employee Center, 198 Payroll Transaction Detail report, 444 Permissions Access by Users report, 497 preferences for estimates, 74 Preview Paycheck window, 442 price level assigned to item, 67 Print Labels dialog box, 91 Printer setup dialog box, 89 Printer Setup window for checks, 174 Profit & Loss Budget Overview, 304 Profit & Loss reports, 342 Profit & Loss standard report, 343 purchase order, 152 purchase order resembles vendor bill, 149 QuickBooks Coach window, 4 Receive Payments window, 105 Reconcile window with uncleared transactions, 280 reconciliation Detail report, 285 Reconciliation Summary report, 286 refund issued, 87 reimbursable expenses, 411 Report Center, 327 report defaults, 476
INDE X
561
report onscreen, 328 report preferences, 474 reports Display tab, 330 reports printed from report group, 336 Review And Create Paychecks window, 219 Sales & Customers preferences, 477 Sales Order Fulfillment Worksheet, 100 sales orders, 79 Sales Tax Liability report, 189 Sales Tax Revenue Summary report, 190 Save Copy on Backup screen, 507 Schedule Backup window, 508 Send Accountants Copy screen, 513 solutions for QuickBooks Enterprise, 10 Solutions Marketplace, 9 statement, 137 Statement of Cash Flows report, 344 statement preview, 139 tax information for employees, 208 template customization, 354, 357 Time Activity Log, 454 Time by Job Detail report, 433 Time Tracing, 424 Time/Enter Single Activity window, 428 Timer Import Detail report, 456 timesheet preview, 435 timesheets printed, 434 timing activities, 452 transaction removal, 524 transactions added to register, 374 Transactions tab, 61
Transactions tab in Employee Center, 197 Transactions tab in Vendor Center, 144 Transfer Funds Between Accounts dialog box, 265 trial balance report, 339 underpayments, 108 units of measure, 245 unpaid bills, 164 Update QuickBooks service, 525527 Vendor 1099 Review report, 387 vendor credit in Enter Bills window, 157 vendor information, 41 Web Connect account, 369 Weekly Timesheet window, 431 workbook for importing Excel information, 16 workers compensation codes, 235 Write Checks window, 180 Write Checks window for NSF checks, 268 files backing up, 503506 encrypting for Accountants Copy, 513 making automatic backups of, 506509 unlocking without receiving Accountants Copy, 521 Filters tab, using with reports, 165, 330331 finance charge invoices, printing, 134 Finance Charge preferences, setting, 469 Finance Charge template, using, 64 finance charges assessing, 132133 including on statements, 139 setting up preferences for, 130132
562
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
financial documents, previewing and printing, 544 financial institutions, finding online, 364366 financial reports purpose of, 338 running at years end, 385 Financial Statement Designer (FSD) components of, 541 features of, 540 opening, 540 Financial Statement Editor accessing, 542 Design Grid in, 543 Properties panel in, 542543 toolbars in, 542 Financial Statement Organizer, using, 541 financial statements changing locations of, 541 configuring appearance of balances on, 544 e-mailing, 545 exporting, 544 previewing and printing, 544 saving as PDF files, 545 financing activities, including in Statement of Cash Flows report, 344 fiscal condition, analyzing, 308 Fixed Asset Item list availability of, 531 setting up, 4647 Fixed Asset Manager Asset tab in, 534 availability of, 319 calculating depreciation in, 535 Client Totals Summary in, 535 Disposal tab in, 534
exporting depreciation data in, 537538 features of, 530 posting journal entries in, 535 producing reports in, 535537 Projection tab in, 534 Schedule tab in, 533 setting up client files for, 531532 supplying company information for, 531 tax worksheets in, 538 using Section 179/40% test with, 534535 fixed assets, depreciating, 318319 Fixed Fee Invoice template, using, 63 fixed-asset accounts, breaking down, 317 flat versus hierarchical view, 2325 FOB (Free On Board) field using with invoices, 66 using with sales forms, 477 FOB site, entering for Ship Via list, 52 folders, navigating to, 17 fonts changing for checks, 175 formatting in reports, 332 footer fields, specifying for reports, 331 footers, changing in templates, 357358 Form 940, creating, 238 Form 941 form, preparing, 237238 Form 1120, filing, 394 Form 1120S, filing, 394 form alignment, setting up, 8990 Form W-2, printing, 239 forms. See also templates availability of, 237 designing layouts for, 358359
INDE X
563
sending, 9495 sending using MAPI-compliant e-mail programs, 94 setting preferences for, 479 setting up printers for, 8889 frames, displaying for form layouts, 358359 Free On Board (FOB) field using with invoices, 66 using with sales forms, 477 Free On Board site, entering for Ship Via list, 52 FSD (Financial Statement Designer) components of, 541 features of, 540 opening, 540 FSD templates, using, 541 funds. See also cash transferring between accounts, 265 transferring online, 378 FUTA (Federal Form 940) report, filing, 238 G general journal entry numbers, assigning automatically, 465 general ledger accounts, splitting bills among, 147 general ledger entries. See also credits for customer payments, 113114 for depreciation, 318 for direct disbursements, 182 for discounts, 170 for paying bills, 167 for vendor credits, 158 general ledger, postings to, 72 GENJRNL transaction type, explanation of, 522
Google desktop searches, performing, 501502 Grace Period field, using with late invoice payments, 132 graphs, setting preferences for, 474476 Grid feature, using with forms, 359 gross wages, calculation of, 222 Group item type, description of, 44 H header fields, specifying for reports, 331 headers, changing in templates, 355356 Help window, displaying and resizing, 5 hh:mm format, using for time, 430 hierarchical view displaying Chart of Accounts window in, 29 versus flat view, 2325 Home page returning to from Coach Tips, 4 showing, 468469 Hour field on paychecks, recalling, 472 hourly employees, entering payroll information for, 217218 I Icon Bar, dragging, 487 icons adding, 486 adding for current window, 486 changing graphics, text, and descriptions for, 485 displaying without title text, 484485 removing, 485 reordering, 484 repositioning, 486 separating, 485
564
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
Import Accountants Changes dialog box, displaying, 520 importing memorized reports, 335337 income, depositing, 120125 Income Account field, using with items, 46 income accounts assigning for reimbursable expenses, 401 setting up for overages and shortages, 124 Income Tax Preparation report, displaying, 392 inkjet printers aligning, 90 handling partial check pages on, 175176 insurance companies, contacting regarding workers compensation, 233 Integrated Applications preferences, setting, 469 interest income, entering, 279280 interest rates, entering for finance charges, 131 Internal Revenue Service (IRS), web site for, 209 Internet, using QuickBooks services on, 479 Internet Connection Setup Wizard, options in, 363364 Internet zone warning, explanation of, 366 Intuit Product Invoice template, using, 63 Intuit Professional Invoice template, using, 62 Intuit Service Invoice template, using, 62 Intuit Standard Pledge template, using, 63 inventory adjusting count of, 258 adjusting value of, 258260
counting, 256260 running reports for, 260261 tracking, 258 Inventory Assembly item type, description of, 44 inventory assembly items. See assembly items Inventory features, enabling, 147 inventory items. See also assembly items; items creating, 247250 creating subitems for, 250 determining current availability of, 99 entering, 46 entering opening balances for, 315 making inactive, 250251 receiving without bills, 150153 setting preferences for, 242 setting up units of measure for, 243247 Inventory Part item type, description of, 44 Inventory Valuation Summary, features of, 261 Inventory Worksheet report description of, 260 printing, 256257 investing activities, including in Statement of Cash Flows report, 344 Invoice For Time & Expenses window displaying, 410 refreshing, 412 Invoice From Proposal/Estimate template, using, 64 invoice heading, entering information in, 6466 invoice numbers, finding, 65 invoice packing slips, using templates for, 478
INDE X
565
invoices. See also progress invoicing adding messages and memos to, 6970 adding new Ship To addresses to, 65 adding price levels to, 67 applying credits to, 8788 applying payments to, 106107 assigning classes to, 482483 changing dates in, 65 checking spelling in, 68 choosing sending methods for, 70 choosing shipping methods for, 66 creating, 64 creating for reimbursable expenses, 404, 406407, 412 creating from estimates, 7577 creating from sales orders, 81 versus credit memos, 85 credits for customer, 109110 editing, 7071 effects of, 72 e-mailing, 9394 entering discounts on, 68 entering line items on, 6668 entering transactions for, 315 identifying, 106 memorizing, 9798 printing, 9192 recording, 113 versus sales orders, 80 saving, 70 sending by e-mail, 9495 templates for, 6264 totaling, 105 voiding and deleting, 7172 IOUs, using with petty cash, 271 IRS (Internal Revenue Service), web site for, 209
IRS rules, checking for 1099 forms, 387 Item List window displaying for inventory items, 247 opening, 43 Item Price list, description of, 130 ITEM RCPT transaction type, assignment of, 156 item receipts converting to bills, 155 general ledger entries for, 156 item tracking, using with paycheck expenses, 472 items. See also inventory items adding to deposits, 124 assigning to customers, 187 creating, 45 creating for payroll, 201202 custom fields for, 5455 determining current availability of, 99 editing, 54 entering, 43 entering data for, 4346 selecting for bank deposits, 121 setting up for sales taxes, 186187 types of, 44 using with statement charges, 135 Items & Inventory, preferences for, 470471 items and bills, receiving simultaneously, 155156 J job costing linking employee time to, 438 setting payroll preferences for, 439 using classes for, 439440 using with paycheck expenses, 472
566
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
job reports, types of, 130 Job Status drop-down list, choices in, 39 Job Type list, setting up, 50 jobs applying credits to, 111 creating estimates for, 74 creating Profit & Loss budgets for, 301303 entering, 3839 linking mileage to, 418420 Jobs & Estimates preferences, setting, 471 journal entries. See also reversing entries creating, 311 entering opening balances for, 312 making at years end, 391 making for changed accounts, 317 posting in Fixed Asset Manager, 535 recording depreciation with, 318319 for recording employer payments, 321322 recording payroll run as, 321322 reporting on, 324 K Keep Custom Item Information option, setting preferences for, 463 keyboard shortcuts accounts, 25, 2728 assembly items, 251 bank account register, 172, 314 Chart of Accounts, 25 Chart Of Accounts window, 271, 273 check register, 178 classes, 481 Create Invoices window, 269 Customer Center, 60
deposits, 264 Edit Account dialog box, 29 Edit Customer dialog box, 37 editing accounts, 27 editing chart of accounts, 392 editing entries for merged lists, 56 editing items, 54 editing names for custom fields, 53 editing vendor information, 43 inventory items, 248 Item list for sales taxes, 186 items, 45 jobs, 38 memorize estimates, 78 Memorize Transaction dialog box, 97, 323 Memorized Transaction list, 160161 New Customer dialog box, 31 New Employee dialog box, 204 New Item dialog box for tax groups, 188 New Payroll Schedule dialog box, 200 New Sales Tax Code window, 184 New Terms window, 50 New Vendor dialog box, 40 price levels, 47 QuickReport on class, 482 sales reps, 50 Select Account Type window, 271, 273274 Ship Via entries, 52 switching between windows, 468 Unit Of Measure Wizard, 245 voiding checks, 270 Write Checks window, 180181, 267
INDE X
567
L labels printing, 9091 using with jobs, 3940 laser printers aligning, 90 handling partial check pages on, 175176 Last Year-to-Date, meaning of, 329 late payments, assessing finance charges for. See also payments Layout Designer, using with forms, 358359 Lead Schedule reports in Fixed Asset Manager, using, 536537 Learning Center, viewing, 14 liability accounts treating credit cards as, 273276 using for payroll entries, 199 liability checks, printing, 229 Liability Payment window, displaying, 228229 line items, entering on invoices, 6668 lists merging entries in, 5556 setting up with Excel data, 1517 views of, 23 local annual returns, preparing, 238 logos adding to checks, 175 locating, 353 M Mail Invoice feature, using, 93 mailing labels, printing, 9091
Make Deposits window displaying, 122123 recording missing transactions in, 314 Make General Journal Entries window opening, 320, 323 producing reports on journal entries from, 324 Manage Templates dialog box, opening, 360 manual checks. See also checks preparing, 173 writing for direct disbursements, 178181 MAPI-compliant e-mail, support for, 9394 margins, adjusting in forms, 359 markups, applying to reimbursable expenses, 408409 Match Transactions window, opening, 372 Medicare, making changes to, 222 Memorize Estimate feature, using, 78 Memorize Transaction dialog box, using with payroll journal entries, 323 memorized bill groups, creating, 161162 memorized bills creating, 158160 using, 160161 memorized invoices, using, 9798 memorized report groups, creating, 334335 Memorized Report lists, 337 memorized reports. See also reports exporting and importing, 335337 printing, 335 Memorized Transaction list selecting items from, 97 setting up, 49
568
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
memos adding to invoices, 6970 including with online payments, 380 using with reimbursable expenses, 403 merchant accounts, using, 122 merchant card fees, handling, 122123 Merchant Service, using for credit card payments, 118 merging accounts, 29 entries in lists, 5556 messages. See also one-time messages adding to invoices, 6970 including in Accountants Copy, 514 mileage billing customers for, 422 entering for vehicles, 416 reimbursing employees and subcontractors for, 420422 Mileage By Detail report, copying, 421 mileage items, creating for vehicles, 415416 mileage rates, entering for vehicles, 415 mileage reports, creating, 417420 missing check numbers. See also check numbers creating audit trail for, 177 reconciling, 278 resolving, 283284 Missing Checks report, using with invoice numbers, 65 missing deposits, managing in online banking, 375 missing transactions, recording, 314, 375. See also transactions Modify Report dialog box, displaying, 329, 380
money. See cash; funds money owed, reporting, 128129 Monthly reports in Fixed Asset Manager, using, 536537 Multiuser Mode in Enterprise Edition, 498 in Premier Edition, 490491 My Preferences tab, using, 461463 N name information updates, setting preferences for, 464 names adding custom field for, 53 editing, 53 .NET Framework 2.0, installation of, 68 net worth graph, displaying, 341 network access, requirements for, 7 Network or Always-on Connections, selecting for online banking, 364 networks, sharing updates on, 527 New Class window, displaying, 481 New Customer dialog box, opening, 31 New Customer window, Address Info tab in, 32 New Item window displaying, 45 displaying for inventory items, 248 New Job window, opening, 38 New Payroll Schedule dialog box, opening, 200 New Price Level dialog box, displaying, 47 New Sales Rep dialog box, opening, 50 New Sales Tax Code window, opening, 184 New Terms window, window, 5051 New Timer File window, opening, 450
INDE X
569
New User dialog box, displaying in Enterprise Edition, 496 New Vendor dialog box, opening, 40 Noninventory Part item type, description of, 44 nonposting accounts, creation of, 22. See also accounts nonprofit organizations, journal entries for, 311 Notepad window, opening, 3738 Notes box using with tracked single activities, 429 using with Weekly Timesheets, 431432 Notes button in Edit Customer dialog box, 37 in Edit Vendor dialog box, 43 NSF (nonsufficient funds) checks. See also checks adjusting accounts for, 267268 attempting redeposit of, 268 recollecting debt for, 269270 setting up for, 266267 NSF payments, retaining, 266 number format, using with accounts, 1921 numbers, formatting in reports, 333 O ODBC reporting, implementing, 350352 odometer readings, tracking, 416 officer compensation, calculating, 394 Officer Compensation payroll item, adding, 202, 212 officer employee type, description of, 209 One Window view, using, 468
one-time messages, bringing back, 462. See also messages online accounts, transferring money between, 377378 Online Backup subscription service, signing up for, 503 online banking. See also Bill Pay service methods of, 362 setting up, 364 setting up connection for, 363364 Online Banking Center features of, 371372 matching transactions in, 372374 opening, 369370 viewing items in, 372, 374 Online Banking Setup Interview Wizard, displaying, 368 online evaluation resources, availability of, 8 online payments, making, 378380 Online Received Payments Report, description of, 130 online transaction reports, creating, 380 Open Invoices Report, description of, 130 Open Sales Orders reports, using, 8384 Opening Balance field, availability of, 3233 opening balances correcting, 289 entering, 27 entering for customers and vendors, 315 entering for inventory items, 315 entering for journal entries, 312 reconciling, 287288 recording, 33 and reporting on cash basis, 316 setting up, 313314
570
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
operating activities, including in Statement of Cash Flows report, 344 Optimizer, using with ODBC reporting, 351 Other Charge item type, description of, 44 Other Names list, setting up, 49 overages for cash drawer, handling, 124 overdue payments, assessing finance charges for, 130132, 133. See also payments Over-Short account, setting up income account for, 124 owner employee type, description of, 209 P Packing Slip template, using, 64 packing slips printing, 93 using templates for, 478 panes, resizing in Customer Center, 62 parent accounts, setting up for tracking reimbursed income, 402 parent items, creating for inventory items, 250 Partial Page window, using with checks, 175176 passwords assigning to administrators in Enterprise Edition, 495 resetting in Premier Edition, 488 setting preferences for, 479 using with Accountants Copy, 513 using with unattended backups, 509 Pay Bills window, listing checks created in, 172 Pay Liabilities window, paying workers compensation from, 236 pay online feature, adding, 93
Pay Sales Tax window, displaying, 190 Pay Selected Bills option, choosing, 171 pay stubs, setting printing options for, 219 paycheck expenses, using item tracking with, 472 paychecks copying earnings details from, 472 creating, 220 creating from timesheet data, 441443 displaying, 218 editing, 221, 442 entering historical data about, 210 printing, 220221 recalling Hour field on, 472 recalling Quantity field on, 472 reviewing information for, 219220 using time data on, 438439 voiding, 222 payee account number, autofilling in check memo, 467 payee aliasing, using with checks, 467 payee field, including on checks, 466 Payment Info tab, fields in, 3537 Payment item type, description of, 44 Payment Method list, setting up, 5152 Payment Method, segregating bank deposits by, 121122 payment method, selecting, 105 Payment Summary window, displaying, 172 payment terms, entering, 34 payments. See also late payments; overdue payments; underpayments adding, 106 applying discounts for, 111113 applying to invoices, 106107 choosing for deposits, 120122
INDE X
571
depositing to Undeposited Funds account, 105, 107108 direct disbursements of, 178 general ledger entries for, 113114 making electronically, 378380 receiving, 478 receiving online, 380381 receiving after sales, 119120 receiving at time of sale, 119 receiving from customers online, 380381 recording, 104105 Payments To Deposit window, displaying, 120 payroll linking employee time to, 438 running, 217 running with timesheet data, 441443 and workers compensation, 236 Payroll & Employees preferences, setting, 471473 payroll accounts reconciling, 323 setting as default, 218 transferring money to, 321 Payroll Center accessing to pay tax liabilities, 228 renewing subscription for, 197 payroll documents, preparing, 238239 payroll elements setting up chart of accounts, 199200 setting up vendors, 199 payroll history entering in batches, 211 entering in Payroll Setup Wizard, 215217 handling of, 210
payroll information entering for employees, 205208 entering for hourly employees, 217218 establishing defaults for employees, 203204 payroll items creating, 201202 setting up in Payroll Setup Wizard, 211212 payroll job costing, using classes for, 439440 payroll journal entries, creating templates for, 323 payroll liabilities. See also unscheduled payroll liabilities adjusting, 232 IRS requirement for, 195 selecting date ranges for, 231 payroll preferences, setting for job costing, 439 Payroll Printing Preferences dialog box, opening, 219 payroll records, summary of, 210 payroll reports, running for cost information, 443444 payroll schedules, creating, 200201 payroll services availability of, 194 paying fees to, 323 recording payroll from, 320323 Payroll Setup Interview Wizard, starting, 227 Payroll Setup Wizard entering payroll history in, 215217 setting up employees in, 213 using, 211
572
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
Payroll Solutions web site, accessing, 195 Payroll tab in Employee Center, options on, 198 payroll taxes, setting up, 214 Payroll Transaction Detail report, using with job costing, 443444 PDF files saving financial statements and documents as, 545 sending invoices and credit memos as, 9394 viewing, 291 pending builds of assemblies, creating, 253255 Per Item price level type, using, 4748 permissions assigning for users in Enterprise Edition, 495 printing reports on, 497 reporting on in Enterprise Edition, 497 setting up in Premier Edition, 489490 Personal Property Schedule by Year of Acquisition report, using, 537 petty cash accounts creating, 270271 selecting, 117 petty cash putting money into, 271 recording disbursements for, 271272 petty cash transactions, entering vendor names for, 272 pick lists, printing, 101 pop-up messages, setting preferences for, 462
portable company files. See also company files creating, 511 description of, 510511 restoring, 511512 POs (purchase orders). See purchase orders (POs) preferences for accounting, 464465 for accounting options, 464465 for beep related to transactions, 461 for Bills category, 466 for checking, 466467 for Class Tracking, 480483 for default due date for new transactions, 463 for desktop view, 467469 for drop-down lists, 461 for estimates, 73 for field navigation, 461 for finance charges, 130132 for finance charges, 469 for forms, 479 for integrated applications, 469 for Items & Inventory, 470 for Items & Inventory, 470471 for Jobs & Estimates, 471 for Payroll & Employees, 471473 for placement of decimal point, 462 for pop-up messages, 462 for recalling information automatically, 462463 for reminders, 473474 for Reports & Graphs, 474476 for Sales & Customers, 476478
INDE X
573
for sales orders, 79 for sales taxes, 479 for service connections, 479 for spelling, 480 for time and expense tracking, 480 for Timer, 453 for ToolTips for clipped text, 462 setting, 461 viewing, 460461 Preferences dialog box displaying for payroll and job costing, 439 tracking reimbursable expenses from, 401 using to number accounts, 19 using with jobs, 39 Preferred Payment Method section in Additional Info tab, using, 36 Preferred Send field in Additional Info tab, using, 35 Premier Edition creating users in, 488 managing user information in, 487 removing users from, 488 Preview Paycheck window, displaying, 218 Price Level feature, activating, 478 Price Level list, setting up, 4748 price levels adding to invoices, 67 using, 34 Print Batch option, using with checks, 182 Print Checks window opening, 181, 220 opening to pay checks for tax liabilities, 229 Printer Setup dialog box, opening, 88
printers setting up for checks, 174176 setting up for forms, 8889 printing 1096 forms, 390 1099 forms, 386, 390391 assembly-item components, 255256 Balance Sheet Budget Overview, 305 batch printing, 9192 bill history, 171 budget reports, 303 checks, 176178 checks for tax liabilities, 229 Closing Date Exception report, 396 deposit slips, 125 direct disbursement checks, 181182 finance charge invoices, 134 financial statements and documents, 544 inventory worksheet, 256257 invoices and credit memos, 9192 mailing labels, 9091 memorized reports, 335 packing slips, 93 paychecks, 220221 pick lists, 101 purchase orders, 149 reconciliation reports, 276, 284285 reports, 327 and reprinting, 177178 sales receipts, 116 statements, 140 Vendor 1099 Review report, 386 W-2 forms, 239 Weekly Timesheets, 434435
574
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
Process Multiple Reports feature, using, 335 Profit & Loss budget overview, producing, 304305 Profit & Loss Budget Performance reports, creating, 306 Profit & Loss budgets creating, 296297 creating for customers and jobs, 301303 Profit & Loss reports generating, 342343 running at years end, 385 sending to accountants, 391 progress invoicing, setting preferences for, 471. See also invoices Progress template, using, 63 Projection by Category report, using, 537 Projection tab in Fixed Asset Manager, options on, 534 Properties dialog box, displaying for forms, 359 Purchase Order features, enabling, 147 purchase orders (POs) creating for inventory items, 248 creating for items on sales orders, 81 printing, 149 setting preferences for, 470 using, 148150 Q .qba extension, meaning of, 517 .qbb extension, explanation of, 502 .QBR extension, meaning of, 336 .qbw versus .qbm files, 510 .qby extension, meaning of, 519520 QODBC driver, configuring, 352
Quantity field on paychecks, recalling, 472 quarterly 941 form, preparing, 237238 QuickBooks 2008 new features in, 23 system requirements for, 68 updating, 524525 QuickBooks Coach, features of, 34, 469 QuickBooks credit card, using, 368 QuickBooks Enterprise. See Enterprise Edition QuickBooks interface, tutorial for, 4 QuickBooks Premier. See Premier Edition QuickBooks Solution Marketplace. See Solutions Marketplace QuickReports, displaying for classes, 482 R Recall options, using with paychecks, 472 receipts requiring for petty cash, 271272 starting, 116 Receive Payments preferences, setting, 478 Receive Payments window, displaying, 104 Reconcile window setting up, 280281 switching between registers, 282 reconciled transactions, voiding, 288 reconciliation issues, troubleshooting, 286290 reconciliation process completing, 284285 pausing, 284 reconciliation reports printing, 276, 284 types of, 285 viewing, 290291
INDE X
575
reconciliations of bank accounts, 279 making adjusting entries for, 292 of payroll accounts, 323 undoing, 291292 recurring bills, entering, 158160. See also bills refreshing reports, 332 refunds, issuing for credits, 8687 registers. See also customer register entering transfers into, 378 recording deposits in, 264 switching between Reconcile window, 282 using for direct disbursement manual checks, 178179 reimbursable expenses. See also expenses assigning income accounts for, 401 creating invoices for, 404 displaying in Invoice for Time & Expenses window, 410 including when prompted, 404409 invoicing for, 409412 marking up, 408409 recording, 403 removing from Choose Billable Time and Costs, 408 tracking, 400402 types of, 400 viewing totals of income received from, 401 reimbursed income, setting up parent and subaccounts for, 402 Relevant Topics tab in Help, links on, 5 Remaining Basis Over Remaining Life report, using, 537 Reminders preferences, setting, 473474 Reorder field, filling for inventory items, 249
Rep field in Additional Info tab, using, 3435 Report Center window, displaying, 326327 report description information, providing, 331 report format defaults, setting preferences for, 475 report information limiting, 330331 selecting and sorting, 329330 Report Navigator, using, 326327 report templates adding to Memorized Report lists, 337 saving, 336 reports. See also customized reports; memorized reports 940 report, 238 adding to memorized report groups, 335 for cash flow, 476 for classes, 482483 for collections, 133134 for estimates, 78 exporting, 337338 filtering for unpaid bills, 165 for Fixed Asset Manager, 535537 formatting text and numbers in, 331333 for inventory, 260261 Inventory Valuation Summary, 261 inventory worksheet, 260 for jobs, 130 for mileage, 417420 Missing Checks, 283 for payroll and cost information, 443444 for pending builds, 255, 260 for permissions, 497
576
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
reports. See also customized reports; memorized reports (cont.) previewing, 326 printing, 327 printing for cash and accrual basis, 329 for quarterly 941 form, 237238 rearranging columns on, 328 for reconciliation, 284285, 290291 refreshing, 332 removing columns from, 328 running on cash basis, 316 for sales taxes, 189 sending to accountants, 391 setting preferences for, 474476 showing by accounts, 476 for timesheets, 432433 for tracking backorders, 83 for vehicle mileage, 417420 for workers compensation, 237 reprinting, 177178. See also printing reversing entries, entering, 320. See also journal entries Review And Create Paychecks window, displaying, 219 Rock Castle Invoice template, using, 64 roles assigning to users in Enterprise Edition, 493494 creating in Enterprise Edition, 494495 S S corporations, entering payroll items for, 202 Sales & Customers preferences, setting, 476478
sales forms, setting preferences for, 477 Sales Order Fulfillment Worksheet availability of, 84 using, 99101 sales orders. See also backorders creating, 80 creating invoices from, 81 creating purchase orders for items on, 81 creating purchase orders from, 149 versus estimates, 79 fulfilling, 99101 versus invoices, 80 setting preferences for, 79 Sales Orders preferences, setting, 478 Sales Price field, using with items, 46 sales receipts requiring for petty cash, 271272 starting, 116 Sales Rep list, setting up, 50 sales reps assigning to customers, 3536 marking new employees as, 473 Sales Tax Code list, setting up, 48 Sales Tax Group item type, description of, 44 sales tax information, supplying, 35 Sales Tax Item type, description of, 44 sales tax items, setting up, 186187 Sales Tax preferences, setting, 479 sales tax reports, running, 189 sales taxes adjusting amounts for, 191 codes for, 183185 remitting, 190191 setting payment basis for, 185
INDE X
577
setting payment dates for, 185186 tracking, 183 Save & New option, using with invoices, 70 SBU_* files, meaning of, 508 Schedule tab in Fixed Asset Manager, options on, 533 Search tab in Help, using, 5 Section 179/40% test, using with Fixed Asset Manager, 534535 Select 1099s To Print window, displaying, 390 Select A Base Unit Of Measure screen, displaying, 246 Select Account Type window displaying for credit card accounts, 273274 displaying for petty cash, 271 Select Checks to Print window, displaying, 176 Select Form Type dialog box, displaying, 237239 Select Forms To Send dialog box, using, 96 Select Labels To Print dialog box, displaying, 91 Send Invoice dialog box, opening, 94 sensitive accounting activities, examples of, 489490 sensitive financial reports, examples of, 490 service charges, entering, 279280 Service Connection preferences, setting, 479 Service item type, description of, 44 Set Up Budgets window, displaying, 295296, 298 Set Up Forecast tool, features of, 308 Ship To address, changing for invoices, 65
Ship Via list, setting up, 52 shipping addresses, maintaining, 32 shipping costs, handling, 73 Shipping Manager, using, 92 shortages for cash drawer, handling, 124 Show Inactive Accounts option, choosing, 27 Show Lowest Subaccount option, using, 1920 Show Next 6 months button, appearance of, 299 sick pay information, entering for employees, 208 sick time information, entering for employees, 212 Single Activity window, filling out for timesheets, 428 Social Security, making changes to, 222 Solutions Marketplace, features of, 810 Sort By drop-down list, using with Payroll Transaction Detail report, 443 sorting customers by type, 33 spell checker using, 12 using with invoices, 6869 Spelling preferences, setting, 480 split transactions, credit card bills as, 272273 state annual returns, preparing, 238 state forms, availability of, 223 state payroll information, setting up for employees, 207 state taxes, setting up, 214. See also tax forms statement charges, entering, 135136 Statement of Cash Flows report, generating, 343345
578
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
statements including finance charges on, 139 previewing, 139140 printing, 140 selecting customers for, 137138 selecting date ranges for, 136137 statutory employee type, description of, 209 stopwatch, tracking time with, 430 subaccounts. See also accounts collapsing, 304 creating, 2829 posting asset purchases to, 318 setting display preferences for, 465 setting up for tracking reimbursed income, 402 using, 23 Subchapter S corporations filing form 1120S for, 394 using Officer Compensation item for, 212 subclasses, creating, 482 subcontractors, reimbursing for mileage, 420422 subitems creating, 45 creating for inventory items, 250 making inactive, 251 subscriptions, renewing for Payroll Center, 197 Subtotal item type, description of, 44 Summary Reports Basis options, setting, 475 Supporting Document Editor accessing, 544 features of, 543 system requirements, 68
T Tables. See also Figures account numbering structure, 20 accountants capabilities relative to Accountants Copy, 518 Balance Sheet reports, 340 compounding versus not compounding, 301 dividing data capabilities in Accountants Copy, 516 employee types, 209 inventory reports, 260 journal entry for employer-side transactions, 322 journal entry to record payroll, 322 Multiuser Mode actions and restrictions, 491 Multiuser Mode in Enterprise Edition, 498 Pay Bills options, 166 reports in Fixed Asset Manager, 536537 Single User Mode in Enterprise Edition, 498 system requirements, 7 units of measure, 244 T-Account format, explanation of, 310 tasks, setting up for time tracking, 427 Tax Code field, using with items, 46 tax forms, filing for C and Subchapter S corporations, 394. See also federal taxes; state taxes tax groups, creating, 187189 tax information, entering employees, 207 tax items, creating for tax groups, 188 tax liabilities, paying, 228231 tax line information, checking, 392394
INDE X
579
tax payment schedules, setting up, 214215, 226227 tax rates, entering as percentages, 187 tax reports, running, 392394 tax worksheets in Fixed Asset Manager, availability of, 538 Tax:1099 preferences, setting, 480 Taxes section of Payroll Setup Wizard, using, 214 templates. See also activity templates; forms adding fields to, 356 changing columns in, 356357 changing footers in, 357358 changing headers in, 355356 creating for payroll journal entries, 323 editing, 353354 for FSD (Financial Statement Designer), 541 for invoice packing slip, 478 naming, 360 selecting for customization, 355 using with invoices, 6264 Terms field in Additional Info tab, using, 34 Terms list, setting up, 5051 text, formatting in reports, 331333 time. See also employee time setting format for, 430 tracking with stopwatch, 430 Time & Expense Invoice template, using, 62 Time Activity Log, displaying, 454 time data using for employees, 438 using on paychecks, 438439
time entries, editing, 434 time format, setting, 464 Time Tracker, using, 429, 446 time tracking setting preferences for, 480 setting up tasks for, 427 setting up workers for, 424426 of single activities, 428430 turning on, 424 Time/Enter Single Activity window, filling in, 428429 Timer files exporting, 453455 importing in QuickBooks, 455457 Timer Import Detail report, displaying, 456 Timer program distributing, 446447 importing files related to, 450451 installing on recipient computer, 447 opening for first time, 449450 setting preferences in, 453 setting up activity template for, 451452 using, 428 Timer users, exporting data lists to, 448449 timesheet data, running payroll with, 441443 timesheet reports, running, 432433 timesheets. See also Weekly Timesheets previewing, 435 reporting information about, 432 using efficiently, 440441 viewing and editing, 456 using, 427432 timing work, 452453 tips, turning of, 16
580
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
ToolTips for clipped text, setting preferences for, 462 Transaction Detail By Account reports, modifying, 380 transaction files, importing, 371 transaction line, entering checks on, 179 Transaction List By Customer Report, description of, 130 transaction rights, establishing, 490 transactions. See also downloaded transactions; missing transactions adding for credit card bills, 276 cleaning up, 523 clearing to reconcile bank statements, 281282 considering during reconciliation, 282 correcting, 289 creating for inventory items, 249 displaying for customers, 61 entering for invoices and bills, 315 entering for reimbursable expenses, 403 finding, 500502 importance of dates to, 289 listing for vendors, 142 matching, 372374 removing, 523 selecting for reconciliation reports, 290 selecting from Memorized Transaction list, 97 setting beep preferences for, 461 setting warning for editing of, 462 unmatching of, 374375 using aliases for matching of, 375376 using classes in, 482
warning when posting to retained earnings, 465 without account numbers in online banking, 375 transactions cleared, using Discrepancy Report with, 288289 Transactions tab in Employee Center, options on, 197 Transfer Funds Between Accounts dialog box, opening, 265 Transfer Funds function, using with online accounts, 377378 Transfer Funds versus Write Checks window, 117 trial balances, producing, 338 TurboTax, using, 394 Type field sorting customers by, 33 sorting vendors by, 41 U U/M (Units Of Measure) feature setting preferences for, 471 using, 243, 248 unattended backups, setting up, 507509 Unbilled Costs By Job Report, description of, 130 Undeposited Funds account depositing payments to, 105, 120, 107108 making payments to, 113114 underpayments, handling, 108109. See also payments units of measure, setting up for inventory items, 243247 unpaid bills, viewing, 164165. See also bills
INDE X
581
unscheduled payroll liabilities, paying, 231232. See also payroll liabilities Update QuickBooks service setting up, 526527 using, 525 update status, determining, 527 updated files, selecting and downloading, 526 updates automatic versus manual types of, 526 sharing on networks, 527 user permissions setting in Enterprise Edition, 495 setting in Premier Edition, 489490 users creating in Enterprise Edition, 496 creating in Premier Edition, 488 managing in Premier Edition, 487 removing from Premier Edition, 488 Users and Roles window, displaying in Enterprise Edition, 492494 V vacation pay information, entering for employees, 208 vacation time information, entering for employees, 212 Vehicle list, setting up, 52 vehicles creating mileage reports for, 417420 entering mileage for, 416 entering mileage rates for, 415 tracking, 414 vendor 1099 balances, verifying, 388390 Vendor 1099 Review report, printing, 386
vendor accounts, setting preferences for, 146 vendor bills general ledger entries for, 156 recording, 143147 Vendor Center one-account posting in, 145146 opening and customizing, 142 vendor credits, recording, 157158 Vendor list choosing columns in, 143 displaying, 40 filling Vendor Center window with, 143 vendor time, tracking, 425 Vendor Type list, setting up, 50 vendors choosing for one-account posting, 145 creating mileage items for, 415416 entering opening balances for, 315 filling out bills for, 145146 listing transactions for, 142 making electronic payments to, 379 paying 940 tax liability to, 227 setting up payroll for, 199 treating credit cards as, 272273 views of lists, support for, 23 Vista, storing company files in, 14 void checks, information on, 177 voided transactions, correcting, 289 Voided/Deleted Transactions Detail report, description of, 347 Voided/Deleted Transactions Summary report, description of, 346347 voiding versus deleting checks, 270
582
Q U I CKBO O KS
2008
T H E
O F F ICIAL
GUIDE
voucher checks printing, 176 printing account names on, 466 selecting, 175 setting printing options for, 219 W W-2 forms, printing, 239 W-4 forms, downloading, 209 wallet checks, selecting, 175, 177 Web Connect online banking enabling bank accounts for, 368369 exchanging data with, 370371 explanation of, 362 and paying bills, 379 setting, 479 web sites Adobe Acrobat Reader, 545 Billing Solutions, 381 business forms, 64 Enterprise-specific solutions, 9 IRS (Internal Revenue Service), 209 Merchant Services account, 118 payroll services, 194 Payroll Solutions, 195 QuickBooks, 93 tax forms, 239 Timer program, 446 W-4 form, 209 Weekly Timesheets. See also timesheets printing, 434435 using, 427, 430432 window envelopes, using, 358
windows, switching between, 468 Windows Vista, storing company files in, 14 work, timing, 452453 workbooks in Excel, using with QuickBooks, 1516 worker time, tracking, 426 workers, setting up for time tracking, 425426 Workers Comp field, appearance of, 429, 431 Workers Comp list, setting up, 49 workers compensation and payroll, 236 reporting on and paying, 237 tracking, 234236 tracking and accruing liability for, 232233 Workers Compensation tab, accessing, 209 Write Checks window opening, 181 opening for NSF checks, 267 versus Transfer Funds window, 117 using, 180 Write Off Amount window, displaying, 109 Y year, closing, 395 year-end backup, creating, 396 year-end financial reports, running, 385 year-end journal entries, making, 391 year-end tasks, examples of, 384 years as 4 digits preference, setting, 464